Location via proxy:   [ UP ]  
[Report a bug]   [Manage cookies]                

Scribd 123456789 Ikmbgyujnbyuj

Download as pdf or txt
Download as pdf or txt
You are on page 1of 211
At a glance
Powered by AI
The book discusses different aspects of mysticism in Indian traditions and compares them to other religious traditions. It contains papers presented at various symposiums edited by Karel Werner.

The book contains papers on topics like mysticism as a doctrine and experience, mysticism in Indian spirituality, yoga in the Vedas, mysticism in Upanishads and Shankara's philosophy, birth of extraordinary persons like Buddha, consciousness mysticism in Buddhist discourses, comparison of stages of mysticism in Christianity and Buddhism, bhakti poetry and Carmelite mystics, yoga philosophy and Jung, biographies of contemporary Indian mystics like Anandamayi and Rajneesh.

The papers cover topics like different understandings of mysticism, connections between mysticism and Indian spirituality, concepts in Vedic texts and Upanishads, lives and teachings of Buddha and other mystics, comparisons between Indian and other religious traditions.

DURHAM INDOLOGICAL SERIES

THE YOGI AND THE MYSTIC


Durham Indological Series No.1

THE YOGI AND THE


MYSTIC
STUDIES IN INDIAN AND
COMPARATIVE MYSTICISM

Edited by
KAREL WERNER

CURZON PRESS
Curzon Press Ltd. 1994
Curzon Press Ltd.
St Johns Studios
Church Road
Richmond
Surrey TW9 2QA
First published 1989
This edition published in the Taylor & Francis e-Library, 2005.
To purchase your own copy of this or any of Taylor & Francis or
Routledges collection of thousands of eBooks please go to
www.eBookstore.tandf.co.uk.
ISBN 0-203-98574-5 Master e-book ISBN

ISBN 0 7007 0272 5 (Print Edition)


All rights reserved
Karel Werner 1989
Durham Indological Series No.1
British Library Cataloguing-in-Publication Data
A CIP record for this book is available
from the British Library
CONTENTS

Abbreviations viii
Editors Preface xi

1 Mysticism as Doctrine and Experience 1


KAREL WERNER
2 Mysticism and Indian Spirituality 19
KAREL WERNER
3 The Longhaired Sage of Veda 10, 136; A Shaman, a Mystic 33
or a Yogi?
KAREL WERNER
4 Mysticism in the and in ankaras Vednta 53
PRATIMA BOWES
5 Birth of Extraordinary Persons: the Buddhas Case 67
MINORU HARA
6 Consciousness Mysticism in the Discourses of The Buddha 81
PETER HARVEY
7 The Stages of Christian Mysticism and Buddhist Purification: 101
Interior Castle of St Teresa of vila and the Path of
Purification of Buddhaghosa
LANCE S.COUSINS
8 Living Between the Worlds: Bhakti Poetry and the Carmelite 119
Mystics
DEIRDRE GREEN
9 Yoga Philosophy and Jung 139
F.W.J.HUMPHRIES
10 Three Contemporary Indian Mystics: nandamay, 149
Krishnabai and Rajneesh
JOHN E.MITCHINER
vi

11 Yoga, Mysticism and a Model of Comparative Religion 167


ANDREW RAWLINSON

Glossary 183
Contributors 191
Note on the Papers and Acknowledgments 193
vii
ABBREVIATIONS

A Nikya
AA Nikya Atthakath
Akb
AP Agni
Asl
ASS nandrama Sanskrit Series (Poona)
AU Aitareya
AV Atharva Veda
B Buddhacarita
BEFEO Bulletin de lcole franaise dextrme orient (Paris)
BI Bibliotheca Indica (Calcutta)
BP Bhgavata
BrahP Brahma
BrP
BU
CU Chndogya
D Dgha Nikya
DA Dgha Nikya Atthakath (commentary)
Dh Dhammapada
Dhs
ERE Encyclopaedia of Religions and Ethics
GP
GU Garbha
ICANAS International Congress of Asian and North African
Studies
IIJ Indo-Iranian Journal
It Ittivuttaka
ix

IU
K
KaU
KeU Kena
L Lalita Vistara
LS Lankvatra Stra
M Majjhima Nikya
MA Majjhima Nikya Atthakath
MaiU Maitr
MaU
Mhb Mahbhrata
Mhvs Mahvastu
Miln Milindapaha
MP
MuH
N Nidnakath
NP Nrada
PP Padma
PPS Praj Pramit Stra
Pr Pretakalpa
Ps
PsS Pupatastra
PTS Pli Text Society
PU
RV Veda
S Samyutta Nikya
Sn Suttanipta
S Ramanujans Speaking of iva
Su Surevaras
T St Teresas Interior Castle
Ta Tandulaveyliya
TSS Trivandrum Sanskrit Series
TU Taittirya
Ud Udna
Vibh
Vism Visuddhimagga
VP
x

Vs
YS Yoga Stra
Ysm
THE EDITORS PREFACE

The original intention behind the publication of this collection of papers


was to commemorate ten Symposia on Indian Religions convened annually
by the editor from 1975. During the preceding decade or so the teaching and
study of, as well as research into, Indian religions on the academic level
underwent considerable expansion. Before that happened Indian religions
were usually a part of the traditional Indology in the departments or schools
of Oriental studies and were, besides, only modestly represented elsewhere,
for example in a few religious departments such as that of Comparative
Religion in the University of Manchester or that of History and Philosophy
of Religion in Kings College, London. These were added to with the
foundation of new Universities, some of which acquired large departments
of Religious Studies as in Lancaster. With the advent of the ecumenical
spirit among Christian denominations and a degree of openmindedness
towards non-Christian religious traditions, including endeavours to broaden
religious education on the secondary level, departments of Theology in some
Universities accordingly extended the scope of their teaching, usually
starting with the creation of a lectureship in Indian religions. A similar trend
developed, even more readily, in some Polytechnics with departments of
humanities or cultural studies, and in Institutes of Higher Education.
In this way some three dozen scholars concerned with Indian religions
became established in academic positions, scattered around the country.
This, of course, placed them in a position of relative isolation with little
opportunity of regular contacts with centres of Indian studies and with
colleagues with similar and overlapping interests.
Perhaps it was the comparable situation of Indian studies in Durham,
represented by a single post initiated by the Spalding Foundation, which
made the editor, whose research interests lay in the field of Indian religions,
alert to the problem, and so the idea of meeting annually for discussions
with colleagues was born. A few preliminary inquiries suggested sufficient
interest for a two-day conference with prepared papers to be feasible and
the First Symposium on Indian Religions, financially supported by the
Spalding Trust, took place in Selwyn College, Cambridge, on 2123 March
xii PREFACE

1975 with over thirty participants. An address by a representative of the


British Association for the History of Religions (BAHR) showed the
potential value of this specialized project for the wider field of religious
studies and the continuation of the new venture was secured.
The Second Symposium held in 1976 in Passfield Hall, London, enjoyed
the appearance of a guest speaker from India, namely Mte Mahdev, the
first female jagadguru or spiritual head of a South Indian
community. She was also the first one of a steady trickle of overseas
visitors who found their way into the Symposiathis collection includes a
contribution by a visiting sanskritist from Japan.
In a working session during the Second Symposium, when future plans
were discussed, virtually no support was found for the proposition that the
Symposia should continue under the umbrella of BAHR, while neither on
that occasion nor at the Third Symposium (in the University College in
Durham Castle in 1977) was there any enthusiasm shown for giving the
Symposia an official status by forming a committee with the prospect of
founding a permanent association for the study of Indian religions.
It might appear that it was somewhat naive on the part of the participants
to assume the smooth continuation of the conferences without an
organizational basis, but in the event it proved to have been the right way to
proceed. Organizations with their committees sometimes generate more
work than the original purpose for which they were formed requires and
may even become a hindrance rather than a help in achieving that purpose.
As everything remained in the hands of one individual, planning and
decisions could be quick and administrative support required proved to be
surprisingly low.
The programmes of the Symposia were planned in such a way that the
invited speakers were left to choose their own themes, but the convener saw
to it that a balance between papers on Buddhism and on Hinduism was
maintained, with an occasional contribution on other religions such as
Sikhism or Jainism whenever available, and that coverage was given both to
the ancient religious systems and to the more recent developments.
During the Fourth Symposium in Mansfield College, Oxford, in 1978 it
was decided that a Symposium on a given theme should be attempted and
the choice fell on mysticism. The Fifth Symposium in Holly Royde College,
Manchester (1979), which received valuable organizational help from one or
two members of the Department of Comparative Religion of the University,
could not accommodate all the papers generated by the enthusiasm for a
thematic conference, and the reading of some of them had to be postponed
till the subsequent year. Most of the papers in the present collection came
from this harvest.
The Sixth Symposium in 1980 found its venue under the hospitable roof
of the Cherwell Centre in Oxford which has become the home of all
PREFACE xiii

subsequent Symposia till the present day and is likely to remain so as long
as it stays available and the Symposia continue.
The success of a one-theme conference was repeated in 1981 with the
Seventh Symposium dedicated to symbolism in Indian religions. It is hoped
that a second collection of papers from the Symposia may be launched by
Curzon Press in due course, the bulk of its contents to be formed by the
papers of this Symposium.
With the project now well established and unlikely to falter even if the
regulars were faced with a need to take some new decisions, the convener
announced, during the Eighth Symposium (1982), his decision to retire from
his responsibility. Sensing the air of disbelief among the participants he
added that the Tenth Symposium would seem to be the suitable occasion
for this change. When he repeated his decision during the Ninth Symposium,
it was obvious that the message had sunk in and steps were being taken to
secure continuity. Thus it was that at the Tenth Symposium a committee of
three was ready at hand to start preparations for the next one. The
Thirteenth Symposium, the last one to date (1987), had Bhakti as its theme
and the level of the contributions would warrant their publication in yet
another volume if the reception of the present one and of the envisaged
volume on symbolism justifies it.
The benefits the Symposia have brought and continue to bring to those
attending are testified to by their steady number, which hovers around or
above thirty. Many papers read at a Symposium found their way into
respectable academic magazines and not a few contributions, successfully
presented at a later stage to an international conference or at a guest
appearance in an overseas University, were first read and discussed at a
Symposium and finalized subsequently under the influence of the feedback
obtained there. This has been possible, because each speaker has nearly two
hours at his disposal for the reading and discussion of his contribution, a
feature which has been one of the main attractions of the Symposia. One or
two newly-appointed lecturers thus gained their first experience of
presenting their work to a learned forum and having it discussed in an
unusually relaxed atmosphere at the Symposium and could proceed further
afield from there with confidence. At an early stage research students
supervised by participants were allowed to attend and from time to time one
of them was invited to present a report on his or her work, again a valuable
experience for their future progress.
The editor trusts that the reader will forgive him for dwelling at some
length on the history of the Symposia before embarking on an explanation
of the theme of the present collection.
When planning the Symposium on Indian mysticism the editor sent a
fairly extensive synopsis of his introductory paper, Mysticism as Doctrine
and Experience, to the prospective contributors so that they could relate to
it if they thought that the presentation of their subject matter would benefit
xiv PREFACE

from it in some way, but it was not made a condition. In some contributions
this relation is clearly reflected, in others it is not obvious at a first glance,
while some were written outside, or without the knowledge of, the framework
outlined in the introductory paper. Yet, in the editors view, the
applicability of the structural patterns in mystical experiences and in the
mystic paths in different traditions and schools as outlined in the
introductory paper extends even to those written without knowledge of it.
The introductory paper traces the beginnings and development of
mysticism in Europe from Orphic times in ancient Greece till the Middle
Ages, taking into account Oriental, Judaic and New Testamental influences,
and shows how mysticism was approached from three distinct angles: as
doctrine, as experience of being face to face with or in union with the
transcendent, and as a practical path to that achievement. The path itself
was seen since medieval times as leading through three stages: of
purification, unification and illumination. Towards the end the paper turns
to the vexed question of the ontological contents or otherwise of the
ultimate mystical experience and suggests possible lines of investigation of
this problem.
The next paper examines, in historical succession, schools of Indian
spirituality and shows how the basic pattern of doctrine, experience and
path can be identified, in different degrees of mutual proportion, in virtually
all of them. Next comes a research paper which analyses the oldest Vedic
evidence for the existence of an accomplished person outside the
mainstream of the Vedic tradition and finds that this often misunderstood
figure of a long haired wandering sage was indeed an ancient example of an
accomplished Yogi, the specificaly Indian variety of mystical achievement.
Even in the brief account of him in the single hymn analysed in the
paper a path is referred to, the experience is described in terms of being
penetrated by gods, illumination is also mentioned and purification can be
presupposed since the sage is described as a sweet and most uplifting
friend of all beings. His addressing of other people as mortals, thereby
implying his own immortality, points to elements of a doctrine which would
hardly have been put into any kind of clearly formulated shape in the
hymnic period, although even at that time some explanatory comments or
more extensive narratives must have accompanied the condensed messages
contained in the sacred poetry.
The following contribution first points out that the term mysticism, if
applied to the experience, must implicitly mean that there is in it
also knowledge. This goes against the prevailing Western notion of
mystical experience, because of its insistence that knowledge is the result of
sense perception plus reasoning. But in the mystical experience
of the ultimate equals full knowledge of the ultimate by higher perception.
It next contrasts the mystical, i.e. direct, knowledge with
ankaras rational approach to the ultimate knowledge and, in a courageous
PREFACE xv

sequence of arguments, finds him wanting in direct experience. The


inevitable conclusion seems to be that ankaras interpretation of the
ultimate reality in the sense of a radical monism is not based on
his knowledge of the ultimate but is a product of intellection based on
fallacious argumentation and supported by deliberately selective quotations
from the .
The paper of the Japanese contributor focuses on the mythological
features which inevitably creep in, with time, to embellish the birth stories
of accomplished teachers of mankind, and demonstrates them on the case of
the Buddha. This process of mythification could be regarded as an example
of the other, obscure or esoteric, meaning of the term mysticism, as
pointed out at the beginning of the introductory paper. But it can also be
looked upon as an expression of the mystical aspirations of masses of
followers to whom the individual mystical path appears unattainable and
who long for vicarious mystical fulfilment mediated by a pure being from
transcendental regions who descends to earth. An innovative solution to the
controversy about the nature of is suggested in the following well-
researched paper in the sense of viewing the experience in early
Buddhism as a mystical state of consciousness.
The study of St Teresa and Buddhaghosa which comes next is an
example of a methodologically sound and cautious approach to comparative
mysticism. Without in any way pursuing the notion of the identity of the
goal it irrefutably demonstrates step by step the structural similarities
between the spiritual paths of these two great figures, so remote from each
other in time and space. In fact the structural, though not terminological,
similarity between the two reaches even beyond the path into the realm of
the transcendent and its cognitive apprehension. Thus the paper, concerned
mainly with purification and only touching on unification, covers also the
stage of illumination. The next paper is the only one which was not
delivered at any of the ten Symposia commemorated, but at the thirteenth
one. It thus demostrates the continuity in the venture of the Symposia under
new conveners. It has been included here mainly because of its theme
demonstrating the extraordinary similarities between the mystical
experiences of St John of the Cross and St Teresa of Avila and those of
South Indian mystical poets Mahdev, and Mr B, with
references to mysticism and the Biblical Song of Songs.
Although the author has not written her paper with the threefold basic
pattern in mind, the doctrinal burden of theistic commitment on the part of
all the mystics discussed comes across very clearly, the mystical
experiences occupy the best part of the paper and the path is referred to
frequently. Full presentation of these constituents, particularly the
separation of the doctrinal component in the discussed mystics
interpretation of their experience, would require further detailed analysis as
would the threefold division of the path. In point of the final goal the author
xvi PREFACE

hints at an important, but not yet very much researched problem of tension
between liberation from or within . The next piece, also
comparative in nature, is a refreshingly controversial, non-academic, but
well-informed investigation of the value of Yoga and Jungs congenial
work in the context of modern life written by a professional man and one-
time mature student of Sanskrit who underwent Freudian psychoanalysis.
The modern Indian scene is represented by a paper which contrasts three
very different present-day mystics of India and seeks to find what they have
in common. In the point of doctrine, they represent a wide variety of
possible approaches, from conservative traditionalism to excessive
eclecticism, but they all stress the predominance of the experience, even
though achieved by a variety of methodical approaches or paths. The
threefold division, albeit not systematically demontrated by the author,
clearly applies to all of them, although the ambiguity and the marginal
character of the purificatory procedures in Rajneeshs case could alert us at
the outset to the problem of selection of examples for academic analysis of
mystical movements which can be reasonably regarded as genuine.
Academic impartiality cannot entirely do away with some kind of sifting
procedure which, of course, implies a certain value judgementa question
not directly tackled by the papers of this collection.
The book ends with an article which attempts to single out the
characteristic constituents of different approaches to the transcendental goal
within different religions and to make visible their overlaps, polarities and
contradictions by suggesting a model which would cover all mystical
traditions and enable their typology. Although the model had, by the
authors own admission, a long period of gestation, its presentation is
purely schematic or skeletal with examples presented in the form of
catchwords presupposing the readers broad acquaintance with the scene of
comparative religion ancient and modern. The authors expectation that
readers will be so taken by his model that they will by their own effort
supply the missing flesh on the skeleton is probably too optimistic, but to
anyone studying any system the model can become very useful as a tool for
the preliminary analysis of terms and concepts of that system and their
specific meaning within it.
1
MYSTICISM AS DOCTRINE AND
EXPERIENCE
Karel Werner

When writing about mysticism, it is still necessary first to explain what one
means by that expression. Some years ago Rufus M.Jones complained that
mysticism in common speech usage is a word of very uncertain
connotation.1 That this is still the case is well illustrated by the entry in The
Concise Oxford Dictionary which defines the term by deriving it from the
word mystic as noun, thus: one who seeks by contemplation and self-
surrender to obtain union with or absorption into the Deity, or who believes
in spiritual apprehension of truth beyond the understanding, whence -ism
m. (often derog.). The trouble is that the word mystic has also an adjectival
meaning, to quote again from the Dictionary, spiritually allegorical, occult,
esoteric; of hidden meaning, mysterious, mysterious and awe-inspiring.
The derivative noun mysticism apparently acquired some overtones
particularly from the area of occult sciences and hence its uncertain
connotation.
This difficulty with the word mysticism, though perhaps not peculiar to
English, is nevertheless not present in all languages. German for instance
has two expressions: der Mystizismus, which refers to occult pursuits of
all kinds, including those responsible for the Oxford Dictionarys bracketed
designation and die Mystik, which is reserved for mans bona fide
experiences of the divine or the ultimate reality, or at least for experiences
genuinely believed, by those who have had them, to have penetrated into
that dimension.
Why English has not produced a less ambiguous term for genuine
mystical pursuits is not easy to see, especially as England is not lacking in
authentic mystical tradition. As R. Otto once remarked when invited to
lecture on mysticism in this country, for a foreigner to come and tell an
English audience about mysticism was to bring owls to Athens (meaning
coals to Newcastle).2 Be that as it may, it will remain for some time
obligatory for every historian of religion dealing with the subject to attempt
to contribute to the clarification of the term.
Mystical writings are probably as old as writing itself, but writings on
mysticism are an innovation of this century, so the subject is young. It
2 WERNER

developed in the wake of the pioneering Gifford lectures on The Varieties


of Religious Experience given by William James in Edinburgh, 19012. It
is therefore not surprising that a general consensus on the scope, methods
and interpretation of research into mysticism has not yet emerged. However,
this is equally true of the study of religion as a whole and since it has not
prevented the history of religion or comparative religion from establishing
itself as a respectable academic discipline, it is clear that the study of
mysticism has a bright future despite inherent difficulties.
If we try to explain what mysticism is, we are immediately faced with the
fact that even within its genuine province the word has been used in more
than one sense. First, it designates what is described as a direct experience
of communion or union with the divine or ultimate reality or at least with
what is believed to be its dimension beyond the world of sense perception
and rational reflection. Second. it is frequently understood as a theological
or metaphysical doctrine, perhaps built around the experiences of a mystic
either by himself or others or both. Of these two components, experience is
primary while mystical doctrines, both philosophical and theological, in so
far as they can be distinguished from descriptive accounts of mystical
experience, are derivative. The third constituent of mysticism is the mystical
path, a certain way of life with incorporated spiritual training in
contemplation, designed to lead in stages to the realization of the mystical
goal. The mystical path may be based purely on a teachers experience and
described as such. More often, however, it is coupled with, or at least
described in terms of, metaphysical or religious doctrine.
The proportion in which the experiential and doctrinal components are
mixed in mystical writings varies and sometimes it is not easy to
disentangle them. Mystical writers in the past could not be expected to
point out the difference, since only very few were even aware of it; it is
only as a result of the modern psychological approach that the two
components are now widely recognized, although not always fully
respected and correctly applied. W. James did not himself deal theoretically
with this problem, but in his lecture on mysticism he was clearly interested
only in mystical experience as such and passed over the doctrinal elements
contained in the materials, which he quoted, without comment. But he
obviously understood the issue well. Within the field of religious studies the
distinction was clearly formulated by R.M. Jones, but he then partly
clouded the issue by his attempt to restrict the usage of the term
mysticism to the historic doctrine of the relationship and potential union
of the human soul with Ultimate Reality and to use the term mystical
experience for direct intercourse with God.3 It is this very statement of his
which is an illustration of the difficulty of distinguishing the two
components clearly and consistently. To say that mystical experience is
direct intercourse with God is already tantamount to imposing a theistic
interpretation on it. It is no wonder then that even present writers on
MYSTICISM AS DOCTRINE AND EXPERIENCE 3

mysticism, if committed to a particular doctrine, fail to make the distinction


and tend to produce classifications of mysticism based on preconceived
ideas and incorporating value judgements derived from personal belief or
preference.
One good example is R.H.Zaehner. A Roman Catholic, he regarded
genuine theistic mysticism as the highest attainment.4 Two other types,
monistic mysticism and pan-en-henic or nature mysticism (the two last
expressions standing for the more usually applied term pantheistic
mysticism) are at best stages on the way5 if not aberrations of the mind. In
fact, he suggested that monistic experience was the isolation of the
individual spirit from the psychophysical body which is mans mortal part
and since that would also mean isolation from God, it would be a state of
sin.6 The pan-en-henic experience he further explained as the reversion of
the individual soul to a state of original innocence (akin to Jungs collective
unconscious) and as such neither good nor evil, It would not produce
substantial change in man, but enhance only the good or bad qualities which
he already had.7
Without necessarily questioning the validity of Zaehners classification
of mystical experience into theistic, monistic and pantheistic, it is quite
clear that his interpretation of the varieties of mystical experience is guided
by his doctrinal allegiance. He did show a certain courtesy when he
admitted of genuine theistic mysticism even in Protestant Christianity and
also in Islam and Hinduism; Rmnujas theism particularly appealed to
him as being in agreement with Catholic mystical tradition. But his bias
was fully revealed when he stated that only Christians believed in the
highest mystical achievement called the Beatific Vision in which even
matter in the shape of the body will share in the general deification, and
God will be all in all (I Cor. XI, 28). In this point he was entirely wrong,
forgetting or ignoring the Mahyna goal of universal liberation down to
the last blade of grass and the Hindu expectation of universal salvation
under Kalki, the future saviour. These teachings have even found
philosophical expression in the work of Aurobindo who formulated the goal
as the spiritualization of the entire universe.8 Although few may be inclined
to say with F. Staal that Zaehners contribution is an unhappy medley of
dogmatism and emotionalism,9 the inherent bias of his work seriously
limited, if not entirely destroyed, its value and usefulness for the general
study of mysticism.
From the opposite side of the spectrum we can take the example of Ben-
Ami Scharfstein. Though not unsympathetic to mysticism, he apparently
does not accept it has any foundation in objective reality or possesses a
dimension of being of its own. Right at the start of his book he says: Seen
very broadly, mysticism is a name for our infinite appetitesless broadly,
it is the assurance that these appetites can be satisfied. Still less broadly, it
is some particular attitude towards reality and a view as to how someone
4 WERNER

or anyone can come into perfect contact with it. And mysticism is also, of
course, a name for the paranoid darkness in which unbalanced people
stumble so confidently.10 Here we can see how the ambiguity of the term
mysticism receives a further twist, covering for Scharfstein also the area of
mental aberration (hinted at, for different reasons, also by Zaehner, as we
have seen). Scharfstein later elaborates on this theme and practically
equates psychosis and the mystic state. Yet all is not lost, because: A
mystic who remains intellectually alert, will accompany his emotional
experience, as we may non-commitally call it, by persistent reasoning.11
Besides, psychosis is involuntary and inescapable while the mystic state
tends to be voluntarygiven a suitable training it can be entered and left
almost at will. The mystic does not suffer his internal ecstasy, infinity or truth,
but creates it.12 This is not just agnosticism, but a denial of the possibility
of any ontological basis for mystical experience. Like psychosis it is held to
be only a subjective state of mind and if an objective base to it can be found,
it will be physiological, in mans nervous system,
Scharfstein shares here the reductionist approach of some scientists to
psychological facts of experience. Unlike Zaehner he does not exactly
define his position, but even so he does not leave us in doubt about his
stance when he says: I myself dislike and prefer to explain away much of
mysticism, but it is in some way essential to us and it is too natively human
ever to die.13 His often witty and lighthearted yet penetrating remarks
make a sober summary of his actual views difficult, but I think that if we try
to produce one we shall find that his stance can be described as
evolutionary positivism and formulated thus: Emotional experiences have a
certain realistic value, though not a basis in objective reality, in so far as
they prove of assistance for the survival and evolution of the species. Thus
the human emotion of love secures, better than mere instinct, procreation
and the protracted care of offspring, enabling humans to develop higher
intelligence on maturity. The emotional experience of oneness could in this
way be interpreted as a future further stage of evolution which would
replace strife, a one-time stimulant of evolution which has become too
destructive, if mystical experience were to become an achievement of a
substantial part of mankind or at least of a large lite which could command
the respect of the rest.
Although this view incorporates a preconceived positivistic bias, it does
have a worthwhile implication, for if our summary of Scharfsteins line of
thought expresses correctly the logic of the positivistic approach, then
scientific and wider academic research interest must sooner or later include
mysticism not only as a phenomenon or an object of study, but also as a
method of research. In other words the researcher studying mysticism
would adopt some kind of mystical practice. This approach is also
advocated by Staal who says: The study of mysticism, to the extent that it
has so far been undertaken, resembles the sketching of a territory that is
MYSTICISM AS DOCTRINE AND EXPERIENCE 5

never visited and only described from hearsay.14 If mysticism is to be


studied seriously, it should not merely be studied indirectly and from
without, but also directly and from within. Without this provision it would
be like a blind man studying vision.15 I have expressed a similar view with
respect to Yoga when advocating for it, in the context of the modern world,
the status of a new field of inquiry both in scientific laboratories and in the
laboratory of the human mind, the latter implying the experimenters use
and application of the Yoga method on a personal basis, not only by the
study of its results on other subjects.16
All modern writers on mysticism include within its range traditions
belonging to different times and parts of the world. But its concept has been
formed in the context of European civilization which has its roots in ancient
Greece, drew substantially from Judaic tradition and was basically Christian
before it underwent the process of secularization. It is therefore inevitable
that in a paper like this one turns also to history.
The origin of mysticism has to be sought in the mystery cults of
prehistoric Greece which survived well into the historical period and
penetrated later into Rome. Since they were secret, not much is known
about them. But in general one can say that some kind of mystical
experience was evoked by rites of initiation into the mysteries and on
special occasions various ecstasy-inducing techniques were used such as
sacred movements and dances, recitations and enigmatic utterances. There
were also enactments of sacred events (mystery plays). The application of
these techniques was often preceded by periods of fasting and chastity.
There are also reports of individuals who achieved union with the deity
and the god, it was believed, spoke through them, giving prophecies.17
Besides the component of mystical experience and the methods of
bringing it about, the mysteries already had their doctrinal element also.
Since a fair deal is known about the mystery doctrines, they may not have
been as secret as the rites, if they were secret at all. While the initiatory rites
and ecstasy-inducing techniques probably relied also on the effect of
novelty, surprise and awe, the teachings provided the motivation for joining
the mystery movement, for undergoing purifications and perhaps for
adopting, temporarily or permanently, a stringent discipline in life. The
teachings of mysteries can be described as ethical, eschatological and
soteriological.18 In the atmosphere of lifes uncertainties in those rough
times and in the face of the gloomy prospects, in the then current Greek
religion, of a shadowy Hades after death, the outlook of rich rewards in the
afterlife, a favourable lot in future lives on earth and the possibility of final
rebirth into immortality represented highly desirable achievements,
attracting mentally alert candidates and furthering their experiences of
ecstasy during the sacred rites.
The exact state of elaboration of the mystery doctrines is not known, but
they influenced philosophers, some of whom were initiated and
6 WERNER

incorporated mystery doctrines into their teachings. As philosophy was not


yet a purely academic discipline they also lived it practically, sometimes
together with their disciples in monastic communities. Two pre-Socratics
have to be mentioned in this context. Pythagoras, who left Samos for
Crotona in southern Italy in 530 B.C., was described by B. Russell as a
combination of Einstein and Mrs Eddy. He was probably initiated into
Orphic mysteries and it may be worth mentioning that it was suggested that
he had come from India, his name being explained as a hellenization of the
Sanskrit pit gurus ( = father teacher).19 He was the contemporary of the
Buddha and one of his utterances, There are men and gods and beings like
Pythagoras,20 suggests that he regarded the expression Pythagoras as a
designation for a special category of beings rather than a personal name
which is reminiscent of the usage of the term buddha in the texts of both
early and Mahyna Buddhism. Several passages in the Buddhas discourses
related in the Pli Canon resemble the above statement. In one of them
(M 4, 36) when a priest who saw unusual signs about the Buddha asked if
he was a god, a man, a ghost etc., he answered each time in the negative. To
the direct question who, then, he was, he retorted he was a buddha
( = an enlightened one). Pythagoras taught metempsychosis as did the
Orphics as well as the Buddha and other Indian teachers. The soul fared
well or badly in the cycle of lives alternating between the underworld and
this world according to its moral merits and state of purity. Eventually
salvation could be won by bringing about complete harmony in the purified
soul by means of philosophical contemplation in which the perception of
harmony in music, in the cosmos and in mathematical relations played an
important part. Like the Buddha, and other Indian gurus, Pythagoras
founded a community of followers abiding by regulations designed to
facilitate a pure and contemplative life.
Empedocles of Agrigentum (c. 48323 B.C.), also an Orphic initiate,
apparently knew the teachings of Pythagoras. He regarded himself as a
fallen god who had had to go through various incarnations to regain the
divine status which he accomplished in his last life. His reported death in
the fiery Etna, though more spectacular, would be in keeping with the taste
of contemporary Indian saints, and particularly those of Jain persuasion, for
death in flames on reaching enlightenment and seeing their lifes task
accomplished (though some preferred starving to death). Empedocles does
not seem to have added anything substantially new to what we know of
Orphic and Pythagorian teachings, but he still makes an impressive figure.
Plato drew from all three mentioned sources.
Although we do not know whether Plato (427347 B.C.) was a practising
mystic, there was enough mysticism in his philosophy for it to become the
basis of medieval mystical doctrine. To what degree Socrates (469399 B.C.)
contributed to it is a long-standing problem, but he may himself have been a
practising mystic. He was known to enter into states of deep contemplation,
MYSTICISM AS DOCTRINE AND EXPERIENCE 7

lasting even for hours, in which he completely ceased to communicate with


his environment. Plato might have followed his teachers example, though
he would have done it less conspicuously.
The basis of the mystical doctrine which Plato provided was his vision of
a hierarchically ordered spiritual universe. The one ultimate reality was the
idea of good and below it, proceeding from one to many, are the other
subordinate ideas or forms, forces and laws of the ideal world of which the
phenomenal world of passing things and events is only a shadowy
reflection. Finding it difficult to express his system in precise terms, Plato
often resorted to poetical myths. Although his philosophy has endured for
centuries with many works written in its spirit or trying to explain it, it is
still poetry which even today is best able to convey to us the mystic flavour
of Platos philosophy, like Shelleys famous verse:

The One remains, the many change and pass;


The light of heavens abides, earths shadows fly;
Life, like a dome of many-coloured glass
Stains the white radiance of eternity21

Platos idea of the good as the absolute to which mens souls would aspire
and make cognitive approaches in contemplation did not prove sufficiently
evocative emotionally for the purpose of mysticism as practice. After all,
the mystery cults had always centred their rites and teachings around a god-
figure. But Olympic god-figures were becoming outdated and mystery
religions needed a more philosophical concept of god. This was provided,
paradoxically if not ironically, by Aristotle (38422 B.C.), for whom God
was a necessary deduction in his process of reasoning. Viewing the world
as real, he saw it as consisting of a hierarchy of actual substances which
required a prime mover to set and keep the world going. But being pure
form, God does not do the moving himself; he is the object of desire of
lower substances which move to achieve perfection since God is perfection
itself. Psychologically God seems to be something like pure mind and
contemplates his own perfection, which may also mean the perfection of all
things.22 Since there is something divine in man, man also has the
capacity for contemplation and can rise to the supreme act of vision
(theoria) akin to Gods, if he so chooses, for he is free and may determine his
own direction in life.23 It is clear that Aristotles theoria is far from what we
mean by theory today and it is difficult to imagine that he developed his
ideas about God purely by reasoning. I think that some measure of mystical
practice of contemplation must be assumed in his life. On the other hand, he
supplied all the rational arguments for the acceptance of the necessity of
God for many people throughout the centuries till the present day and
influenced in the same way also the mystical doctrine which enabled
8 WERNER

mysticism to flourish under dogmatic religous systems. Both Christianity


and Islam made use of this opportunity.
Mysticism furthermore profited from the vacuity of Aristotles idea of
God in a far superior way. It enabled advanced mystics to transcend the all
too concrete, even human features of the Christian God and allowed them
even in the climate of a strict theistic religion to point beyond the limiting
idea of a personal God through the method which became known as via
negativa. God is beyond the concrete and beyond the finite; any
characteristic ascribed to him would be a limitation; he is not this and not
that.
A further contribution to mystical teachings came from Stoicism in its
concept of an immanent Spirit present both in the world as its soul and in
man as a seed of God in his soul, but it was Neoplatonism which became
the real foundation of mysticism. Starting as a metaphysical teaching, it
became eventually a kind of magic religion, trying to rival Christianity. It
failed as religion, but won as philosophy, though translated into Christian
terms.24 The creator of the Neoplatonic system, Plotinus (A.D. 20370) is
reported to have travelled far into the East to familiarise himself with
Indian wisdom.25 The name of his teacher, Ammonios Sakkas, sounds like
a deliberate reversal of the name akyamuni (i.e. the sage from the akya
clan) under which the Buddha was known in India, to begin with outside
the circle of his followers and later also in the Mahyna sources.
In the teachings of Plotinus we again meet Platos hierarchical structure
of being, but it is expressed in a more systematic and conceptually more
accurate way, as is to be expected in post-Aristotelian times. At the top is
the One or Above-Being, at the bottom matter or non-being. Both are
unthinkable, indeterminable, formless, without quality and quantity, but the
One is perfect and dynamic, while matter is deficient and passive. Being is
a flow from Above-Being to non-being through three descending stages.
The first, that of the Spirit, is the intelligible world of pure forms, Ideas or
archetypes of things. The second is the stage of the soulthe world-soul
and individual souls. The third is the stage of nature, which receives life
from the world-soul, and of beings in the world of nature which receive life
from individual souls. As in all metaphysical teachings, the reason for the
process of emanation from Above-Being to non-being, the One to the
many, remains obscure, despite abounding explanations. But reasons for the
ascent to be desired are clear. The soul can sometimes look upwards, and
seeing the world of spirit realizes its condition as imprisonment in the body
and even becomes ashamed of the body. Since the One, frequently also
called God by Plotinus, is the centre of the soul, it is possible to find ones
way to it in ecstatic unification. According to Porphyry, Plotinus
experienced this state four times during his life. Before his death he said to
a friend he would try to achieve it for ever.
MYSTICISM AS DOCTRINE AND EXPERIENCE 9

Although Plotinus was occupied all his life in teaching and writing down
his philosophy, it was not for him an end in itself, but the way to the One.
Philosophical speculation was prompted and inspired by the One and was
therefore the starting point of the journey to it. The starting point of the
speculation itself is not arbitrary, but is determined, as Jaspers put it when
writing about Plotinus, by the experience of our reality. In the course of
speculative thinking based on our experience a process of transcending is
initiated so that thought approaches what can be called contemplation of the
archetypal or the spiritual. Eventually the mind arrives at contemplation of
the One and recognizes it as its origin and this fills it with joy.26 In this
interpretation we can see how the process of formulating a doctrine initiates
the mystical path and how the practical steps on, and the completion of, the
mystical path in turn inform the doctrine. Doctrine and experience go here
hand in hand and since the experience transcends the world of nature and
mere speculation, the concepts used for the doctrinal formulations become
more and more vacuous and the highest is called by the entirely
nondescriptive term the One.
Besides its links to Plato and Aristotle, the mystical system of Piotinus
has clear and congenial parallels only in India where the idea of the One
beyond being and non-being, from which emanate becoming and further
stages of manifested reality by virtue of its inner dynamism, was first
expressed in a hymn of the Veda (10, 129) before 1000 B.C.27 The
hierarchical structure of the existential planes of the spiritual and material
universe appears in different elaborations both in Hindu and Buddhist
systems and the One again reappears as the only truly existing reality called
brahman in Hindu Vedntism and nyat (emptiness or voidness) in
Mahyna Buddhism. Its experience reached in contemplation is described
as the unity of being, knowing and bliss by the former and as enlightenment
by the latter.
With Plotinus all that philosophy could do for mysticism had been done,
but most (though by no means all) people need religion to start them off and
Neoplatonism tried to meet this need, but it did it incongruously and
unsuccessfully. However, there was one great successor of Plotinus, namely
Proclus (A.D. 41085), important for the transmission of the system to
Christianity in a modified form. He described the emanation process from
the One to lower planes as proceeding in triads. As in Plotinus, the human
soul in Proclus view always has the choice open to it of withdrawing into
its inner sanctuary to find God, who is immanent to it though transcendent
to the world. He describes this experience as enthousiasmos, i.e. as being
possessed by God, and in the Socratic or Platonic way as a kind of divine
madness. Proclus directly influenced pseudo-Dionysius Areopagita
(c. A.D. 500), the father of Christian mysticism.
But before this, mystical tendencies of early Christianity, informed also
by the Judaic tradition which in turn drew at that time from Hellenistic
10 WERNER

sources, developed into what came to be known as mystical theology.


This term originally meant direct, secret and incommunicable knowledge of
God received in contemplation, as opposed to natural theology, the
knowledge of God obtained through creatures, and dogmatic theology,
the knowledge of God by revelation.28 We can, I think, understand mystical
theology as mystical experience developed in the context and therefore
interpreted in the light of dogmatic theology based on faith in a theistic
revelation. Theism can therefore be regarded as its doctrinal admixture.
Judaic mysticism goes back to the experiences of the prophets who
claimed direct communion with God. Psalms and other books of the Old
Testament are full of mystical allusions. However, by the time of Christ its
stream seems to have dried up and the mystical philosophy of Philo of
Alexandria (c. 20 B.C.A.D. 50) used Platonic inspiration to interpret Old
Testamental mystical experience and to explain philosophically the process
of creation. In it Logos is the mediator between God and man. Logos is the
divine power of creation, the idea of ideas, the paradigm and the archetype.
Having a double nature, Logos dwells in all single ideas of the ideal world.
which is in fact the mind of God who thinks those ideas, as well as in the
single things of the perceived world. Although an infinite power of an
infinite God, Logos is also a person, an archangel, the first-born son of God
and his agent in the world, acting as helper, advocate and intercessor of
men. Man is capable of contemplation when leading a quiet theoretical
life. Then he can obtain an inner revelation in mystical ecstasy which is
higher than Biblical revelation. In this ecstasy human consciousness is
darkened and even obliterated by the experience of the proximity of God or
even union with him. Philo influenced the developing Christianity and its
theology as well as mysticism. He was also, in a way, a predecessor of
Plotinus.
Like the prophets of Israel, Christ can be seen as a mystic who expressed
his experience of union with the ultimate reality in terms of his unity with
God as father. The experience of the presence of God appears to have been
a frequent phenomenon in the gatherings of early Christians and it can be
classified as mystical, though it was apparently the charismatic influence of
the person of Christ which prompted it rather than a doctrine and some special
method, prayer being the only preparation for it. St Pauls conversion
accompanied by a vision of light is another instance of spontaneous
mystical experience under the charismatic influence of Christs personality.
But as the Master became more remote in time, his charisma gradually lost
its immediacy and the time came when the Christian doctrine started taking
over and getting more elaborate. With it started also the mystical doctrine
and with it more definite forms of contemplation were now needed to bring
about the mystical experience. Some individuals with a strong mystical
sense followed a solitary ascetic path and founded the tradition of desert
hermits.
MYSTICISM AS DOCTRINE AND EXPERIENCE 11

The forming of mystical theology or the Christian way of mystical


experience crystallized in the atmosphere of Neoplatonic religion and
Gnostic teachings, but was firmly rooted in the Christian religion whose
foundation was faith. The idea of gnosis ( = knowledge) was developed in
conscious contradistinction to the phenomenon of strong religious faith
(pistis). This distinction was not clearly seen before and is even today
frequently obscured: believers often insist on having knowledge through
faith. But gnosis was understood as real knowledge like that gained by the
senses, albeit on a suprasensory level and concerning suprasensory matters.
It was also higher than knowledge gained by mere reflection or inference,
though reflection was used to formulate Gnostic teachings based on
suprasensory cognition. Christian mystical theology accepted much of what
was current in Gnosticism, but insisted on its foundation on the faith in
Christ as a starting point, its aim being a kind of Christ-experience as the
culmination of the mystic path.
The Christian mystic path was one of withdrawal from the world,
self-conquest and contemplation as defined by Clement of Alexandria
(c. A.D. 150215), the oldest-known writer on mystical theology. The
conquest of oneself is a way of negation and abstraction of all that is
material and personal and first it leads one into inner darknessthis image
is an echo from Philo and it was again used by pseudo-Dionysius and
reappeared centuries later in St John of the Cross as the dark night of the
soul. The experience of darkness, as Clement explains, is in fact a plunging
into the vastness of Christ and through it gaining knowledge of God, not as
he is, but as he is not. So God cannot be known, not even in contemplation,
during this life, but his image is sealed on the soul by the Son.29 Despite
Neoplatonic language and Gnostic reasoning, faith remained the pivot of
Clements approach. Like other patristic authors, he is not regarded
as a mystic, but rather as a writer on mystical theology.30 Origen
(c. A.D. 185254), however, was known to be dedicated to contemplation
and ascetisism and seems to speak from experience of rising to one
mystical and unspeakable vision and communion with God. He was also
credited with spiritual gifts like prophecy and other by-products of mystical
practice. The third century then saw a great flowering of contemplative
communities in the wake of St Anthony of Egypt, a great ecstatic.
Mention has also to be made of St Augustine (A.D. 354430) who is
often elevated for his strongly personal mystical passages. But strong faith
in scriptural revelation coupled with an extreme theological dogmatism
which pervades his main works overshadow his mystical experiences and
may not have allowed the mystic in him to develop fully. He formulated the
lethal dogma No salvation outside the Church and was the father of the
predestination doctrine.
The real beginning of the Christian mystical tradition is with pseudo-
Dionysius Areopagita (c. A.D. 500). He was probably a convert to
12 WERNER

Christianity who assumed the name of another famous convert, St Pauls


successor as bishop of Athens. His work shows that he had been educated in
late Neoplatonic philosophy as presented by Proclus. In his system God is
immanent (in all things) as well as transcendent (apart from all things) and
is of the nature of Trinity and reveals and manifests himself through the
heavenly hierarchy composed of three triads of Great Intelligences. He used
biblical names for them which started with Seraphim and ended with angels,
thus presenting to Christendom the Neoplatonic spiritual cosmos of Proclus
in the new terminology in which it was taken up centuries later by St
Thomas of Aquinas in his Summa Theologiae.
But higher than this assertive theology is, for Dionysius, the philosophical
knowledge of God from the order of the universe and through the process
of abstracting the notion of perfection from all the perfections of nature and
attributing it to God. Higher still is the philosophical process of analysis by
negation whereby God is understood conceptually as beyond concepts: He
is all in all things and nothing in none; and he is known through all things
and through none of them to none (De div. nom. VII, 3) are his almost Zen
style statements. But the highest and the only real knowledge of God is
through union in mystical vision. One ascends to it on the mystical ladder
through a darkness which is brighter than light: The super-unknown, the
super-luminous and loftiest height, wherein the simple and absolute and
unchangeable mysteries are cloaked in super-lucent darkness of hidden
mystic silence, which super-shines most super-brightly in the blackest night,
and, in the altogether intangible and unseen, super-fills the eyeless
understandings with super-beautiful brightness. (Myst. Theol. I.).
The subtle distinction made by Dionysius between the analytical
understanding of the mystical goal and its direct experience in mystical
vision is the most neglected instance of an early recognition of the
difference between mysticism as doctrine (however refined and
philosophically analytical) and mysticism as experience (expressible only in
approximation by the use of contradictory terms). Many medieval and
modern authors have blurred it. Zaehner ignored it, possibly because it was
denied by some dogmatic theologians, for whom analytical understanding
by negation is directly followed by faith, which is mystical enough in itself,
while full knowledge of God, as we saw in Clement, is possible only after
death. As to the mystic way, Dionysius gave the following advice which
also explains again, in different terms, the highest knowledge: in thy
intent practice of the mystical contemplations, leave behind both thy senses
and thy intellectual operations, and all things known by sense and intellect,
and all things which are not and which are, and set thyself, as far as may be,
to unite thyself in unknowing with him who is above all being and
knowledge, for by being purely free and absolute, out of self and of all
things, thou shalt be led up to the ray of the divine darkness, stripped of all
and loosed from all.
MYSTICISM AS DOCTRINE AND EXPERIENCE 13

Few writers have matched and hardly anybody has surpassed


pseudo-Dionysius. His works were translated into Latin in the ninth century
by John Scotus Erigena, himself a great mystic, but one of the greatest was
Master Eckhart (12601327) who described his mystical experiences as
transcending any theological ideas of God and Trinity, beyond which is
Godhead and higher still one faces nothingness. Summoned by the pope
John XXII he died on the way to Avignon. The pope then condemned a
number of propositions in his writings as heretical and others as rash and
suspect, saying of him that he had wished to know more than he should.
The dogmatic theology which had been systematized by St Thomas
Aquinas ruled supreme by then and although mystical theology was not
suppressed, any deviation in it from the accepted terminology and imagery
became dangerous. Great mystics hardly ever abandoned the view that
mystical contemplation led to direct knowledge superior to dogmatic
theological understanding, but some became more cautious, using carefully
chosen Christian imagery and biblical terminology in a figurative sense. A
good example is St John of the Cross. Others, like Master Molinos, suffered
at the hands of the Inquisition.
This situation created a whole new problem with regard to mystical
language. One has now to admit that an authors description of his mystical
experience may be free from doctrinal bias even if he uses the terminolgy
of dogmatic theology and biblical imagery so that careful interpretation or
translation into uncommitted language becomes necessary. On the other
hand the author may be a believer in the literal meaning of the Churchs
teaching in which case his account of mystical experience is not
descriptive, but interprets it in the light of the doctrine, perhaps without
realizing it, And he may, as a result of his belief in a dogma, stop short of
the final mystical realization.
Two examples may illustrate this problem:
The whole mystical tradition points to the final mystical achievement as
unification with the goal. The mystical path which was gradually elaborated
until it appeared formulated in three stages, starts with via purgativa which
means purification of the heart, reflected in conduct, and of the mind, which
is freed from the shackles of the sensory world, proceeds through via
illuminativa, an act of inner cognition even though often described as
occurring through a cloud of unknowing, and culminates in via unitiva,
the final cognitive-cum-ontic, subjectless and objectless experience of
oneness with the ultimate. Eckhart says: When I attain this blessedness of
union, then all things are in me and in God, and where I am there is God,
and where God is, there am I.31 St John of the Cross could not use such
open language and resorted to erotic biblical imagery from the Song of
Songs:
14 WERNER

Oh night that was my guide!


Oh darkness dearer than the mornings pride,
Oh night that joined the lover
To the beloved bride
Transfiguring them each into the other.32

The inevitable conclusion is that one gets to know God by becoming God
or by being directly and intimately united with him.
The other example is from St Gregory the Great (A.D. 540604):
The soul beholds something beneath His brightnessnot that which God
is, but that which is under HimLight cannot be seen as it is. If the mind
could not see it at all, it would not even see that it is afar off; and if it
perceived it perfectly, it would not see it as though through darkness.
Therefore, because it is not altogether seen, nor againaltogether unseen, it is
rightly said that it is seen from afar. (Morals on Job XXXI, 101)33 The
passage seems authentic enough to reveal a mystic, but St Gregory had
papal responsibilities for the multitudes of believers in theological dogmas
and he already held the dogma which ruled out the possibility of seeing God
in this life. The question now is: did the pope interpret the mystics highest
experience in the light of the dogma or did the doctrinal stricture held by
the pope impede the mystics progress to the final stage of via unitiva? The
quoted passage does look like a description of via illuminativa. This raises a
further important question for the comparative study of mysticism, namely
that of the stages of mystical experience and their identification in different
mystical authors within one tradition as well as in different traditions.34
The richness of the stream of European mysticism continued for several
centuries, also in Protestant Christianity and, of course, from early times it
has been abundant in Eastern Christendom. It seems to have subsided in more
recent times, but it has by no means dried up. Accounts of mystical
experience in our time are being collected and some remarkable reports
have also come out of Eastern Europe, particularly from Soviet labour
camps.35 Material for research will probably never be in short supply. But
what general conclusions can we draw from this examination?
First, I think, it is clear that there is nothing specifically European and
Christian about mysticism as such. Its beginnings in the twilight of Greek
history may point to its even older origin in Indo-European antiquity, which
would explain the developed Indo-ryan mysticism in the Vedas and the
fact that traces of mysticism can also be detected in other less-documented
areas of Indo-Euorpean tradition. But the fact that mystical trends can be
found also in different cultures of the Semitic group, to say nothing of the
Chinese example, points clearly to the universality of the phenomenon of
mysticism. Of the Semitic traditions the Judaic one contributed substantially
to the formation of the European form of mysticism, but other traditions had
MYSTICISM AS DOCTRINE AND EXPERIENCE 15

undoubtedly their say as well. Mutual influence can be clearly observed at


different times and can be assumed to have been stronger and more far
reaching than the available historical evidence for it suggests, particularly
between Hellenistic and Oriental, and here chiefly Indian, traditions.
Christian mysticism is therefore a direct outcome of a merger between the
Judaic and Hellenistic streams, with a rivulet coming from India, and
enlivened by the mystical dimension in Christs mission and in the early
Christian communities. European mysticism only illustrates the universality
of mysticism as a human experience.
Second, we can see that despite doctrinal and terminological differences
there is common core to mystical experiences, although room is left for a
variety of accompanying phenomena, such as concrete visions or unusual
powers, hardly touched upon in this paper. The common core appears to be
the experience of union or oneness with the ultimate reality which is beyond
any conceptual grasp and is therefore called by conceptually vacuous
expressions or by the religious expression God which suggests the idea of
an infinite person incorporating all perfections. Some doctrinal and
terminological differences are also caused by misjudging the stages of
attainment and their different demarcation and assessment. In addition there
are problems connected with the types of language used and the reasons,
conscious or otherwise, for using a particular type of language.
Third, there appears to be a remarkable degree of agreement over the
general outlines of the mystic way, while concrete techniques for entering
the state of contemplation may be variegated.
If all these factors are taken into account, it seems to me that an identity
of purpose and of final realization in the developed mystical traditions of
the world can be assumed. One important point still to be considered is that
of the ontological contents or otherwise of the ultimate mystical experience.
I think that there are two pitfalls here which an historian of religion should
avoid. The first is that of creating another mystical doctrine, which
nowadays would probably mean adopting and perhaps modifying an
existing one. As a good example we can point to the work of W.F. Stace.
Using the combined methods of comparative religion and philosophical
analysis, he put forth a version of pantheism as the metaphysical doctrine
best suited to describe the ontological basis of mystical experience.36 As
such it may have its merits while at the same time being open to various
criticisms,37 but it has no chance of being adopted by a majority let alone
all of those concerned with research into mysticism because, as a definite
theory, it may limit in certain ways the approach to research.
The second pitfall would consist in accepting a theory from another field
of learning, such as science, which would have an even more detrimental
effect. (The social sciences have suffered from this mistake.) What I have in
mind is scientific positivism, which uses reductionist methods of
interpretation. It would make mystical experience into an epiphenomenon
16 WERNER

of human emotional life which in turn is derived from the biology of the
nervous system and it would be denied any possibility of objective
reference or ontological validity. This is Scharfsteins position, referred to
earlier. There are rival theories in sciences also, and further reduction
brings biological forces down to the level of physical forces to which alone
is ascribed true reality. (This picture of a mechanisitic universe frightens
even some scientists back into adopting, sometimes only privately, a
traditional religious faith. The more thoughtful ones embark on the study of
philosophy or Eastern mysticism.)
The room for manoeuvre between these two pitfalls is very small and the
task of working out an acceptable position which would be a
methodological help is a formidable one. I would like to formulate a few
suggestions outlining the general direction in which a solution could be
sought:
1. There is an ontological basis to mystical experience which is also, in
various symbolical disguises, the object of religious faith as well as of
philosophical quest.
2. Mystical experience is a suprasensory and supraintellectual, i.e.
intuitive, apprehension of that ontological reality and it proceeds in stages of
approximation, culminating in cognitive experience of being ontologically
united with it.
3. Conceptual descriptions of the ultimate mystical experience are
inadequate and provide only partial impressions of its ontological basis,
never a global view. When guided by an analytical approach they are
without contents, suggesting voidness or nothingness, while
psychologically the experience has fullness of contents describable in terms
of being, knowledge or intelligence and bliss.
4. The dimension of the ultimate reality is beyond the world of external
objects and its counterpart, mans sensory apparatus with its co-ordinating
intellect, and is therefore transcendent, while the experience of union with
it is reached through the process of inner cognition which gives it the
character of immanence.
5. Metaphysical descriptions of the ultimate reality, when informed by an
analytical approach, ascribe to it the character of impersonality; when
guided by the psychological contents of the ultimate experience of fullness,
they suggest a superstructural unit not dissimilar, though vastly superior, to
the human personality; in religious terms it becomes the infinite personality
of God. The ultimate ontological dimension may therefore unite
dichotomies which on the level of intellectual understanding remain
contradictory.38 (This happens to be a feature not altogether unknown to
modern science, particularly to subatomic physics.)
6. Since the practical mystical paths as developed by different traditions
show a remarkable structural unity, experimental application of mystical
techniques should be possible, especially where a high degree of doctrinal
MYSTICISM AS DOCTRINE AND EXPERIENCE 17

neutrality has been achieved as in some forms of Indian Yoga. It is


therefore desirable to include this approach along with current methods of
research into mysticism.

NOTES

1 Encyclopaedia of Religions and Ethics 113, ed. J.Hastings,


Edinburgh 190826, vol. 9, p. 84.
2 Rudolf Otto: The Idea of the Holy, the authors Introduction to the 1st
English ed. (Oxford 1923; German 1st ed. 1917), Harmondsworth
1959, p. 11.
3 ERE, vol. 9, pp. 845.
4 R.C.Zaehner, Mysticism Sacred and Profane, Oxford, repr. 1967
(1st ed. 1957), pp. 184 & 204.
5 Ibid., p. 168.
6 Ibid., p. 206.
7 Ibid., p. 104.
8 Karel Werner, Yoga and Indian Philosophy, Delhi, repr. 1980
(1st ed. 1977), pp. 8991,
9 Fritz Staal, Exploring Mysticism, Harmondsworth 1975, p. 75.
10 Ben-Ami Scharfstein, Mystical Experience, Oxford 1973, p. 1.
11 Ibid., p. 26.
12 Ibid., p. 160.
13 Ibid., p. 169.
14 Staal, op. cit., p. 18.
15 Ibid., p. 125.
16 Werner, op. cit., p. 178.
17 Cf. Johannes Leipoldt, Von den Mysterien zur Kirche, Leipzig 1961,
pp. 550. For the nature of the mystery plays cf. K.H.E.de Jong, Das
antike Mysterienwesen, Leiden 1919 (2nd ed.), and De Apuleio
Isiacorum mysteriorum teste, Leiden 1901. For the wider context cf.
John Pollard, Seers, Shrines and Sirens, London 1965.
18 Cf. M.Hadas and M.Smith, Heroes and Gods, New York 1965, p. 38,
and S.Angus: The Mystery Religions and Christianity, London 1925,
pp. 5067.
19 Hadas and Smith, op. cit., p. 42.
20 Bertrand Russell, History of Western Philosophy, London 1946, p. 51.
21 R.S.Brumbaugh, The Philosophers of Greece, London 1966, p. 158.
22 Ibid., p. 195.
23 Rufus M.Jones, Studies in Mystical Religion, London 1918, p. 68.
24 Ibid.. p. 79.
25 Karl Jaspers, The Great Philosophers, London 1966 (German ed.
1957), vol. 2, The Original Thinkers, p. 38.
26 Cf. Jaspers, op. cit., chapter on Plotinus.
18 WERNER

27 Karel Werner, Symbolism in the Vedas and its Conceptualisation,


Numen, vol. XXIV (1977), fase. 3, pp. 22340. A revised version is
in preparation for the second collection of papers from Symposia on
Indian religions which will be concerned with Symbolism.
28 J.Chapman in ERE, vol. 9, p. 90.
29 Ibid., p. 91.
30 R.M.Jones, op. cit., p. 83.
31 Ibid., p. 233.
32 St John of the Cross, Poems, with a translation by Roy Campbell,
Harmondsworth, repr. 1968, p. 27. The translation is misleading to a
degree, because it suggests complete mutual identity of the soul and
God on an equal level. The original, however, is rather more
cautious:

Oh noche, que juntaste


Amado con amada,
Amada en el Amado transformada!

33 ERE, p. 94.
34 Peter G.Moore, Recent Studies of Mysticism, Religion, vol. 3
(1973), part 2, pp. 14656. See pp. 1534.
35 Mihajlo Mihajlov, Mystical Experiences of the Labour Camps,
Kontinent 2, The Alternative Voice of Russia and Eastern Europe,
London 1978, pp. 10331.
36 W.T.Stace, Mysticism and Philosophy, London 1961, pp. 24050.
37 Moore, op. cit., pp. 14950.
38 Werner, Symbolism in the Vedas, pp. 22930.
2
MYSTICISM AND INDIAN
SPIRITUALITY
Karel Werner

Although the term mysticism is of Western origin, it has been used in the
context of Indian spiritual tradition both by European and Indian authors,
often without any attempt to define it. This is perhaps because there is, after
all, a certain broad consensus about its meaning among most scholars
concerned with religious studies despite the ambiguity of the term as it is
frequently exhibited in its popular usage and sometimes also in academic
works: we have seen on previous pages how broadly the term is employed
for example by Scharfstein.
For the purposes of this survey, however, I shall adhere to the
understanding of mysticism as it follows from the results of the
investigations in my introductory paper. In particular, I shall look at the
mystical dimension in Indian spiritual traditions from the angle of the
division of its endeavours and results into the previously discussed three
categories of doctrine, experience and path.
Furthermore I regard the threefold division of the mystical progress and
experience into the three stages as the path of purification of the heart (via
purgativa,) the path of illumination of the mind (via illuminativa) and the
path of unification of the mystic with the goal of his efforts (via unitiva) as
both useful for the purpose of theoretical study and universally valid across
the boundaries of cultures and traditions because, on analysis, all the three
components can be found in developed mysticism of any religious system.
The usefulness of the threefold division into doctrine, experience and
path lies especially in its hermeneutical value: it enables the scholar as
someome standing outside a particular mystical tradition or movement to
assess its basic nature and find out which of the three elements predominates
in it and then formulate his interpretations accordingly.
The universal applicability of this threefold division points to another
important conclusion, namely that one can assume that all mystical or
deeper spiritual systems possess a certain structural correspondence and
most likely also an identity of purpose and final goal.
From the study of various religious systems it further seems to follow that
mysticism is the heart of every developed religion lending it the dimension
20 WERNER

of depth. It is almost always possible to trace the beginning of a religious


tradition to mystical experiences of its founder(s). In the course of the
subsequent development of a given religious tradition its mystical
dimension may go through times when it is at a low ebb, but if it disappears
entirely to become only a vestige of the past, the religious tradition in
question is in a crisis and may be in danger of perishing entirely.
India offers us an example of religious development whose phases are
marked by the emergence of ever-renewed mystical experiences, ever
freshly formulated mystical doctrines and periodically reformulated
mystical paths. In that respect the Indian religious history provides us with a
very vivid and concrete illustration of the above thesis about the
universality of mysticism and its overall structural unity across cultural
boundaries.
The earliest highly-developed and well-studied stage of Indian religious
development is the Vedic religion and we must, naturally, look for its
mystical dimension. The nature of the Vedic mystical dimension has been,
however, seriously undervalued. Thus S.N. Dasgupta who produced one of
the earliest collections of studies of Hindu mysticism dealt with the Vedic
period under the heading Sacrificial Mysticism.1 To him mysticism in the
Vedas is what surrounds their sacrificial rituals which have a mysterious
link to cosmic forces and human events. Correctly performed rituals can
manipulate those forces for the advantage of the individual.
If we bear in mind the double meaning of the term mysticism as it was
explained at the beginning of the previous paper, then we shall see that
S.N.Dasgupta uses it here obviously in its wider sense which of course may
include the magic of ritual performances. He may have done so more or less
unwittingly without being fully aware of the double meaning of the term.
But all subsequent instances of Hindu mysticism he deals with in his book,
starting with the peak achievements of the , are examples of
mysticism in the narrower or proper sense of the word. And so one would
have expected him to search in the Vedas at least for some kind of
beginnings of what only a few centuries later surfaced as a highly-
developed and truly mystical approach.
But S.N.Dasgupta apparently looked upon the Vedas through the eyes of
the early European scholarship which undervalued the depth of the Vedic
spirituality and saw the Vedas as merely a compendium of sacrificial lore,
regarding their more obviously non-ritual and valuable hymns at best as
iyrical nature poetry.2
It is, of course, true that many Vedic hymns have ritualistic links with the
sacrifice which was a major or even the central concern of the Brahminic
religion in the later Vedic period, but the original inspiration behind the
hymns of the RV was of a much deeper nature. The bulk of them originated
before the era of the elaborate ritual practices anyway and although they were
MYSTICISM AND INDIAN SPIRITUALITY 21

later used and sometimes further adapted for ritual, their original purpose
was spiritual.
In all high religions the ritualistic and ecclesiastical phase of their history
followed the original spiritual beginnings of a movement which formed
around or in the wake of a teacher who was a prophetic figure or a
spiritually enlightened personality, sometimes regarded as an incarnation of
God. Sometimes, as in Judaism, the original spiritual message was
transmitted in stages by a series of prophets who claimed to have been
called to carry out their mission directly by God who revealed his will
through them.
There is no reason why the beginnings of the Vedic religion should be
looked upon in a different way and regarded as an outcome of poetic
inspiration by natural forces with some primitive and sacrificial magic
thrown in and nothing else. The later Hindu tradition has always claimed
that the Vedas are a product of divine revelation which was transmitted to
their ancestors by ancient seers ( ) Certain were already in Vedic
times legendary ancient figures and were looked upon as path-finders
(RV 1, 72, 2; 1, 105, 15) who had won immortality and thereby become
equal in status and power to gods (RV 10.54, 4).3 They reached the heights
of immortality through the development of a special faculty of a visionary or
mystical and meditative character called dhti to whose investigation Gonda
dedicated a whole book.4 This mystical vision enabled the ancient seers to
discover and grasp the substance and meaning of the eternal law ( cf. RV
4, 23, 8) governing the whole of manifested reality as well as its emergence
from the unmanifest.5
In the process of transmitting this vision of the eternal law to their less
spiritually minded contemporaries, the seers produced their message on
more than one level.6 The transmission of a vision is not the vision itself, it
is a projection of the original vision into a specific area of human activity
and understanding. Besides the poetical, mythological and legendary
projections of this vision there was also the area of religious activity which
was very close to the heart of archaic man and was capable of exercising a
strong influence on his character and behaviour, much more so than words,
images and stories. This was ritual action. In performing a rite modelled on
mythical or cosmic events Vedic man was able to take in into himself
archetypal patterns of thought and behaviour which reflected the hierarchy
of the world order and created in him a sense of belonging and an
awareness, however dim, that the cosmic law was also the moral law which
told him what was right and wrong and that it further was also the social law
which determined his place in the structure of the ryan society.
It was only later in the course of several centuries that Vedic ritual
deteriorated into an over-elaborated system of ceremonial observances of
the late Vedic or period in which the original mystical vision
became buried. We can certainly discern evidence in many Vedic hymns
22 WERNER

for genuine mystical experiences of the ancient seers which became the
basis and starting point of the Vedic religion. It is also sufficiently obvious
that for some generations this tradition of mystical approach and cultivation
of mystical experiences was kept alive. What is more difficult is to establish
the existence of a mystical doctrine in Vedic times since that would require
the existence also of systematic expositions and interpretations of those
mystical experiences in the context of a philosophical or theological world
picture expressed in conceptually understandable terms.
However, although the language of the Vedas is poetical, symbolical and
mythological and the hymns do not aim at systematic instruction of
listeners, they nevertheless do convey a certain sufficiently clear world view
if not a systematic doctrine. They allow us to glimpse the Vedic mans
picture of an ordered universe with a vast spiritual dimension behind it. That
is expressed repeatedly by Vedic cosmogonic myths of creationthat of
the goddess Aditi, mother of all that is, has been and will be (RV 1, 89, 10),
that of the cosmic or the giant cosmic person (RV 10, 90), of
or the cosmic golden germ (RV 10, 121), of skambha, the
cosmic pillar or axis mundi (AV 10, 7) and that of the combat,
symbolizing the victory of cosmic creation over the dark demon of
stagnation, which is referred to many times throughout the Vedas. This view
of the world and its origins was later also expressed in terms almost devoid
of mythological imagery in the so-called hymn of creation (RV 10, 129)
whereby began the process of conceptualization of the Vedic vision of
reality which then continued in the and eventually produced fully
formulated mystical doctrines and philosophical systems.7
The existence of a path to immortality is quite clearly mentioned in
connection with the ancient seers who had found it, as quoted above. Once
found it must undoubtedly have been handed down and taught in some way
by the pathfinder seers to their disciples and this process would certainly
have gone on for a number of generations. The actual method can hardly be
ascertained from the hymns, but one could say with Aurobindo that it must
have been some kind of progressive self-culture and assume with Hauer
that it comprised some technique of meditative absorption.8 A personal
discipline and meditational practice have been the pillars of the mystic way
in all times and all traditions.
When eventually the elaborate structure of brahminic ritualism which
grew around and out of the original mystical vision of the ancient seers very
nearly stifled all spirituality there came a new eruption of
mystical experience which is documented in the . The approach
to the transcendent through the worship of gods was largely brushed aside
and a direct encounter with the ultimate reality was sought. In the final
break-through it amounted to an overwhelming and all-embracing
experience expressed in bold statements such as I am brahman (aham
brahmsmi, BU 1, 4, 10). you are that, (tat tvam asi, CU 6, 15, 3) and I am
MYSTICISM AND INDIAN SPIRITUALITY 23

all this ( = this whole universe: aham evedam sarvam, CU 7, 25, 1). This
certainly appears to be a genuine expression of an experience of unio
mystica if ever there was one. It came as a culmination of a search which
involved both intellectual questioning and a strong emotional need for
security and certainty in face of an uncertain world in which man was the
victim of successive deaths. As a result the final experience found a ready
expression in what we can classify as the metaphysical gnosticism of the
. The philosophical search progressed far enough by then to be able
to supply adequate and appealing metaphysical terms to the mystic to
express himself when his experience overwhelmed him and also to the
thinker when he later tried to express his mystical experience in a more
systematic and intellectually graspable way.
As is well known, this search proceeded first into the cosmic dimension
and its inspiration must have been derived from the distant echoes of the
Vedic cosmogonical mythology, all pointing in the direction of the original
unity as the source of the cosmic diversity. That unity, which was
understood to be the source and the directing agency of everything that is,
was called by Yjavalkya, at a certain stage, the imperishable (
BU 3, 8, 811), but eventually it obtained the name brahman which became
universally accepted.
When the line of inquiry turned from the cosmic perspective to the inner
dimension of mans own personality, brahman was found again lurking
behind all life functions and mental faculties, behind the mind and behind
the heart (BU 4, 2, 17). And in the course of further search it was
eventually discovered to be mens very essence, his inner self (tman, BU 4,
2, 4,). This was a great discovery which was new to most participants in the
dialogues of the older , but it was readily accepted. The great
unborn tman, the inmost self of man, was identical with brahman, the
source and essence of the whole of universe as well as all beings and
things.
One could argue that this identification was first achieved as a result of a
philosophical speculative process which was then translated into
contemplative mystical experience, or one can take the opposite view and
regard the experience of the unio mystica as primary and as preceding the
conceptual understanding which followed only afterwards and led to the
brahman-tman doctrine in its familiar formulation. It is, of course, equally
possible that the two went together. My impression is that the experience
which prompted the three statements quoted above preceded the conceptual
elaboration and understanding of the doctrine of unity. In any event, in the
early we have, for the first time and side by side, both the
experience and the doctrine and we have here, also for the first time, a clear
formulation of the ontological nature of the final experience of the
true knowledge of the ultimate: to know brahman is to be brahman
(MuU 3, 2, 9). True knowledge is here understood as being beyond the
24 WERNER

senses and the intellect. It is a non-dual, unmediated process of knowing,


without the split between object and subject.
The are also very keen on transmitting this true and higher
knowledge, this non-dual state of being-cum-knowing which is, besides,
also the only true bliss (BU 7, 23) and making it available to truth seekers.
And so we get in them also the first formulation of a path to realization. It is
said, however, that it is a difficult path (KaU 1, 3, 14), because it leads
away from the senses and goes inward (KaU 2, 1, 1). As such it is a path of
renunciation and Yoga. The word Yoga appears here for the first time in its
fully technical meaning, namely as a systematic training, and it already
received a more or less clear formulation in some other middle
beside KaU such as vetvatara and Maitr. Further process of the
systematization of Yoga as a path to the ultimate mystic goal is obvious in
subsequent Yoga and the culmination of this endeavour is
represented by Patajalis codification of this path into a system of the
eightfold Yoga. Thus all the three ingredients of mysticism emerged out of
the several centuries earlier than in Europe.
Simultaneously with the development described so far there was another,
largely independent, process of search going on outside the well-
documented Vedic tradition. Although this independent process has not left
behind its own literary sources, there is enough evidence from indirect
sources to leave us in little doubt that at the time of the early and
early Buddhism this outsiders stream of spiritual quest was already very
old. This is particularly clear from the Pli Canon of Buddhism. But how
far into the past it reaches cannot be ascertained. It is certainly not possible
to speculate about its existence at the time of the ancient seers, the path-
finders and originators of the Vedic lore, who were themselves already
legendary when the hymns as known to us were actually being composed.
However, at the later Vedic time, before the final redaction of the RV, there
is good evidence about non-Vedic accomplished sages, conspicuous by
their nakedness and long hair, roaming the country and teaching their path
of the wind. They were known as munis and keins and regarded
themselves as immortals who were equally at home in the higher spiritual
world and in this world of mortals, celestial beings and sylvan beasts. The
next paper is dedicated to the analysis of the hymn of the Long-haired One
and his status with respect to mysticism and Yoga.
Besides keins there were other wanderers, some of them of the solitary
type, known as vrtyas, regarded by Hauer as the original Yogis (Uryogins)9
The tradition of wandering ascetics, later known as outside the
Vedic and Brahminic establishment continued for centuries in relative
obscurity while ceremonial religion flourished. But it was obviously
gradually gaining more recognition and power of attraction for those who
became weary of Brahminic sacrificial ritualism and sought some clearer
solution of the riddle of existence. As the Vedic tradition preserved the
MYSTICISM AND INDIAN SPIRITUALITY 25

memory of the accomplished of old, so this unorthodox


movement harboured memories of enlightened munis of the past. It was
not, of course, a unitary movement. It was rather a broad trend manifesting
itself in individual truth-seekers and teachers with groups of followers
around some of them. This trend eventually reached its peak in the great
achievement of Buddhism and also of Jainism and other minor schools of
Yoga, now mostly forgotten. The memory of two of them has been
preserved in the Pli Canon in connection with the Buddhas life story.
Some might object to regarding the Buddhist (and possibly also Jainist)
top achievement of as mystical whilst admitting to the mystical
character of jhnic states of mind. But this is only a terminological
problem. Maybe it is not correct to speak about unio mystica when
describing the attainment of in early Buddhism since the term
originated in the context of theistic theology. But both terms point to the
highest achievement of what is seen as the ultimate reality in the two
respective systems. In both cases it is also admitted that the designation of
the goalGod, does not really convey the true nature of the
ultimate reality which is felt to be beyond description and, as I already tried
to explain elsewhere,10 beyond the conceptual dichotomy of the personal
and impersonal.
If we agree that the goal of mysticism is the final and ultimate truth
achieved by direct experience, then the of Buddhism falls within
that heading. When C.A.Keller tried to define mystical writings he arrived
at a criterion for them by saying that they are texts which discuss the path
towards realisation of the ultimate knowledge which each particular religion
has to offer and which contain statements about the nature of such
knowledge.11 F.J.Streng defined the meaning of mysticism as an interior
illumination of reality that results in ultimate freedom.12 Both these
definitions include the Buddhist .
Of the three constituents of mysticism, experience is the one most
emphasized and the path the one most elaborated in early Buddhism. The
doctrine on the other hand was kept low. The Buddha avoided doctrinal
formulations concerning the final reality as much as possible in order to
prevent his followers from resting content with minor achievements on the
path in which the absence of the final experience could be substituted by
conceptual understanding of the doctrine or by religious faith, a situation
which sometimes occurs, in both varieties, in the context of the Hindu
systems of doctrine. One can, of course, maintain that there is an implicit
doctrine contained also in the Buddhas teachings and there has been no
shortage of explicit expositions of what their authors have understood to be
the actual doctrine of early Buddhism about the ultimate goal of .
Such attempts are no doubt perfectly legitimate, because there certainly is a
definite world-view contained in the Buddhas teachings, although it is not
easy to formulate it in a way which would not immediately invite objections
26 WERNER

from one or another quarter of both the scholarly interpreters of Buddhism


and its followers.
The peak achievements of the and Buddhist mysticism were
truly litist, yet they also had popular appeal even though they were out of
reach of most people, because of most peoples lack of total practical
commitment. But the best minds among the earnest truth-seekers of the
time were attracted by them, because they appreciated the promise of a
relatively speady realization of the goal. This was made possible by the
careful concentration of Buddhism and the various Yoga movements on the
elaboration of the path. This feature which is prominent in most schools of
Indian mysticism accounts for the unique form of mysticism which only
India produced, namely for Yoga. The Buddhas eightfold path and
Patajalis yoga are the two most highly systematized techniques of
mystical training and this is what characterizes Yoga most. Systematization
of techniques and methods is also an important feature of modern scientific
procedures and so one can almost say that Yoga, as a methodical device, is
mysticism gone scientific.
Patajalis system is unthinkable without Buddhism. As far as its
terminology goes there is much in the Yoga Stras that reminds us of
Buddhist formulations from the Pli Canon and even more so from the
Sarvstivda Abhidharma and from Sautrntika. So while containing a
complete systematization of Yogic (mystical) experience from initial stages
to the highest point of final liberation (kaivalya,) the Yoga Stras are
almost as cagey about spelling out a doctrine as early Buddhism. Unlike
with Buddhism, however, few attempts have been made to formulate, from
within the Yoga Stras, a specific doctrine which may have been Patajalis
or which may have been held in the various Yoga circles from which he, or
the redactors of the Yoga Stras hiding behind his name, drew their
materials. Instead, later commentators like Vysa interpreted the doctrine
that may be implicit in the Yoga Stras in terms of philosophy.
They were followed by many modern interpreters, quite unjustifiably, since
classical was formulated several centuries after Patajali so that
any analysis of the relation between the doctrine and the implicit
Patajalis doctrine would have to be preceded by a reconstruction of the
likely state of the teachings at a time of the composition of the
Yoga Stras.13
Despite the highly litist character of the goal of Yoga and the exclusivity
of its methods, its wide appeal continued. What was attractive to many
about it was that it was an individual achievement which did not require the
mediation of priests with their endless and expensive ceremonies. It usually
necessitated just a special relation to a spiritually advanced teacher. In rare
instances one could hope to find an accomplished master as ones guide.
Such was the reputation of the Buddha with many followers and also of Jina
and some other less-known spiritual teachers.
MYSTICISM AND INDIAN SPIRITUALITY 27

In this atmosphere it eventually came to a wide popularization of Yoga


which inevitably meant a certain modification of its previous methodical
and impersonal approach and of its minimal doctrinal involvement. With
popular following there arose the need to satisfy the emotional allegiance
people normally have to the transcendent, represented as a personal God, in
the context of religious observance. This found its natural expression in the
theistic type of mysticism which thus opened the gate to some kind of
direct experience of the divine for large numbers of people for whom a
methodical approach did not mean much and solitary meditation did not
appear attractive. Their attitude was one of devotion which could be
nourished only on mutuality. And thus appeared on the scene the Bhakti
Yoga which found its early popular exposition in the Bhagavad Gt which,
however, popularized to some extent also some of the most technical
methods of Yoga, making them accessible to a larger number of people, as
well as the doctrines of the about the unity of the individual and
the universal which to the popular mind means man and God.
On the Buddhist side it was the compassion expressed in the Bodhisattva
approach which gave the opportunity to masses of followers, previously left
out of the immediate liberation scheme of the strict eightfold path, to have
an outlet for their emotional need for an all-embracing and assisted path.
All this meant that mystical experience, at least in its elementary forms,
became almost universally available. Obviously, this does not represent a
peak in the development of Indian approaches to spirituality, but it did give
both Hinduism and Buddhism as religions a certain awareness of the
mystical dimension on all levels of worship which is still alive in them to a
large degree and which is not easily found in other religions.
However, there is no escaping the fact that the way of the mystic is an
exclusive way. Its true aim is the realization of the ultimate reality which
requires detachment from the immediate relative reality and this can never
become the prevailing concern of multitudes. Consequently the litist
character of mysticism made itself felt again very quickly. A Bodhisattva
may have compassion for all creatures and sacrifice his final liberation for
the sake of helping them, but he nevertheless aims at complete
enlightenment which includes the perfect skill of an accomplished teacher
and spiritual powers which will enable him to pursue his mission. All this
points to a mystical experience of the highest order arrived at on an arduous
path through several stages (bhmis,) involving the development of
superhuman perfections (pramits) which is a very individualistic and
litist achievement.
Thus the eightfold path of a follower of the Buddha was replaced by the
Bodhisattva path and the description of the goal was also reformulated. At
the same time the doctrinal component of Buddhism grew in the context of
Mahyna mysticism more and more until it developed into new and lofty
metaphysical systems in which both the impersonal and personalized
28 WERNER

approaches found full and elaborate expression. On the one hand we have
the tri kya doctrine of layers of reality converging in the dharmakya and
on the other we are faced with the overwhelming hierarchy of cosmic
buddhas and bodhisattvas presided over by di Buddha. The dichotomy
and the inevitable coexistence of the personal and the impersonal in the
attempted conceptual and symbolical descriptions of the experience of the
ultimate reality again make their unavoidable appearance.
The mystical doctrines of the Mahyna have quite a number of features
which were developed in a somewhat similar way and almost
simultaneously by European mystical theology based as it was on the
Neoplatonic philosophy as transmitted by pseudo-Dionysios Areopagita. It
is hardly possible to imagine a better example of corresponding
development in two mystical traditions, although there is some possibility
of earlier Indian influence on the formation of the doctrines of
Neoplatonism as was hinted at in the previous paper.
Within the Hindu tradition mysticism as doctrine and experience as well
as path reached its new peak in ankaras system of Advaita Vednta. The
experience of oneness dominated ankaras thinking and his understanding
of older sources, particularly the , and it completely determined
his doctrinal formulations which largely overshadowed ankara as practical
mystic and teacher of a Yoga path. In his commitment to a specific doctrinal
formulation ankara was dependent on Gaudapda, his teachers teacher, on
Bdryana, the founder of Vedantism, and possibly on an older tradition of
Varaha sahodara .14 It would therefore be difficult to decide whether
ankaras uncompromising monism was an outcome of his experience for
which he found confirmation in his predecessors interpretations of the
or whether his previous acceptance of monism on philosophical
grounds found subsequent support in the overwhelming experience of
oneness in samdhi. The , of course, contain materials which
enabled other schools also to claim their support for their own different
interpretations. It has, however, been an undisputed tenet within ankaras
school for centuries that this world of diversity is false; reality, myself
included, is non-dual brahman ; the evidence of it is vednta [ = ],
gurus as well as direct experience.15
I think that we have here an almost inextricable symbiosis of doctrine and
experience, but what is important is that ankara most emphatically insisted
on the actual realization of personal experience without which the doctrine
means nothing. One has to know the truth directly; all else, including verbal
knowledge of the doctrine, is still within the sphere of ignorance. Again: to
know brahman is to be brahman. The practical way to this realization is the
way of knowledge which became known as Jna Yoga. ankaras Yoga
path follows in many details the older schemes of Yoga training as known
particularly from Patajalis account, but it also has its own specific
techniques of developing the discriminatory faculty of the mind whereby it
MYSTICISM AND INDIAN SPIRITUALITY 29

could sift through its experiences and eliminate from them those which are
concerned with transitory, unreal features as compared with those which
point to the eternal and real.
The inevitable differences in descriptions of the ultimate and its real
nature, well known already from the themselves, led quite
naturally to the establishment of different schools of Vedntism of which
there are at least five. The most important one after ankaras is
Advaita of . In it the previously mentioned popular path of
Bhakti received an elaborate doctrinal backing in which a certain relative or
qualified status is allowed for individual beings also in the context of
ultimate reality which is conceived in personalized terms. Thus Vedntism,
like Buddhism, reflects the ineffability of the ultimate experience which
does not lend itself to simple descriptions.
That does not mean that clear-cut descriptions are necessarily entirely
wrong as opponents in the polemics of rival schools would have us believe;
rather it indicates the simpler fact that the ultimate truth is bigger than
words and that therefore every logically straightforward and consistent
description of its experience must appear to be a simplification. This, in
turn, does not mean that such a description is entirely useless, since it does
convey a certain idea about the ultimate to the totally inexperienced and
may act as an encouragement and motivation for entering the mystic path. A
variety of descriptions addresses a variety of minds according to their
dispositions.
There have been objections to this kind of interpretation of differing
mystical doctrines and the consequent claim of a common core in all
mystical traditions. S.T.Katz expressed it bluntly saying that mysticism
promises something for everybody if not everything to everybody.16 But
that is an ill-founded criticism. The differing interpretations merely express
the infinite richness of the ultimate which must be bigger than individual
minds which can therefore approach it from a large variety of starting
points. Various simplified descriptions of the ultimate goal become wrong
only if taken literally and if they are individually believed in to the
exclusion of other descriptions. That can happen only when the doctrine,
accepted on authority, becomes more important than the experience, which
means that the mystic path is not really being followed. Then we are in the
province of theological or philosophical polemics. These do occur also, of
course, among historians of religions if they bring into their inquiry personal
preferences or beliefs.
With Mahyna Buddhism and Vedntism Indian spirituality reached its
peak, particularly in the elaboration of mystical doctrines. But the whole
process of mystical endeavours did not stop there. Although Buddhism
eventually disappeared from the Indian scene to flourish elsewhere, Yoga
and broader mystical movements as well as doctrinal creativity have
continued to live in India till modern times as shown by the lives and work
30 WERNER

of such personalities as Ramakrishna, Ramana, Aurobindo, Ananda Mayi


Ma and others.

NOTES

1 S.N.Dasgupta, Hindu Mysticism, New York 1927 (repr. 1959), pp.


330.
2 He expressed this view previously already in his multi-volume work
A History of Indian Philosophy I, Cambridge 1951 (1st ed. 1922). p.
17. I have discussed the early views of scholars on the Vedic religion
in my article On Interpreting the Vedas, Religion, vol. 7 (1977). pp.
189200.
3 I have dealt with the question of immortality in the Vedas as a special
achievement of ancient as distinct from the limited reward of the
ordinary worshipper in my article The Vedic Concept of Human
Personality and its Destiny, Journal of Indian Philosophy, vol. 5
(1978), pp. 27589.
4 Jan Gonda, The Vision of the Vedic Poets, The Hague 1963.
5 A comprehensive study of has been written by Jeanine Miller.
The Vision of Cosmic Order in the Vedas, London 1985.
6 I have touched upon the question of understanding the Vedas on
more than one level in the article On interpreting the Vedas, see
above, note 2, and dealt with it more fully in my paper The
Teachings of the Veda and the dhytmika Method of Interpretation,
Golden Jubilee Volume, Vaidika Samsodhana Mandala, Poona 1981,
pp. 28895.
7 I have analysed the myth of Aditi in relation to the creation hymn RV
10, 129 in an earlier paper Symbolism in the Vedas and its
Conceptualisation, Numen XXIV (1977), pp. 22340, to appear in a
revised form in the second volume of collected papers from the
Symposia on Indian religions. For the myth and other
Vedic cosmogonies see Norman W.Brown, The Creation Myth of
the Rig Veda, Journal of the American Oriental Society, vol. 62
(1942), pp. 8598. Also: Mircea Elliade, Cosmos and History, New
York 1959, p. 19ff and later again in A History of Religious Ideas,
vol. I, London 1979 (French ed. 1976), pp. 2058. Cf. also
F.B.J.Kuiper, Cosmogony and Conception: A Query, History of
Religions, vol. 10 (1970), pp. 91138; reprinted in Ancient Indian
Cosmogony, essays selected and introduced by John Irwin, Delhi
1983, pp. 90137, where other essays are also relevant to our theme.
8 See Aurobindo Ghosh, The Secret of the Veda, Birth Centenary
Library, vol. 10, Pondicherry 1971, p. 8, and J.W.Hauer, Der Yoga. Ein
indischer Weg zum Selbst, Stuttgart 1958, p. 19, respectively.
MYSTICISM AND INDIAN SPIRITUALITY 31

9 J.W.Hauer, Das Vrtya. Untersuchungen ber die nicht-


brahmanische Religion Alt-Indiens, Stuttgart 1928. Also:
R.Choudhari, Vrtyas in Ancient India, Varanasi 1964. I have dealt
initially with this problem in my article Religious Practice and Yoga
in the Time of the Vedas, and Early Buddhism, Annals of
the Bhandarkar Oriental Research Institute, vol. LVI (1975), pp.
17994.
10 Symbolism in the Vedas, pp. 22930.
11 Mystical Literature, p. 77, in S.T.Katz (ed.), Mysticism and
Philosophical Analysis, London 1978, pp. 75100.
12 Language and Mystical Awareness, p. 142, ibid. pp. 14160.
13 The closeness of Buddhist and Patajalis terminology was
recognized already by L.de la Vallee Poussin, Le Bouddhisme et le
Yoga de Patanjali, Melanges chinois et bouddhique, vol. 5
(1936/37), pp. 22342. The problem has been again elucidated by
G.J.Larson in his paper An Old Problem Revisited: the Relation
between , Yoga and Buddhism delivered at the XXXII
ICANAS (Hamburg 1986). He draws attention to the fact that Vysa
Yoga Stras more than their text warrants.
14 Cf. S.Radhakrishnan, The Brahma Stra, London 1960, p. 26.
15 Ayam prapaco mithyaiva satyam brahmham advayam/atra
vednta guravo nubhavas tath. Cf. A.J.Alston,
on the Absolute, London 1980, p. 62 and 112.
16 See the editors introduction to Mysticism and Phil. Analysis, p. 1.
32
3
THE LONGHAIRED SAGE OF RV 10,
136: A SHAMAN, A MYSTIC OR A
YOGI?
Karel Werner

In the previous paper I referred to the ancient seers ( ) as the pathfinders


who were reputed to have won immortality and were thus equal to gods.
These spiritual giants with profound mystical insights became the founders
of Indian spiritual tradition as the originators of the oldest Vedic hymns and
were probably also responsible for shaping the moral awareness of the
Vedic ryans and also much of their religious, cultural and social
institutions. They were ancient and legendary figures already to the minds of
the redactors of the Vedic collections and we cannot say if any hymns can
be ascribed directly to their authorship in the form in which they have been
preserved in the RV. But much of the contents of the Vedic hymns does go
back to very early times even if many or most of them were given their
final form by lesser seers of the younger Vedic period.
The tendency to keep the tradition of seerhood alive was very strong, and
active composition of hymns continued for many generations over several
centuries. In the process of this poetic creativity old insights and ideas were
often incorporated into new hymns while some older hymns were
undergoing modifications. Some new hymns did not always find general
approval and so the process of adding new poems to the ancient heritage
was eventually stopped by the codification of the RV around 1000 B.C.1 (It
can be assumed, however, that the production of religious poetry went on
even afterwards in unofficial circles throughout subsequent centuries,
gradually changing its character in the process, and that its last descendants
in our time are the melodious devotional songs.) Some hymns of the RV
were used in a shortened form in liturgy and these were then codified as
Sma Veda. Yajur Veda is a collection of ritual texts closely connected with
the sacrificial cult. The three Vedas were the basis on which the priesthood
gradually erected the elaborate structure of the Vedic religion whose
overwhelming ritualism virtually obscured the spiritual tradition of
seerhood for several centuries until the time of the revival.
But there were also other individuals inclined to pursue mystical
experiences without themselves engaging, like the ancient , in attempts
to transmit their experiences through mythological poetry and religious
34 WERNER

leadership. They adopted mystical pursuits as their way of life. Mysticism


as a consciously cultivated way of life is known in India as Yoga. It is the
purpose of this paper to establish the actual character of these individuals
who were active outside the trend of Vedic mythological creativity and the
Brahminic religious orthodoxy and therefore little evidence of their
existence, practices and achievements has survived. And such evidence as
is available in the Vedas themselves is scanty and indirect.
Nevertheless the indirect evidence is strong enough not to allow any
doubt about the existence of spiritually highly advanced wanderers: besides
several allusions to them in various hymns of the RV we have the hymn of
the longhaired one (kein, RV 10, 136) which is the only hymn in the whole
of the Vedas which is fully dedicated to the description of an outsider who
does not belong to the brahminic establishment and yet is given a rather
sympathetic treatment. He is presented as a longhaired wandering
renunciate called muni, as distinct from , who possesses extraordinary
powers and deep spiritual experiences. The word muni is derived from the
root man which means to think, to muse, to contemplate, to meditate all of
which is normally done in silence and so the general meaning which the
word eventually acquired appears to be a silent sage. The derivative noun
mauneya later obtained the meaning the vow of silence. This need not be
taken in the full sense of the word, and certainly not in early times, but in the
general sense: these sages were silent about the nature of their wisdom, they
did not preach it to others and did not use it to influence others in the
context of communal life as did .
The existence of two different types of religious personages in ancient
India has been pointed out before. Rahurkar speaks of them as belonging to
two distinct cultural strands and refers to them as -culture and muni-
culture. The , according to him, maintained the tradition of prayers and
worship while living within the community and generally manifested a
kind of hieratic attitude. The munis practised yoga, austerities and
orgiastic ritesglorified life of renunciation, isolation and wandering
mendicancy.2 Wayman also found evidence for two distinct approaches to
the spiritual dimension in ancient India and calls them the traditions of
truth and silence. He traces them particularly in the older , in
early Buddhism and in some later literature. The muni of our hymn
represents to him the silence tradition as does the great muni, the Buddha.
That Buddhism belonged originally to the silence tradition can be seen in its
notion of pratyekabuddhas (silent buddhas), The Buddha himself,
however, moved to the other side, the tradition of truth (satya,) when he
decided to teach. Wayman does not refer to the of the Vedas as
representing the truth tradition, but if he had examined the matter he would
have found that they fit well into it as those who had seen the truth and
expressed it then to others through their hymns and other activities.3
THE LONGHAIRED SAGE 35

The kein hymn has not been really understood by commentators of


brahminic tradition and it has been generally underrated and even greatly
misinterpreted over the decades by modern interpreters down to the present
day. The only author who, as far as I know, has attempted to bring out the
spiritual significance of this hymn in recent times is J.Miller, but even she did
not do full justice to it. Yet the strength of experience that seems to lie
behind it is such that even in the inadequate interpretations of scholars with
entirely different backgrounds there is almost always at least one piece of
information, a statement or a conclusion that points to a far deeper meaning
of the hymn than the interpreters are willing to admit. Also, if one pieces
together their positive or appreciative statements about the hymn, as I shall
do later on, one arrives at a highly intriguing picture of a spiritual personage
of a very high stature.
When thus preoccupied with the analysis of the hymn and its previous
translations and interpretations and then engaged in the attempt to translate
it adequately I came to the conclusion that it contained the highest ideas,
aspirations and expressions of mystical experience such as one can find in
any subsequent Hindu or Buddhist system of spiritual endeavour. But let us
first acquaint ourselves with perhaps the latest conventional translation of it
from an anthology of Vedic hymns offered to general public and to students
of Sanskrit who had not had the time to enter upon a study of the Veda.4
Its author, W.H.Maurer, seems to be entirely innocent of or ignores a great
deal of published research into the hymn and its problems done by those
who gave it serious thought and effort:

X.136
THE ASCETIC

1. The longhaired ascetic bears the fire; the longhaired ascetic bears the
toxic drink; the longhaired ascetic bears the two worlds; the longhaired
ascetic is everything; the heavenly light to behold! The longhaired
ascetic is called this light.
2. The hermits have the wind as their girdle. They wear soiled brown
garments. They go along the path of the wind, when the gods have
entered them.
3. Made ecstatic due to our hermit-state, we have mounted upon the
winds. Only our bodies do you mortals perceive!
4. Through the air he flies, looking down upon all forms. The hermit for
every gods benefaction is established as a friend.
5. The winds horse, Vyus friend and also one who is impelled by the
gods is the hermit. Both oceans he inhabits: the one that is eastern and
the western.
6. Going in the path of Apsarases, Gandharvas, beasts, the longhaired
ascetic is aware of their intent, a friend most sweet, most exhilarating.
36 WERNER

7. Vyu stirred the draught for him, Kunannam ground it, when the
longhaired ascetic along with Rudra drank the poison from the goblet.

The history of misinterpretation or superficial translation of this hymn is


a long one. Perhaps the first misleading interpretation is that of Yska (c.
500 B.C.) in his Nirukta (12, 26): Kein bears fire, kein bears water, kein
bears heaven and earth. The word is a synonym of water from the
verb =to purifyKein is called this sun. With these words the seer
describes the sun.5
Belonging to the official or orthodox trend of the brahminic tradition,
Yska was not sensitive to the underlying spiritual meaning of the Vedic
hymns, just as many European Sanskritic philologists in the last century and
some of this century, and depended on a rather scholastic understanding
of the Vedic mythology and imagery which is often reflected in his
etymologies. With him, as far as I could find out, originated the most unlikely
interpretation of the kein as the sun or the Sun god (Srya), his long hair
symbolizing the suns rays. He was followed by the medieval commentator
Syana who lived in the southern kingdom of Vijayanagara in the
fourteenth century A.D. This interpretation was accepted even by some
European scholars of the last century who thought that Indian
commentators were naturally the best interpreters of their own native
tradition. Thus H.H.Wilson translated the whole RV faithfully following
Syana6 and even M.Bloomfield went along with the interpretation of the
kein as sun and developed ingenious arguments to support it at a time
when scholars like Ludwig, Grassmann and Griffith had rejected it.7
Griffith did not elaborate on his translation of the hymn, but he added
Roths summary of it in a footnote: The hymn shows the conception that
by a life of sanctity the Muni can attain to the fellowship of the deities of
the air, the Vyu, the Rudras, the Asparases, and the Gandharvas; and,
furnished like them with wonderful powers, can travel along with them on
their courseThe beautiful haired, the longhaired, that is to say, the Muni,
who during the time of his austerities does not shave his hair, upholds fire,
moisture, heaven, and earth, and resembles the world of light, ideas which
the later literature so largely contains.8
This is quite a fair summary, without serious misinterpretations, although
a bit superficial and lacking in analysis. What is worth noting, however, is
that neither Roth nor Griffith suspected our muni of drug-taking on account
of his drinking poison with Rudra and they both accepted that his was a life
of sanctity.
The first European interpretation, which has to be carefully considered
because it has been very influential, is that of Oldenberg. Although he
dedicated to it hardly half a page in his work on the religion of the Vedas,
the echo of his views and conjectures resounded through a large number of
subsequent interpretations to the present day, often without due
THE LONGHAIRED SAGE 37

acknowledgement and always without any backing by research. This is


certainly quite remarkable, because Oldenberg dealt with the hymn almost
casually while discussing , a ritual initiation before the sacrificial
ceremony, and tapas, the ascetic practice required also during the initiation
rites. It is worthwhile to translate here his whole account of the hymn:

The hymn vividly describes the orgiastic practices of the old Vedic times,
still un-ennobled by the thirst for liberation which moved the ascetics of the
Buddhist time, still banished into rude forms of medicinemanship
(Medizinmn-nertum). The hymn speaks of longhaired ecstatics (kein,
muni,) clad in brown dirt, who enter the winds course, when the gods enter
them, who drink, poison (ecstacy-producing medicaments?) with Rudra
from a cup. In drunken rapture we have ascended the carriage of the wind.
You mortals can see only our bodies.The winds steed, the Storm gods
friend, the ecstatic is god-driven. He inhabits both seas, that in the east and
the western one. He wanders on the path of the Apsarases, Gandharvas,
wild animals.9

Althoughas is obviousOldenberg valued little the phenomenon


represented by the kein, which he even equated with the lowest forms of
religious life and called the cultivation of ecstatic association with
ghosts, he nevertheless recognized the great antiquity of the ecstatic
practices in India which, according to him, were not late innovations, but
must have played a more significant role in the oldest Vedic times than the
limited range of hymnic poetry could reveal.10
Oldenberg made no real attempt to analyse the hymn carefully and gain a
proper understanding of it. In what can only be classified as a superficial
equation he put the ecstatic practices of the medicine-men of primitive
tribal societies, known in the nineteenth century from reports of travellers
and observations of ethnologists, on the same level as the spiritual practices
referred to in the RV which is a sophisticated religious and literary creation
of a developed ancient civilization. His failure to see the full significance of
the hymn stemmed most likely from the then prevailing (and in some
quarters even now surviving) positivistic and evolutionary thinking applied
to the study of the history of religion. When looking at the early Indian
religiosity from this vantage point he could not but see the clearly expressed
Buddhist goal of liberation as the advanced and ennobled stage of religious
quest preceded by lower religious forms such as ritual worship and cult
which in turn had been preceded by a wild, primitive and orgiastic stage. He
could not see that the frequently expressed longing of the Vedic worshipper
for immortality was a manifestation of a similar spiritual questexpressed,
of course, in a different idiom from that in the much later Buddhist texts
which, far from being pursued only by ritual means, was the objective of
those who were steeped in the already in very ancient times and
38 WERNER

also of the movement of the longhaired munis, living lives of renunciation


outside the .11
The point to mention in favour of Oldenbergs attitude to the hymn is
that he did not regard it as a nature myth, but as an account of an existing
phenomenon of some antiquity and importance which the official
Brahminic establishment, oriented as it was towards the sacrificial cult
approach, kept outside its domain, although it was unable to escape its
influence entirely.12
Oldenbergs reputation was high and indologists of the next generations
accepted many of his views, particularly in areas in which they did not do
special research themselves. Thus Hillebrandt, in some respects
Oldenbergs opponent, and Arbmann, who produced some original research
results in Vedic studies, both depended on Oldenbergs views in their
evaluation of our hymn. The same is probably true of Griswold who may
have been the first to introduce the drug theory, so casually suggested by
Oldenberg, into this country when he referred in connection with the hymn
to poison-liquids that produce ecstasy.13
Of recent German indologists, J.W.Hauer did more than anyone else to
gain general recognition for Yoga as a subject to be taken seriously on the
academic level. But his attempt to deduce the origin of Yoga practices from
the Vedic cult was misguided and earned him the following remark from
the pen of Keith: J.W.Hauer (Die Anf. d. Yogapr. in Alt. Ind., pp. 965)
adduces all available evidence but most of it is obviously without value.14
Hauer did not recognize the true nature of the kein hymn, because his
attitude to it was basically the same as Oldenbergs before him. He, too,
believed in upward evolution of Indian religiosity and Yoga was to him a
product of this evolution. So he regarded the muni as a mere primitive shaman
and in his later book went out of his way in order to find traces of
developing Yoga procedures in the Vedic ritual observances. Although his
observations concerning Vrtyas as forerunners of the tradition and
of Buddhism are probably very near the mark, he did not manage to find the
probable link between the ekavrtya phenomenon and the wanderer of our
hymn and to dissociate him from Oldenbergs casual remarks. Instead, he
virtually echoed him without expressing in any way Oldenbergs
uncertainty indicated by the question mark. He wrote: The kein reached
ecstacy because he drank from a cup with Rudra. And he believed
that was some kind of intoxicating drink. He even went further than
Oldenberg in calling the kein a Wildekstatiker, but on the other hand he did
admit that the kein had also great spiritual intuitions. Finally he gave the
following ambiguous summary of the hymn: The hymn vividly describes
the experiences of those primitive ecstatics who, elevated above all
terrestrial heaviness, arrive at cosmic expanse.15
Keith, having so severely criticized Hauer, found the description of the
muni in our hymn striking. He recognized that the longhaired wanderer
THE LONGHAIRED SAGE 39

differed entirely from the Brahminic student, because his experiences were
not connected either with the sacrifice or with any of the rites ancillary to it
or to other ritual procedures. But he quite obviously succumbed to the
Oldenbergs tentative suggestion (which he did not care to quote or refer to)
when he wrote: his ecstasy, it seems, is due to a potent draught which, with
Rudra, he drinks from a goblet, perhaps a reference to the use of some
poison to produce exhilaration or hypnosis.16
Eliade, as an historian of religion and explorer of the dimension of the
sacred, was much more open to Yoga and the spiritual values of Indian
culture in general and fought consistently against the image which the
nineteenth century created of so-called inferior societies in particular.17
Yet even he looked at Indian spiritual experience from an evolutionistic
standpoint. He started his book with an exposition of Patajalis Yoga and
when he came to consider its prehistory, he was looking for the evidence of
elements he knew from the later classic Yoga of Patajali. He thought that
he had found rudiments of it in the Vedas.
In his investigations Eliade made the mistake of not taking into account
the different nature of his two sources separated by more than a thousand
years of linguistic development. When tackling our hymn he apparently
approached it with preconceived ideas, some of them stemming from his
earlier preoccupation with Siberian shamanism. The kein is to him only an
ecstatic who but vaguely resembles the Yogi. the chief similarity being his
ability to fly through the airbut this siddhi is a magical power that is
found everywhere. The hymns references to the horse of the wind, the
poison drunk with Rudra and to the gods whom he incarnates [sic!] point
for him rather to a shamanizing technique. He did not analyse the hymn
carefully and produced only a hasty, inaccurate and misleading paraphrase
of it. Yet he was also struck by it and found the description of the keins
ecstasy significant. He expressed his appreciative impressions as follows:
The muni disappears in spirit; abandoning his body, he divines the
thoughts of others; he inhabits the two seas. All of these are experiences
transcending the sphere of the profane, are states of consciousness cosmic
in structure, though they can be realized through other means than
ecstasy.18 Those other means he referred to are the three last stages of
Patajalis Yoga, namely concentration , meditation (dhyna) and
enstasis (samdhi) which can be deliberately used for acquiring siddhis or
miraculous powers.19 Enstasis is an expression coined by Eliade which
he used to distinguish samdhi from the lower technique of ecstasy.
Eliades arbitrary distinction between the achievement of a Yogi of
Patajalis school of classical Yoga and of a muni of Vedic times is based
on his understanding of mauneya (verse 3), i.e. the sages state of mind or
achievement (which Maurer translates clumsily hermit-state), as being a
shamanistic ecstasy, and possibly drug-induced at that. It is highly unlikely
that Eliade ever saw or tried to read the original of the hymn. All he wrote
40 WERNER

about it and the inaccurate paraphrase of it point to the use of a translation.


He also heavily depended on Hauer who in turn followed the unfounded
casual remarks of Oldenberg who had rendered mauneya as drunken
rapture (trunkene Verzckung). I have already pointed out above the basic
meaning of that expression as associated with contemplation and silent
meditation and so the keins achievement cannot, with justification, be
regarded as different in essence from that of a Yogi of classical times who
is steeped in his samdhi. The difference is clearly only terminological as is
understandable with the two texts separated by such a long period of time.
It is a matter for regret that not even Gonda, the most prolific Vedic
researcher of this century, has done anything to clarify our picture of the
kein. He merely repeated the view about ecstatic practices and referred to
Oldenberg, Hauer and Eliade.20 But he did make one significant
contribution to the discussion of the phenomenon of kein when he offered
some general comments on the world of ecstatic experience. He
confirmed that such figures as represented by the muni of our hymn lived
predominantly outside the Brahminic culture.21
The resounding echo of Oldenbergs remark alluding to the possibility of
drug-induced ecstasy (after which, we have to point out again, he put a
question mark!) bounced back, after more than half a century, from as far as
India, the homeland of our longhaired sage, with the question mark
removed. R.N.Dandekar, now retired from the chair of Sanskrit in the
University of Poona, a distinguished scholar with a high international
reputation (who had, in his young days, studied in Germany) wrote words
which read more or less like a direct translation from Oldenberg. He said
that our hymn clearly relates to the specific orgiastic cult of the munis
who seemed to him to have indulged in a sort of ecstasy-producing
medicament. And he added a conjecture of his own that Rudra is
represented in this muniskta almost as the leader of that cult.22
It is perhaps not surprising if this interpretation, although based originally
only on a casual remark of Oldenberg which was never given substance in a
serious inquiry by him or anyone else, has found ready acceptance in our
time when it was influenced by the hippy subculture often acclaiming
superficial mysticism la Aldous Huxley with LSD connections (which,
sadly, has now taken an even worse turn, namely to naked hard-drug abuse,
quite free from any mystical pretences). In his, in some respects quite
thought-provoking book, Staal, in full dependence on Dandekar (and
thereby on Oldenbergs question-marked suggestion), unhesitatingly
explained our hymn as not only the oldest, but one of the most impressive
poetic descriptions of mystical experience connected with the effects of a
drug. He gave a very inaccurate translation of the hymn and described it,
without having any backing for it in his own or others serious research, as
an indication of the use of various hallucinogens in Vedic times of which
soma, as explained by the now generally rejected Wassons mushroom
THE LONGHAIRED SAGE 41

theory, was one: That soma is not the only hallucinogen referred to in the
is clear from the long-hair hymn.23 It is a sad reflection on the
level of critical re-examination, or the lack of it, of old clichs, which the
remark of Oldenbergs has become, that the drug theory has found common
acceptance among teachers of Sanskrit like Maurer. In his comment to
verse 2 of his translation, given above, he says: toxic drink refers to
some sort of narcotic substance used by the ascetics to induce a trance-like,
ecstatic state. And his observation to verse 7 elaborates: This passageis
the oldest reference to the Rudra-iva cult of traditional Indian civilisation,
which has always been characterised by wild, frenzied rites and revelry
involving the consumption of intoxicating beverages and hallucinatory
drugs. (Cf. my note 4.) Such sweeping assertions, which lack
substantiation and are not backed by references to any research work, are
unworthy of an academic.
The common fallacy of all such interpretations of the material is
their disregard for the highly symbolical character of the Vedic texts and
thereby for the deeper meaning of their mythological background. Their
protagonists appear to have always sought only the most obvious and
virtually literal explanation which one could be forgiven for calling a kind
of (academic) fundamentalism.
A more cautious and less extreme view of our hymn was expressed by
Geldner: The song describes the trance-state of an ascetic ecstatic
Oldenberg (Religion 404) goes too far in stressing the rough features of a
wild medicine-man. The muni possesses fully the external signs of the later
Yogi and of the god iva.24 In this statement he was long before preceded
by Ludwig, although he did not quote him. Ludwig, moreover, recognized
in the image of Rudra drinking the poison a reference to the myth about the
churning of the cosmic ocean and to iva drinking the poison halhala
which has been separated from the ocean first, to be followed later by the
drink of immortality. That is why he suggested that one should see in Rudra
a Yogi.25
There are other, perhaps less important, interpretations of our hymn like
that of Sharma who regards the keins as the forerunners of the
and as such the earliest dissenters from the orthodox religion26, a view
which cannot be upheld and for which there is no evidence. Neither keins
nor can be held for dissenters from the orthodox religion, because
they represented quite a different tradition outside orthodoxy or outside
Brahminic culture, as Gonda put it. Turning now to the first comprehensive
and serious attempt at a deeper understanding of this remarkable hymn by
Miller, I have to say again that bold and imaginative as it is, her
interpretation which came quite near to unveiling the true character of the
longhaired sage, still failed to do full justice to him, for two reasons.
Firstly, she was too much influenced by Eliades views and secondly she,
too, looked at the hymn with a certain evolutionistic biasas already the
42 WERNER

title of her paper, Forerunners of Yoga, indicates. Like others before her
she spoke about the ecstatic state of the munis and although she admitted
that it contains an element of luminosity characteristic of the later Yogi
experiences she found, clearly under the influence of Eliade, also some
marked similarities between shamanism and the munis experiences. She
judged them apparently by her understanding of the Patajalis elaborate
scheme of the stages of samdhi when she further wrote: The munis
experiences cannot even be regarded as simple states of samdhithey still
belong to the lowest part of the created cosmos. She evidently believed
that further evolution was necessary to bring our wandering sage of Vedic
time from his supposedly primitive mentality to the advanced spirituality of
Patajalis time.
But as in almost everybody elses case, the underlying strength of the
hymns evidence influenced even her to the point where she appears to have
become inconsistent with her own statements. She very nearly ascribed to
the sage the highest possible development of mans spirituality when she
recognized that he possessed detachment from life leading to its mastery
and even admitted that he is not merely master of the two worlds, mind and
matter, but he has penetrated into svar, the spiritual world or level of
cognition.27 She was further tempted by the view of Bose who interpreted
the drinking of poison by the sage in Rudras company as a symbol of
taking, on himself, the worlds suffering. This is a suggestion which is not
unsound, because in the myth about the churning of the cosmic ocean iva
drinks the poison in order to save other gods and the whole world from
destruction. Yet Miller shrinks back from the temptation of what would
appear to be spurious reasons. She must have known about the awareness in
the Vedas of the meaning of sacrifice and self-sacrifice for the benefit of the
world which is expressed mythologically by the original sacrifice of the
in the process of world creation (RV 10, 90). Yet she finds Boses
idea as striking a slightly dramatic note not quite in keeping with the
Indian spirit for whom tragedy has no place.28 This remark is off the mark,
for if a spiritually advanced being undergoes suffering in order to help
others, there may be in it a dramatic note, but it is quite in keeping with the
Indian spiritas the myth about churning the cosmic ocean and drinking
the poison, or even the story of the Buddhas life before enlightenment and
other instances showbut there certainly is no tragedy in it.
The approach to the interpretation of this hymn should be free from
prejudice and preconceived ideas and theories about the evolution of
religious experiences of mankind. All high religions recognize a
transcendental and ultimate source of spirituality (be it called God, tman,
Tao, , the Holy or any other name) which itself does not undergo
evolution and can reveal itself or be experienced fully in different times and
situations and in different stages of mans mental or intellectual
development, without being linked together by any kind of evolutionary
THE LONGHAIRED SAGE 43

process. The expressions and interpretations of such revelations or


experiences of course vary according to the idiom current at different times
and in different cultures, but they always point to the highest conceivable
reality. This is true also of the hymn about the longhaired sage and that is why
hardly any of its interpreters surveyed above could avoid expressing it in
one way or another, even though in their overall evaluation they more or
less belittled the achievement of the sage. So let us now piece together
those valid and important observations of individual scholars so far quoted
which give him credit for some special feature.
First of all, the hymn obviously portrays a phenomenon of great antiquity,
as we are already assured by Oldenberg, despite the fact that the tenth book
of the RV is considered to be of relatively late date. No one has ever
challenged this point. Secondly, as Keith pointed out, the longhaired sage was
not a student of the Brahminic tradition, which means that he lived, as
Gonda put it, predominantly outside the Brahminic culture, a point also
already made by Oldenberg. Thirdly, the longhaired sage impressed some
scholars by what is indicated of his saintly life, leading to high spiritual
achievements: Roth spoke of a life of sanctity by which the muni could
attain to the fellowship of deities; Hauer admitted that he had great spiritual
intuitions and, elevated above all terrestrial heaviness, arrived at cosmic
expanse (a high evaluation whatever he may have meant by it); Eliade
recognized that his experiences transcended the sphere of the profane and
were states of consciousness cosmic in structure (yet another instance of a
high appraisal whose exact meaning is not quite clear); and Miller credited
him with mastery of life and of the two worlds of mind and matter (her
interpretation of the two oceans, the eastern and the western) as well as with
penetrating into the spiritual world of cognition. Last but not least,
Ludwig saw in the longhaired sage a Yogi, Geldner also recognized in him
all the external signs of Yogis known from historical times and of the God
iva worshipped in later Hinduism as Yogapati, the Lord of Yoga and,
finally, Bose brought a soteriological element into the process of the
interpretation of the hymn by suggesting that his drinking of poison
symbolized taking the worlds suffering on himself.
With the results of my precedessors in mind I would now proceed to the
presentation of my own translation and discussion of the hymn:

1. The longhaired one carries within himself fire and poison and both
heaven and earth. To look at him is like seeing heavenly brightness in
its fullness. He is said to be light itself.
2. The sages, girdled with the wind, are clad in dust of yellow hue. They
follow the path of the wind when the gods have penetrated them.
3. Uplifted by our sagehood we have ascended upon the winds. You
mortals see just our bodies.
44 WERNER

4. The sage flies through the inner region, illuminating all forms below.
Given to holy work he is the companion of every god.
5. Being the winds horse, the Vyus companion and god-inspired, the
sage is at home in both oceans, the eastern and the western.
6. Wandering in the track of celestial beings and sylvan beasts, the
longhaired one, knowing their aspiration, is a sweet and most uplifting
friend.
7. For him Vyu churned, even pounded that which is hard to bend, as the
longhaired one drank the poison with the cup, together with Rudra.

It may now be clear that the Vedas as religious scriptures are


representative of one type of spiritual tradition which spread its message
through familiar religious means. The hymn under scrutiny gives evidence
of the existence of another ancient type of spiritual tradition which
expressed itself in what we can call, using a term which appeared later, the
Yogic way of life. This consisted in renouncing worldly life, abstaining
from current forms of religious worship and practising a meditative
approach to the transcendent. According to the evidence given by the
followers of this tradition, this led to the shifting of their consciousness into
the dimension of the spiritual which gave them access to a higher kind of
knowledge of themselves, of the hidden reality and of other men and beings
both superhuman and subhuman. As a result they were friends and helpers
of others, possibly even assisting them spiritually by way of some kind of
self-sacrifice.
The authorship of this hymn is clearly to be ascribed to someone
belonging to the Vedic tradition who reported sympathetically and perhaps
even with admiration about the longhaired sage, using of course the current
mythological and symbolical images of the idiom of later Vedic time. This
imagery is not as difficult to understand as it may seem at first glance and it
is therefore possible to obtain a fairly clear picture of the longhaired sage
and the tradition behind him as outlined above and as it will further emerge
from the following analysis of the individual verses of the hymn step
by step:
1. Carrying within oneself fire and poison, heaven and earth, is best
explained as expressing the enormously wide scope of human experience,
ranging from enthusiasm and creativity to depression and agony, from the
heights of spiritual bliss to the heaviness of earthbound labour. This is true
of man in general as well as our sage in particular, but the latter has
mastered and transformed these contrary forces and is a visible embodiment
of accomplished spirituality (svar) : he is said to be light or enlightenment
itself.
2. Being fully anchored in spirituality, the longhaired sage does not live a
normal life of convention. He spends long periods of time in
silent absorption, musing or meditation (man,) and therefore he is called
THE LONGHAIRED SAGE 45

the silent one (muni). The unconventional appearance of these sages is


further marked by their attire; either they wear clothes of yellow rags
fluttering in the wind or, much more likely, they go naked (girdled with the
wind), clad only in the yellow dust of the Indian soil which may have been
the origin of the usual colour of the later adopted traditional robes of Indian
mendicants and Buddhist monks. But their personalities are not bound to
earth, for they follow the path of the mysterious wind when the gods enter
them. This can be regarded as a mythological and metaphorical description
of someone who has reached, through meditation or progress on the spiritual
path, a state of consciousness or a mode of existence on a higher plane or in
another dimension which is free from earthly entanglements and invisible to
ordinary people and is also associated with gods.
3. While the first two verses were descriptive, the third one is a quotation
in which one of the sages confirms that through their silent meditation they,
as spiritual personalities, have reached a different level of existence from
that of other people who, as ordinary mortals, cannot see them as they really
are, but see only their bodies. This is a hint that they themselves are no
mere mortals but have reached the plane of immortality, an achievement
desired and often prayed for by traditional Vedic worshippers as well (RV 5,
55, 4; 7, 59, 12; 9, 113, 11), but which was reliably attained only by the
ancient pathfinder seers and by gods (RV 10, 56, 4).
4. This verse asserts that the sage moves in the inner dimension of reality
( ) where he perceives and understands all forms i.e. the
archetypes of everything that exists. He is dedicated only to worthwhile
effort and can communicate with any god.
5. The imagery of this verse suggests that the sage is in tune with life at
large, both as far as the biological vitality, the lower aspect of life, is
concerned (being Vtas horse) and (as Vyus companion) also with
respect to the subtle aspect of the cosmic force of life. It follows from the
previous verse that he has reached this situation by his dedication to some
form of spiritual discipline, the only worthwhile task for men. No
intervention of divine grace, help or assistance is mentioned, yet he is
penetrated by the divine or is god-inspired and at home in both oceans, the
eastern and the western, the east being a symbol for the world of light, spirit
and wisdom, while the west symbolizes the world of darkness, matter and
ignorance. The sages mastery of both the worlds is reminiscent of the later
notion of Mahyna bodhisattvas equally at home in and .
6. The spiritual achievements of the longhaired sage enable him to follow
the tracks of all beings, even the superhuman and the subhuman ones, to
know their hearts and, by fully understanding them, to become their real
friend and help them by uplifting them. This is yet another anticipation of a
Buddhist notion, namely that of a beautiful or spiritual friend (kalyna
mitra,) an expression used for the personal teacher occasionally in the
Theravda tradition (kalyna mitta,) but mainly in Mahyna Buddhist
46 WERNER

context where it was not influenced by the later Hindu image of a stern
guru. The ability to read other beings hearts is among the Yogic powers
(siddhis) listed by Patajali as well as being a quality which was said to have
been possessed by the Buddha in an unequalled measure and used by him
particularly when instructing and helping his pupils and listeners on the
path of their moral and spiritual progress and well-being.
7. This last verse of the hymn presents some real difficulties to
interpreters, as the history of its misrepresentation testifies. Help is
available if one draws on the materials contained in the . The image
of churning and pounding connects this verse, as already mentioned earlier
in this paper, with the myth of churning the cosmic ocean to obtain
the drink of immortality. The myths, though usually recorded
relatively late, have undoubtedly a long history and some may be very
ancient indeed and therefore the allusion to one of them in the RV need not
be surprising.29 If one takes Vyu to stand again for universal life, one may
understand the first part of the verse as stating that having reached harmony
with the universal life, the sage also reached immortality, the highest goal
of spiritual life. The second part of the stanza then indicates that he did so
while still active in (drinking from) the stream of mortal (poisonous) life
in the material world through having a material body (represented probably
by the image of the cup). One can paraphrase the situation in Buddhist
terminology: having realized , he remains active in
untouched by its defilements.
In the legend poison is released as a by-product during the
process of churning the cosmic ocean, before the drink of immortality is
won, and it thus symbolizes the unavoidable phenomenon of death within
the manifested universe ( is the realm of Mra). Only when death
is overcome by ones spiritual power is true immortality obtained. The gods
do not manage to do so in the legend. Only iva is capable of drinking the
poison without harm and he is, significantly enough, the popular Hindu
symbol of spiritual progress through Yoga. As the Vedic Rudra was the
same as or developed into iva, the image of drinking poison in his
company suggests the spiritual achievement gained by Yoga and as iva
saved by his deed the gods and other beings from the deadly poison, the
image suggests also the idea of assistance which the longhaired sage gives
or is capable of offering to others. But he does not do so as a saviour, as
Bose would have it, for he is not and has not become a god or divine
incarnation; he is still a man who has reached accomplishment and thereby
the realms of immortality, but who can only assist the world rather than
save it, an idea which again points in the direction of the later Mahyna
Buddhist teachings as expressed in the Bodhisattva doctrine.
Thus what clearly emerges from this unique hymn is a picture, not of an
orgiastic drug-addict, but of the noble figure of a spiritual hero, an ideal
THE LONGHAIRED SAGE 47

which has been the focal point of spiritual aspirations in India throughout
millenia and which has retained its appeal up to the present day.

APPENDIX

Discussion of the text


The text is taken from Th. Aufrecht, Die Hymnen des Rigveda I-II, 2nd ed.
Bonn 1877.

1. Key gnm bibharti rdas/


vvam svr jytir ucyate//

, bibharti I used one of the equivalents given in H.Grassmanns


dictionary (Wrterbuch zum , Leipzig 1873) as eine
Eigenschaft oder Kraft in sich tragen (although Grassmann himself
renders the word in his translation of the hymn trgt erhaltend
which I consider inadequate, as is the whole translation of the hymn
by him added only in an appendix in prose, while the bulk of the hymns
was translated by him in verses. See his Rig- Veda I-II, Leipzig 1877,
vol. 2, p. 499). Supporting evidence for my translation is 10, 84, 6:
sho and 10, 39, 10: smy jo bibharth; also 10, 27, 16:
grbham bibharti.
agni symbolizes here the flame of creativity, the eternal source of
manifestation.
moisture, water, poison; the last meaning is undoubtedly
appropriate here as it achieves the necessary contrast and is
consistent with verse 7. Poison symbolizes the dark side of existence
in the world of suffering ruled by death, later called . Water
would fit in, too, if understood as the symbol of the unconscious or
subconscious stream of mental existence, harbouring the monsters of
dark urges and destructive instincts.
rodas is a dual form designating the two worlds, the higher and the lower,
heaven and earth, its root rud meaning, significantly enough, to
shine as well as to weep. This stands again for the spiritual and
material life as do the previous two symbols. As explained earlier,
these two sides of existence have been mastered by the longhaired
sage. H.Bailey suggests a philological interpretation of rodas as two
surfaces (Indo-Iranica, p. 326, Bulletin of the School of Oriental
and African Studies, XII [1947], pp. 31932). This suits the
mythological picture of heaven and earth as two parts of the shell of
the primeval egg and also its figurative meaning as the two levels
48 WERNER

or, better, two planes of existence, the higher and the lower, i.e. the
spiritual and the material.
svar meaning brightness, light, splendour, bliss, happiness and also the
sun, bright space and bright sky; it symbolizes the highest realm,
possibly the element of enlightenment itself.
jyoti light, also inner light, insight, enlightenment.

2. Mnayo pinga vasate ml/


yanti yd //

muni Grassman translates Bsser which is not even compatible with his
own dictionary which gives ein Begeisterter, Verzckter. The last
expression was used by Oldenberg and Geldner, but it was not a
happy choice. The English equivalent would be the ecstatic and it
does not convey the root meaning of the word pointing as it does to a
silent meditative life (mauneya). In the absence of a congenial
English expression sage seems to be the best rendering.
vtaraana girdled with the wind. It probably indicates that they did not
wear any girdles, because, going naked, they did not need them, the
wind blowing round their naked waists.
mala taken as a noun in Instr. Sg., it means that the sages were wrapped
in dirt, dust or soil whose predominant colour was pianga, yellow,
which is still true of the Indian plains. This again indicates that they
went about naked. Miller suggests that it could mean that the sages
have donned the perishable vehicle of earth, the body, with all its
impurities (Reappraisal, p. 104) which is not altogether impossible.
Most translators obviously take mala to be an adjective in the Acc. Pl.,
in which case robes has to be supplemented and we get the
traditional yellow robe of Hindu and Buddhist mendicants. This is,
however, not at all necessary. In view of the ancient custom of Jain
ascetics to go naked which survived with their digambara sect till
modern times, most ancient unorthodox sages were most likely
following the same trend.
devaso Griffiths translation where gods have gone before is
more appealing, but there does not seem to be grammatical support
for it, as yad stands for when and not where. The overall sense of
the verse is practically the same in either case, expressing the
capacity of the sages to communicate on the level or in the dimension
of divine intelligences. This is the path of the wind, the breath of
gods.

3. nmadit maneyena vaym/


rrd yym mrtso abhpayatha//
THE LONGHAIRED SAGE 49

mauna the achievement or status of being a muni. It obviously points to


an inner, spiritual state of being. The most likely equivalent in the
Yoga terminology of later times is samdhi.

4. patati vv /
mnir devsya devasya skh //

although the usual rendering is the interim region between


heaven and earth and therefore often atmosphere or even air, the
only possible meaning here is the inner region or the spiritual
dimension of reality which overlaps with the unconscious part of the
psyche into which the sage can fly, i.e. which has become
accessible to him consciously through the meditational shift of his
consciousness (mauneyena). Here Grassmanns interpretation of antar
(i) (Grundbe griff: ins Innere dringend oder im Innern befindlich)
points in the right direction. Dandekar drew attention to AV 1, 32
(Universe in Vedic Thought, pp. 10910, India Maior, Leiden 1972,
pp. 91114), a hymn which glorifies as the sphere of life-
giving potencies. It also seems to say that is the place where
those who are weary (asleep?) rest. All this strongly supports my
interpretation.
k to illuminate; the prefix avaindicates that the action comes from
above: the sage illuminates the contents of the unconscious from the
superior position of an enlightened one. As the individual unconscious
overlaps with the cosmic inner region or dimension which contains
the seeds or archetypal forms, one can see in this the oldest hint at
what developed into laya vijna of the Vijnavda school of
Buddhism.
literally good work, means good work par excellence, i.e.
holy work, the work of spiritual achievement which is the only real
work to be done ( of the Pli suttas).
hita p.p. of dh to put, give, dedicate.

5. /
ubha y ca //

vtasya-ava the image winds horse makes sense when we take


wind to be symbolical of life-force (and thus connected by meaning
with ). Then the image of the horse immediately suggests the
life-force flowing through a powerful tool or vehicle by which it
comes to be manifested. There are reasons to view Vta as the lower
aspect of Vyu, both words having the same meaning. That is why I
regard Vta as representing the lower, biological, force which is
50 WERNER

apparently fully at the sages disposal, and Vyu the higher lifes
force or the very essence of life with which the sage is in harmony.
samudra the image of the ocean, usually meaning the cosmic ocean,
i.e. the space in its entirety, including the inner space, stands in the
Vedas and virtually all of Indian mythology for spheres of existence
and for layers of the mind, both cosmic and individual, since they
overlap (cf. also RV 1, 159, 4). The interpretation of eastern as
spiritual and western as material is supported also by the fact that
prva also means upper (particularly in compounds, like
prvakya, the upper part of the body) and that apara then means
low or even inferior.

6. Apsarsm cran/
ktasya skh svdr //

keta from the root kit=cit expresses the dynamic drive of the mind or
heart, hence it means will, intention, desire, inclination, motivation,
aspiration (Pli cetan is also used in this sense); the expression
ketasya vidvn no doubt means that he knows his own hearts
movements as well as the longings and aspirations or motivations of
other beings. This is further strengthened by the phrase wandering in
their track which has also the figurative meaning of being able to
trace them mentally which is a siddhi called dibba cakkhu in the Pli
Canon.

7. Vyr asm pmanthat sm /


yd sah//

kunannama based on the intensive form of the verb nam to bend.


Geldner suggested the translation die hsslich Gekrmte (which is
highly improbable) and considered it the name of a female demon or
fairy, but had no reasons for his view to offer (similarly Renou;
Maurer also followed suit). He elaborated, again without
substantiation, by saying that she helped Vyu to prepare the magic
potion for the longhaired sage. Since no such fairy is known from
anywhere else, his suggestion can be dismissed as little more
than pure speculation. He of course takes kunannam to be Nom. Sg.
fem. as did Wilson before him, following Syana, and translating it
the inflexible, meaningin agreement with his naturalistic
interpretation of the hymnthunder. Others, such as Ludwig,
Grassmann and Griffith, take it as Acc. and so do I.
ptra vessel, cup, container, also mothers womb and river-bed and
hence, figuratively, a material body (as a container for the poison of
THE LONGHAIRED SAGE 51

the stream of life). The image of drinking the poison with a


cup thus suggests that the body is deliberately used by the sage to go
on partaking in life for a special purpose which is indicated
by the reference to Rudra evoking the myth about the churning of the
cosmic ocean and iva drinking the poison (to save others) as
originally pointed out by Ludwig.

NOTES

1 This date is based on the ingenious calculations of Max Mller, History


of Ancient Sanskrit Literature, London 1859 (repr. 1860, 1912, 1926),
p. 70ff. whose time-scale for the composition of Vedic literature has
not yet found a serious challenger. There are, however, voices which,
while accepting as the time of the composition of the hymns
the period between 1500 and 1000 B.C., are inclined to place the date
of final codification later, but in any event before 600 B.C. Cf. Jan
Gonda, Vedic Literature, Wiesbaden 1975, p. 15 and 22.
2 V.G. Rahurkar, The Seers of the Rgveda, Poona 1964, pp. XV-XVI.
3 Alex Wayman, Two Traditions of IndiaTruth and Silence,
Philosophy East and West, XXIV (1974), pp. 389403.
4 Pinnacles of Indias Past. Selections from the Rgveda, trans. &
annot. by Walter H.Maurer (professor of Sanskrit at the University of
Hawaii at Manoa), Amsterdam/Philadelphia 1986, p. 4. The
translation and interpretation is on pp. 31618.
5 Lakshman Sarup, Yska, Nighanta and Nirukta, Oxford 1921, vol. 6,
p. 192.
6 H.H.Wilson, , 10 vols, London 18661888. His
translation of the hymn as dedicated to the sun is in vol. 6, pp. 3645.
7 M.Bloomfield, Contributions to the Interpretation of the Veda. The
Two Dogs of Yama in a New Role, Journal of the American Oriental
Society, XV (1893).
8 The Hymns of the Rigveda, 2 vols. trans. with a popular commentary
by Ralph T.H.Griffith, 2nd ed. Benares 18967, vol. 2, p. 582. In fact
he does not quote Roth from his original work, but takes the
quotation from J. Muir, Original Sanskrit Texts, part IV, p. 319. I do
not quote from the work of Ludwig and Grassmann at this stage,
because they did not produce full interpretations of the hymn with
their translations. But their translations or brief commnets will be
taken account of later on.
9 Hermann Oldenberg, Die Religion des Veda, 5th ed., Darmstadt 1970,
pp. 4045 (1st ed. 1894).
10 Ibid., p. 404.
11 Cf. my paper The Vedic Concept of Human Personality, pp. 2834,
Journal of Indian Philosophy 5 (1978), pp. 27589.
52 WERNER

12 Oldenberg, op. cit. p. 405.


13 A.Hillebrandt, Lieder des Rgveda, Gttingen 1913, pp. 156ff. E.
Arbman, RudraUntersuchungen zum altindischen Glauben und
Kultur, Uppsala 1922, pp. 298ff. H.D.Griswold, The Religion of the
Rigveda, London 1923, p. 339.
14 A.B.Keith, The Religion and Philosophy of the Veda and the
Upanishads, repr. Delhi 1970, p. 401, note 7 (first pub. Cambridge,
Mass., Harvard U.P. 1925).
15 J.W.Hauer, Der Yoga, ein indischer Weg zum Selbst, Stuttgart 1958,
pp. 2931. This book replaced the one criticized by Keith which was
originally Hauers doctoral thesis submitted in Tbingen 1917 and
published as Die Anfnge der Yogapraxis im alten Indien, Stuttgart
1922. Hauers later research on Vrtyas was published as Der
Vrtya. Untersuchungen ber die nichtbrahmanische Religion
Altindiens, Stuttgart 1927.
16 Keith, op. cit. p. 402.
17 M.Eliade, Yoga, Immortality and Freedom, 2nd ed. London 1969
(1st ed. 1958, French orig. 1954), see the Foreword.
18 Ibid., pp. 1023.
19 Ibid., pp. 857.
20 Jan Gonda, Die Religionen Indiens, I, Veda und lterer Hinduismus,
Stuttgart 1960, p. 109.
21 Ibid., p. 184.
22 R.N.Dandekar, Rudra in the Veda, Journal of the University of
Poona, vol. I (1953), pp. 99.
23 F.Staal, Exploring Mysticism, Harmondsworth 1975, pp. 18592.
24 K.F.Geldner, Der Rig-Veda, 3 vols., Cambridge, Mass., Harvard U.P.
1951, vol. 3, p. 369.
25 Der Rigveda oder die heiligen Hymnen der Brahmana, zum ersten
male vollstandig ins Deutsche bersetzt mit Commentar und
Einleitung von Alfred Ludwig, 6 vols, Prag 187888, vol. 5, p. 553.
26 H.D.Sharma, Contributions to the History of Brahmanical Asceticism,
Poona 1939, p. 19.
27 J.Miller, Forerunners of Yoga: the Ksin Hymn, A Reappraisal of
Yoga, by G.Feuerstein and J.Miller, London 1971. pp. 95120.
28 Ibid. p. 120, where she quotes A.C.Bose, Hymns from the Vedas,
London 1966, p. 157.
29 A short version of this myth is given in: A.K.Coomaraswamy and
Sister Nivedita, Myths of the Hindus and Buddhists. New York 1967
(first pub. 1913), pp. 31416. A longer version is given in:
H.Zimmer, Maya, der indische Mythos, Zurich 1952, pp. 10119. A
translation of the section on churning the ocean in the Padma
is included in: H.v. Glasenapp, Indische Geisteswelt I, Wiesbaden
(date not given), pp. 1004.
4
MYSTICISM IN THE
AND IN ANKARAS VEDNTA
Pratima Bowes

The term mysticism suggests a view about ultimate reality in which this
reality is known in direct experience and about the relation of this reality to
the world in our ordinary experience which is based on sense perception,
intellection and various processes of reasoning involved in intellection.
No equivalent of the term mysticism exists in Sanskrit and its use with
regard to what we find in the may be misleading: The dominant
philosophical tradition in the West insists that the term is non-cognitive so
that it has no place in any epistemological investigation, cognition being
defined as knowing by sense perception and reasoning. But as far as the
are concerned, the fact that mystical viewing of reality is not a
process of intellection does not mean that what we know in such viewing is
only a state of feeling and not of knowledge.
Mystical viewing amounts to what we call direct experience, in English
usually termed intuition. It is accepted that it may illumine life in some
way, but what it delivers does not qualify for the name knowledge. But
the teachers claim that what they know in such experience is
knowledge (vidy,) indeed such knowledge is higher (para) compared to
the knowledge derived from sense perception and reasoning which is called
lower (apara). It is higher because the understanding of reality one gets
here is such that it can illumine any other kind of understanding of reality
that we have. It is also higher because experience here is not indirect, not
knowledge about, but knowing by being: there is no distance between
the reality known and the knowledge of it, no intermediaries like the senses
and the intellect. This is expressed by such Sanskrit terms as tdtmya or
tadkrita : one knows something because one is it or becomes it. A
mundane example of the difference is knowing hunger by being hungry as
distinct from knowing it by watching someone who behaves in a fashion
that is indicative of hunger.
The human capacity that enables one to be conscious of reality in this
direct fashion is called in Sanskrit bodhi as distinct from the term buddhi
(intellect) which knows that something is so and so by making it an object
of investigation to which one turns ones attention as an investigating
54 BOWES

subject. The term bodhi was used in this sense in Mahyna philosophical
literature for expounding its own non-dualism. , not being
technical philosophy, do not actually use a special term for direct
knowledge, except in KU where the phrase pratibodha viditam occurs in
that sense.
I feel justified in using the Buddhist term bodhi for direct knowledge in
the , because it appears later also in Hindu literature. Buddhism
shared a common cultural background with the rest of the spiritual-religious
thinking in India and many other terms were so shared, especially between
Mdhyamika and Yogcra varieties of Buddhism and Hindu Advaitism.
The point is to stress that mystical viewing is knowledge, because human
beings, participating in tman or the principle of conscious functioning that
is itself self-conscious, are equipped with the capacity to know things
directly just as they are equipped with the senses and the intellect to know
about things.
Since ultimate reality can only be one, some people believe that all
mystical experience must be the same, although its interpretations may
differ in different cultures. I do not share that view and believe that there
are descriptions of different types of mystical experiences even in the
. If the reality being experienced by X, Y and Z in common is the
same in some genuine sense of same, it does not mean that X, Y and Z
necessarily have the same experience of it. The one and the same man, Mr
Smith, is experienced by his wife, children, friends, neighbours, employees
and competitors, but not only can their accounts of what Mr Smith is like as
a person differ, they can have genuinely different experiences of him each
of which is valid. This is so because Mr Smith, although one person, has
many facets and experiencing him involves one or more of these facets.
Only when a simple thing like a mathematical point is involved can it be
said that the content of different experiences of the same thing be thought to
be the same, in the sense of being carbon copies. What is called ultimate
reality is acknowledged to be infinite, i.e. beyond all measure of whatever
magnification can be devised by the human mind, and absolute, i.e. not
limited by the reality of anything else on which its being would be
dependent in some fashionthat is to say, limitless. Surely, a reality like
that should not be thought to be one thing or as simple as a mathematical
point, and there must be more than one way of experiencing it which is
genuine and valid if there is more than one way even in respect of things
which are finite and limited.
The unity and oneness of the ultimate reality is in no way impugned
because men experience it in diverse ways just as the unity and oneness of
Mr Smith is not in jeopardy because different people experience him
differently.
In a scheme where mystical experience means Gods self-revelation to
man there may be some justification for claiming that there is only one kind
THE AND ANKARAS VEDNTA 55

of valid mystical experience, other kinds being spurious (as Zaehner


thought). But the experiences are not of this kind and there is no
reason why in their context a variety of experiences, all genuine and valid,
cannot be permitted.
Then there is also, of course, a difference between
non-dualism, which gives one kind of account of the relationship between
the ultimate and the phenomenal reality, and between non-duality of the
ankaras variety, which gives quite a different account of this relationship.
This difference is rooted in the fact that ankara believes that the
experience of the ultimate can be of only one kind, the kind in which the
phenomenal world disappears. So all our other experiences, that of
phenomenal diversity included, must be of the nature of illusion from the
point of ultimate truth. But the , which base their judgement on
two different kinds of experiences, find room also for phenomenal diversity
within the realms of truth, as will be shown later on, although this is not
often realized by scholars who make their way to the through
ankaras interpretation of them.
One of the terms for the ultimate in the is brahman which
Danielou translates as the divine immensity, and this gives something of
the flavour of the root , to grow, from which this term is derived. The
choice of this root to designate the ultimate is telling, because it suggests
that the ultimate does not have to be conceived as something static, finished
or fixed, as one unambiguous thing. It suggests further that its limitlessness
can hold together both the idea of being that neither originates nor comes to
an end, and of becoming, i.e. of changing forms that do originate and end,
however ones rational faculty may be revolted by this double inclusion, as
ankaras was.
We can, of course, by some effort of imagination picture all becoming as
happening within the bosom of beinga mundane analogy of which would
be what happens when a piece of near-solidified jelly is given a shake. But
in the end we have to accept, as mystical views insist, that the ultimate
holds together opposing properties which reason finds paradoxical and so
insists that mystical perception of the ultimate or the account given of it, or
both, are muddled.
This is understandable if we consider the function of reason as a specific
type of human faculty. I will now make a slight digression and say
something about reason and its function in view of the problem that is
posed by the rational requirement that language be used in a certain way.
The task of reason is to discriminate between things and this can best be
done through directing ones attention to opposing qualities which are the
lynch-pin, so to say, of all discriminative activity. No doubt reality lends
itself to such understanding, but if we believe that it also lends itself to the
bodhi kind of understanding, then things which are opposite and remain
separate on one kind of count, namely that of reason, come together on
56 BOWES

another count where all things, including opposites, make a totality of a


kind which is able to hold them together; we have a mundane example of this
in our experience of an aesthetic whole.
Our understanding of language operates at the level of reason where to
say that something is stationary is to say that it is not moving. In fact, most
of the use of language is in aid of this kind of discrimination. If the same
language with its built-in discriminative attitude is applied to a mystical
experience with its famous lack of discriminative boundaries, the result is a
certain kind of tension.
Being human, we find that we have to use language, but language is so
fashioned that when we use it in respect of a mystical experience we appear
to be talking nonsense. So we say that this experience is indescribable even
though we continue to describe it through a paradoxical use of language.
We have no choice of not using language in respect of what we experience.
The way out of this impasse is to recognize that a paradoxical use of
language is a genuine use of it when it comes to mystical experience.
Reality in that region is such that it can hold together opposing qualities,
and it is because we feel in some ways justified in this pursuit that we also
say that ultimate reality transcends reason.
Transcending reason does not necessarily mean transcending all
understanding with respect to opposites which are discriminated in some
contexts while they are seen to come together in others.
If we do see this, then the demand of reason that if we say that something
is moving, we must not say, at the same time, that it is at rest is not to be
put up as the ultimate criterion of truth; it is acceptable only for
phenomenal purposes where discriminations of this kind are integral to the
living process.
I shall not have the opportunity within the scope of this paper to show
this fully, but it is clear to me that ankaras highly developed sense of
rational requirements made him uneasy with the paradoxical statements of
the and he tried hard to put them in a logical system with a view
to divesting them of their paradoxicality. Like all logical systems his system,
too, involves a gap which cannot be justified in terms of itself. ankaras
logical operations on the have, to my mind, divested them not only
of paradoxicality, but also of the most significant message they carry,
namely their affirmation that all things in their particularity participate in
the nature of the ultimate reality as the infinite and the limitless.
The other term used in the to indicate the nature of the
ultimate is tman. Its translation as ego or soul or even as the soul of
the universe is a deplorable misreading. It is also almost wilful, for the
literature is replete with statements which clearly show tman to be nothing
of the kind. The equation tman = brahman makes it abundantly clear that
it is not an individual entity, indeed entity of any sort, since it has no space-
time connotation. Terms used to describe it (cit, prajna-ghana etc.) show
THE AND ANKARAS VEDNTA 57

that it is of the nature of pure consciousness which is conscious of itself and


that it is not a conscious state or process which is taking place in an
individual mind. Unlike the individual mind, it has no intentional object of
any kind towards which it would be directed, but it is the very principle of
conscious awareness and as such it is self-aware. In accordance with its
functioning an individual knows an object as well as himself as the subject
of that knowledge.
We, as particular egos or personalities, are tman in the sense that we
participate in this mode of functioning and not in the sense that some kind of
spiritual substance is lodged in our bodies which we could claim as our
individual property. The statement aham brahmsmi (I am Brahman) does
not mean that brahman is my personal property. Nor does it mean that it
constitutes my personal ego. The tman, like brahman, is infinite, not
measurable in the way in which a particular state of mind (cetana as
distinct from cit) may be measured according to some criterion. The tman
is absolute, i.e. limitless as a pure function of awareness, itself self-aware.
It is not just a conscious mental state which is, of course, limited by other
states.
The tman neither comes into being nor ever goes out of existence, being
ever there. It may help to think of it as energy in its spiritual dimension, as
efficiency that has no space-time connotation, hence unknowable by
methods which are devised to catch things which do have space-time
connotations. That does not, of course, mean that it is unknowable, for it is
the very principle of knowability in its character as self-aware.
The identification of tman with brahman shows how the ultimate can
have self-existent being, a being of self-awareness which needs nothing else
to be there. And in this sense of completeness of being it is also nanda,
often translated as bliss, but better as delight. (It is only a sense of lack or of
a gap that causes fall from delight of being.)
say that brahman is all this and that holds for tman too.
Therefore energy in its spiritual dimension, conceived as cit, is not
discontinuous with energy that goes into the evolution of the phenomenal
world. Because it is all this, it is the same energy everywhere which
expresses itself differently at different levels of being. Five of them are
mentioned: the physical, the vital, the mental, the conscious and that of
bliss (spiritual).
Brahman is further referred to also as fourfold (in BU, CU, MaU) and
this is, therefore, also true of tman (Sarvam hy etad brahma, ayam tma
brahma, so yam tma : All this is brahman, tman is brahman,
so tman is four-footed). These four feet are: (1) The waking state and the
world of its experience; (2) the state of dream with its shadowy dream
objects; (3) the state of deep sleep where there is no object consciousness,
but consciousness-mass exists in its own beingan inkling of it is a sense
of well-being when one wakes up from deep sleep; finally (4) there is the
58 BOWES

fourth state called turya which is above all this; in it everything becomes
one (advaitam) beyond the distinction of conscious and unconscious and is
unthinkable, unspeakable etc,
tman is thus not to be identified exclusively with its ultimate state of
being beyond all distinctions, nor even as pure consciousness (cit), a
description most often resorted to, but it is to be seen at work in phenomenal
and dream reality as well. It is only the fourth stage which absorbs all
distinctions, but it does not negate them as operating at lower levels; this
also has to be experienced if tman is to be known in the fullness of its
being as the ultimate reality. [Turya is] not that which cognizes the
internal [objects], not that which cognizes the external [objects], not what
cognizes both of them, not a mass of cognition, not cognitive, not non-
cognitive (MaU, 7).1 Because tman is all, this same indescribable
infinite energy brings forth, by an act of voluntary self-limitation, the finite
and the limited world within the expanse of its own limitless being.
The BU talks about two forms of reality: Verily there are two forms of
brahman, the formed and the formless, the mortal and the immortal, the
unmoving and the moving, the manifest existent (sat) and the unmanifest
that (tat) (BU 2, 3, l).2 I believe that this twofold nature of brahman or the
two modes of its being are talked about on the basis of actual experience of
brahman as both formed and formless, as the quotations below will show.
The idea is not that there are two brahmans, but that the same brahman has
opposite characteristics to be realized in distinctive types of mystical
experience, and the fact that such opposing experiences of the same reality
are possible is itself a mystical realization.
First the formless. This is an experience of infinite and limitless being
wherein all particulars are absorbed, including the separate sense of the
experiencing subject, so that this experience cannot properly be said to
qualify as knowledge or consciousness. It cannot be described, because the
language of description requires that there be a reality which is limited by
the presence of another for the sake of description. To begin with the
experiencing subject takes his stand on the world of plurality of which he is
conscious, but then it disappears into indifferentiation and loses its separate
identity: As these flowing rivers tending towards the ocean, on reaching
the ocean, disappear, their name-shape broken up, and are called simply the
ocean, even so of this seer, these sixteen parts tending towards the person,
on reaching the person, disappear, their name-shape broken up, and are
called simply the person. That one is without parts, immortal (PU 6, 5).3
This formless experience is described by Yjavalkya to Maitreyi: As a
lump of salt thrown in water becomes dissolved in water and there would
not be any of it to seize forth as it were, but wherever one may take it it is
salty indeed, so, verily, this great being, infinite, limitless, consists of
nothing but knowledge. Arising from out of these elements one vanishes
away into them. When he has departed there is no more knowledge. Then
THE AND ANKARAS VEDNTA 59

said Maitreyi: In this, indeed you have bewildered me, Venerable Sir, by
saying that when he has departed there is no more knowledge. Then
Yjavalya said: Certainly I am not saying anything bewilderingFor
where there is duality as it were, there one smells another, there one sees
anotherWhereeverything has become the self, then by what and whom
should one smellhearby what and whom should one understand? By
what should one know that by which all this is known? By what, my dear,
should one know the knower? (BU 2, 4, 1314).4
There (in that state) a father is not a father, a mother is not a mother, the
worlds are not the worlds, the gods are not the gods, the Vedas are not the
Vedas. There a thief is not a thiefan ascetic not an ascetic. He is not
followed by good, he is not followed by evil, for then he has passed beyond
all the sorrows of the heart (BU 4, 3, 22).5
To give the final example of the undifferentiated: That, O Grg, the
knowers of brahman call the imperishable. It is neither gross nor fine,
neither short nor longneither shadow nor darkness, neither air nor space,
unattached, without tastewithout eyeswithout measure, having no
within and no without. It eats nothing and no one eats it (BU 3, 8, 8).
Verily that imperishable, O Grg, is unseen but is the seer, is unheard but
is the hearer, unthought but is the thinker, unknown but is the knower.
There is no other seer but this, no other hearer but this, no other thinker but
this, no other knower but this. By this imperishable, O Grg, is space
woven like warp and woof (BU 3, 8, 11).6
The experience of this undifferentiated formless brahman is by its very
nature non-dual in the sense of there being not two things to be
experienced. But the same give also another account of the
brahman experience which is not non-dual in the sense that there is no
second thing present in experience, but in the sense that all things in their
particularity are actually seen as permeated by the same essence which is
tman or brahman. They are non-dual with it as the waves of the sea are
non-dual with the sea, although seen also as separate items.
This non-duality of essence comes from the fact that brahman actually
becomes the world to enjoy diversity through differences of name, shape
and work. In the beginning the world was only self, in the shape of a
personHe had no delightHe desired a second. He became as large as a
woman and a man in close embrace (BU 1, 4, 1 & 3). Now this self is the
world of all beingsof the godsof the seersof the fathersof menof
animals (BU 1, 4, 16).7
There was nothing whatsoever here in the beginningHe created the
mind, thinking let me have a self (mind). Then he moved about,
worshipping. From him, thus worshipping, water was producedHe
divided himself threefoldfiresunand air (BU 1, 2, 1 & 3). At that
time it (brahman) was undifferentiated. It became differentiated by the
60 BOWES

name and form. Therefore even today all this is differentiated by the name
and form (BU 1, 4, 7).8
There are many statements throughout the in which brahman
or tman is identified with this all, because it becomes this all. In addition
there are many accounts which suggest an actual mystical experience of
diversity issuing forth from a primal unity which as an experience is the
very opposite of the one discussed earlier. Brahman becomes differentiated
as the world while remaining inexhaustible as the unity that is holding forth
all these phenomenal differences within its limitless being.
As a spider sends forth and draws in (its thread), as herbs grow on the
earth, as hair (grows) on the head and the body of a living person, so from
the imperishable arises here the universe (MuU 1, 1, 7). As from a lighted
fire laid with damp fuel, various (clouds of) smoke issue forth, even so, my
dear, the Veda, the Yajur Veda, the Sma Veda, Atharvngirasa,
history, ancient lore, sciences, , verses, aphorisms, explanations
and commentaries. From it, indeed, are all these breathed forth (BU 2, 4,
10).
And he who sees all beings in self and the self in all beings shrinks from
nothing (IU, 7).9
The self is indeed brahman, consisting of understanding, mind, life, sight,
hearing, earth, water, air, ether, light and no light, desire and absence of
desire, anger and absence of anger, righteousness and absence of
righteousness and all things (BU 4, 4, 5). He desired, let me become many,
let me be born. He performed austeritycreated all thisentered into it
(and) became both the actual and the beyond, the defined and the
undefined, both the founded and the non-founded, the intelligent and the
non-ingelligent, the true and the untrue. As the real he became whatever there
is here, that is what they call the real (TaU 2, 6, 1).10
Lastly: The self verily is the lord of all beings, the king of all kings. As
all spokes are held together in the hub and felly of a wheel just so in the self
all beings, all gods, all worlds, all breathing creatures, all these things are
held together. This can be realized in a mystical experience of one
becoming the many, but not through rational discourse, as the following
conversation makes clear:
said: This has been explained by you in the manner as
one explains: This is a cow, this is a horse. Explain to me properly the
brahman that is immediately present and directly perceived, that (you say)
is the self in all things. Yjavalkya: That is your self which is within all
things. : Which is within all things, Yjavalkya?
Yjavalkya: You cannot see the seer of seeinghear the hearer of
hearingthink the thinker of thinkingunderstand the understander of
understanding. He is your self which is in all things. Everything else is
afflicted. Thereupon kept silent (BU, 3, 4, 2).11
THE AND ANKARAS VEDNTA 61

Thus the mystical experience of all things issuing out of brahman or


tman does not see it diminished in its character as the infinite and limitless
being. Nor does the non-duality of man and of all things with the ultimate,
proclaimed in the CU in such statements as that though art, suggest in the
context of this type of mystical experience that manyness disappears when
its unity with the one is realized. Now the light which shines above this
heaven, above all, above everything, in the highest world beyond which
there is no higher, verily, that is the same light as this light which is here
within this person (CU 3, 13, 7).12
When we come to ankara the significance of the term non-dualism
changes its meaning. It no longer means that there is no duality of essence
in things despite their manyness as they all arise out of the same ultimate
reality (brahman or tman) like pots and figurines made out of clay. With
ankara it means literally that there are no two things so that reality cannot
be dualistic. In truth only brahman exists, the rest is illusion or at best a
mixture of truth and falsity, but certainly not true in the full sense of the
term. His reasons for holding this position are given in a closely argued
philosophical treatise, , in the usual logical way: If one
said both this and that, one would contradict oneself; if it is this, it cannot
be that; and so it goes on. This is certainly not the way of the mystic and no
such arguments appear in the . If ankara ever had mystical
experience, it was only the kind where plurality disappears into
undifferentiated unity. He certainly did not have the mystical realization of
the opposite kind where the one differentiates itself into the many so often
talked about in the . His logical mind finds the concepts one and
many to be opposites, hence both cannot be true, and since the one is
true, the many is illusory.
ankara treats the statement khalvidam brahma
(everything here is brahman) as saying that everything does not exist as
everything; only brahman exists and everything appears as existing only
through being generated by some illusive power called my and then
superimposed on brahman, the sole reality, by the human mind soaked in
ignorance. In other words, if my and ignorance were not there, brahman
would be everywhere in full and not in its many expressions as the
have it. (My, incidentally, is not to be thought of as brahmans creative
power, as most Hindu thinking does, because it is illusive.)
It is easy to see that this conception of reality corresponds to the kind of
mystical experience illustrated by the image of rivers entering the sea,
abandoning the name and form, with only sea remaining wherever one
looks. Not having the other kind of experience illustrated by sparks coming
out of the same fire, smoke shapes issuing from the same damp fuel or
many spokes held together by the same hub and felly of the wheel, ankara
was unable to think that the many which disappear into the one could really
be genuine expressions of it, nor that as expressions they could still be
62 BOWES

non-dualistic with reality as waves with the sea. So he produced logical


arguments to show why the existence of the many, experienced by us in
common, must have an illusory status, albeit of a cosmic nature, explaining
away all statements to the effect that brahman becomes all that through the
activity of vara, the creator God, who, however, is himself generated by
cosmic illusion.
ankara argues as follows: Butit might be objected that brahman has
in itself elements of manifoldness. As the tree has many branches, so
brahman possesses many powers and energies dependent on these powers.
Unity and manifoldness are therefore both true. Thus a tree considered in
itself is one, but it is manifold if viewed as having branches; so the sea is
itself one, but manifold as having waves and form; so the clay itself is one,
but manifold if viewed with regard to the jars and dishes made of itThis
theory, we reply, is untenable, because in the instance (quoted in the
) the phrase as clay they are true asserts the cause only to be
true while the phrase having its origin in speech declares the unreality of
all effects.13
This is a classic example of philosophers twisting a statement so as to
make it yield the meaning they want. In the the realm of
manyness is associated with the name and form, and this is
quite unexceptionable, because the recognition of the many as particulars (at
least of the kind of recognition human beings have) needs language. But
nowhere has it been said that having a name means unreality. The alleged
instance occurs in CU (6, 1, 4) which properly translated runs as follows:
Just as, my dear, by one clod of clay all that is made of clay can be made to
be known, the different modifications being understood by different names
(nma-dheyam) arising out of speech, clay itself being their truth.
One can notice that the statement simply says that the clay itself is their
truth, not that modifications are false or unreal, a sense that ankara slips
into the idea that they arise out of speech. To understand what is here being
talked about we can best refer to the BU (2, 1, 20) where it is made clear
that, while all things are true as particulars, they also possess one thing in
common as their truth. As a spider moves along the thread, as small sparks
come out of fire, even so from the self come forth all breaths, all words, all
divinities, all beings. Its secret meaning is the truth of the truth. Vital breaths
are the truth and their truth is I (self).14
A distinction is being made here between two kinds of truth, the ordinary
one (satyam) and the higher kind (satyasya satyam,) not between truth and
falsity as ankara alleges. For him the knowledge of brahman is truth while
knowledge of manyness is ignorance (avidy,) a term that is conspicuous
by its absence in such important as BU, CU and TU. It occurs only
once in IU and also in KaU and U, but it does not refer there to the whole
realm of phenomena which is what ankara means by it, following the
Buddhist lead.
THE AND ANKARAS VEDNTA 63

In the the distinction is between higher (para) and lower


(apara) knowledge. Knowing brahman simply in its manifestation without
any understanding of the underlying unity is lower knowledge. Such
knowledge is not illusory and cannot be called avidy in the sense in which
ankara uses this term, although it contains no understanding of the highest
truth. The term avidy when used in the simply means
acceptance of the phenomenal world, by itself, (that is without being
grounded in brahman) as the ultimate reality.
In any event, the Upanisads nowhere say that if something arises out of
speech it is unreal, as ankara asserts. Take the following example: With
the speech, with that self he brought forth all this whatsoever exists here,
the the Yajur Veda, the Sma Veda, the metres, the sacrifices, men
and cattle (BU 1, 2, 5). Verily, the world is a triad of name, shape and
work. As regards names, speech is the source, for from it all names ariseIt
is their brahman, for it sustains all names (BU 1, 6, 1). These three
together are one, this self; the self, though one, is this triad. This is the
immortal veiled by the real. Breath, verily, is the immortal, name and shape
are the real. By them this breath is veiled (BU 1, 6, 3).15
One can see that the veiling of the ultimate truth of non-duality is not by
the unreal and illusory existent, but by the real itself, the world of name and
shape, because of our inability to read their higher truth. This is put into a
totally different idiom by ankara which makes the world of our ordinary
experience, the realm of lower knowledge, hang in the air without any
relationship to the ultimate ground of existence.
ankara finds the idea of many issuing forth from the one unacceptable
also for logical reasons. He recognizes that the scriptural passages are of a
double character; some indicate that brahman is one (devoid of all
distinctions) and eternally the same (unchanging), while others suggest
distinction and change. But the logical mind of ankara asserts that
brahman cannot possess double characteristics and so one set of these
statements must be assumed to be attributing limiting adjuncts to brahman
arising out of nescience or avidy:
The same one and only one brahman cannot at one and the same time be
understood both to possess the quality of modification and yet be
unchangeable, i.e. without that quality of modification also. If the opponent
were to suggest It may well be like something which is both stationary and
at the same time have movement, we reply No, because it has been
particularized as being absolutely unchangeable. It is not possible that one
and the same unchangeable brahman can at one and the same time be the
substratum of many opposite qualities such as being fixed and yet capable of
movement. We have already said that brahman is unchangeable and eternal
because of the denial by the scriptures of its undergoing any
modification.16
64 BOWES

The opponents idea that one and the same thing is both stationary and
moving, put down as illogical by ankara, in fact comes from IU: It, one,
unmoving, moves swifter than the mind. The senses do not attain it for its
being ever ahead. It stands still but outruns everything that runs. In it the
moving air supports all existence (IU 4). Obviously, ankaras brahman is
unequivocally one thing of such simplicity that it cannot be the basis from
which opposite qualities issue forth. It also appears to be of a finite, limited
nature so that undergoing modifications would mean diminution of its being
The BU, which is based on the double mystical experience of all things
both disappearing into and arising out of the one, has no problem of how all
things can arise out of brahman which nevertheless remains unchanged and
unlimited. It sets out the paradoxical character of brahman as the
inexhaustible reality which gives rise to all things and yet remains ever the
same as the full. That is full, this is full. From fullness arises fullness. If
fullness is taken away from fullness, it is fullness itself that remains
(BU 5, 1, 1). This statement itself is proof, apart from many others quoted
earlier, that ankaras statement about scriptures as denying that brahman
undergoes modifications is untrue.
ankara quotes selectively from the scriptures, which is typical of rational
activity, to establish his own idea of one reality without a second: Now
there is the instruction not so, not so (BU 2, 3, 6) and thus it is determined
that in this way, by denying the truth of the imagined aspects of brahman
the real nature of brahman is intimated, and this aggregate of all effects
which depends upon it is denied to be true by the words, not so, not so. It is
logical also that this is a repudiation of all effects as such, by the words, not
so, not so, as they are in the ultimate sense non-existent.17
Let me quote a passage to show that it does not mean that the whole
phenomenal world has been repudiated as ankara would have it: He who
knows it thus attains splendour like a sudden flash of lightning. Now
therefore there is the teaching, not this, not thisthe designation for him is
the truth of truth. Verily, the vital breath is the truth, and he is the truth of
that (BU 2, 3, 6).18
I find here no suggestion that the this or that of ordinary experience,
with which brahmanrevealed like a sudden flash of lightningcannot be
equated, is illusory or is repudiated as having imaginary being; particularly
because the vital breath (presumably the individual experiencing) is
declared to be true.
The world of this or that is the world which is experienced by
everybody. Therefore ankara is not entitled to give it the status of an
imagined object comparable to that of a flower growing in the sky or stamp
it as non-existent like the son of a barren woman. He, in fact, borrows the
Yogcra Buddhist terminology of adhysa, meaning the superimposition of
the attributes of one thing on another, to explain how the world comes to be
there: it is on the part of man a natural procedurewhich has its cause
THE AND ANKARAS VEDNTA 65

in wrong knowledgenot to distinguish the two entities (object and


subject) and their respective attributes, although they are absolutely
distinct, but to superimpose upon each the characteristic nature and the
attributes of the other, and thus, coupling the real and the unreal, to make
use of expressions such as That am I, That is mine.19
The opponent naturally asks: How can there be a superimposition of
sense objects on the universal self which itself is not an object (since we do
not experience it)? ankara answers by arguments which are beside the
point. The universal self, he says, is not a total non-object, because it is
enacted by the word asmat. How this purely verbal point, which has nothing
to do with experience, can help superimposition of one thing on another
(which must be within the field of experience) I fail to see. I presume that
one is hardly likely to indulge in superimposition at the moment of the
revelation of truth. As ankara says himself, for him who sees that his self
is brahman the whole phenomenal world with its actions, agents and results
of actions is non-existent.20
Also, as the individual person, who does the superimposition himself,
does not exist outside the superimposition, one wonders how the whole
process gets going. Brahman, the true reality on which the thing is
superimposed, naturally does not start italso because brahman is not
effected by ignorance which is the reason behind superimposition. The
instant logician that ankara is when it suits his purpose, he refuses to
answer the question about the relationship between brahman and my by
saying that it is unthinkable.
The world is not an impossible entity like the son of a barren woman. It
is not non-existent like something which nobody has ever experienced, for
example a flower growing in the sky. But for ankara it exists only as an
illusory imposition through ignorance, as snake exists in the rope through
imposition by mistake, i.e. ignorance.
If it were not for ankaras affirmation of brahman as being the ultimate
reality and my as being cosmic in nature rather than individual, one could
regard his philosophy as a refurbished version of Yogcra Buddhist
philosophy in which one comes across concepts like avidy, my, adhysa,
and even the snake-rope example in their original version.
But of course, Yogcra philosophy functions within the conceptual
structure of Buddhism with its pressupposition of the flux nature of reality.
conceptual structure, on the other hand, is very different; in it all
things, as they are, are affirmed as expressions of the ultimate. It is changed
drastically when ankara superimposes a reworked version of the Yogcra
philosophy on the . It then plays havoc with the very positive
message of the which is the participation of all levels of
phenomenal existence, in their differences of name and shape and work, in
one ultimate reality which is here everywhere and at the same time
transcends, in its fullness, the categories of space, time and causality.
66 BOWES

NOTES

1 The Principal , ed. with introd., text, translation and notes


by S. Radhakrishnan, London 1953, p. 698.
2 Ibid., pp. 1923, except for the underlined sentence which is my
translation.
3 Ibid., p. 667.
4 Ibid., pp. 2001.
5 Ibid., p. 263.
6 Ibid., p. 2323.
7 Ibid., pp. 1634 and pp. 1712.
8 Ibid., pp. 1512 and p. 166; the translation of the latter quotation has
been modified.
9 Ibid., p. 673, p. 199 and p. 572; the translation of the later quotation
has been modified.
10 Ibid., p. 572 and p. 548; the translation of the latter quotation has
been modified.
11 Ibid., p. 220. The translation has been somewhat altered by me.
12 Ibid., p. 390.
13 E.Deutsch & J.A.B.van Buitenen (ed.), A Source Book of Advaita
Vednta, Honolulu 1971, p. 179.
14 Radhakrishnan, op. cit., p. 190.
15 Ibid., pp. 153 and 183.
16 V.M.Apte (tr.), Brahma-Stra-Shankara-Bhshya, Bombay 1960,
p. 309.
17 Ibid., p. 600.
18 Radhakrishnan, op. cit. p. 194.
19 Deutsch, op. cit., p. 152.
20 Ibid., p. 179.
5
BIRTH OF EXTRAORDINARY
PERSONS: THE BUDDHAS CASE
Minoru Hara

As pointed out by Windisch, religious logic requires that pious followers


of particular religions try to embellish the lives of their founders as much as
possible.1 As a result the stories of their lives become mythified and
adorned with many kinds of legendary material and miraculous events. This
tendency makes itself felt particularly in the accounts of the two most
important events of their lives, namely their birth and death. This is because
birth in the human form on earth involves getting stained by some kind of
impurity and death is contrary to the infinity or eternity of such deified
beings as founders of religions.
The process of mythification, however, varies from religion to religion
according to the cultural background.2 The Buddhas life is no exception to
this process of mythification. It is entangled with a number of legendary
stories imbued with elements peculiar to Indian culture.
Much has been written on the life of the Buddha by scholars both in the
West and the East on the basis of textual materials available in Pli,
Sanskrit, Tibetan and Chinese. These textual studies have also been
combined with those in other disciplines such as history, archaeology and
art history. As early as 1948 Lamotte surveyed important studies on the
subject published by then, critically sorted out the legends and identified
five stages in their formation.3 Being myself a student of Hindu religion and
literature, I propose to discuss some points of the Buddhas birth story in
the light of the Hindu concept of which is said by Lamotte to
be la douler qui est la plus grave parmi toutes les doulers.4
To begin with, we shall give a brief survey of the legendary stories of the
Buddhas birth as related in the Acchariyabbhutasutta (M), the
Mahpadnasutta (D), Nidnakath, Mahvastu, Lalitavistara,
Buddhacarita and their Chinese equivalents.5
To illuminate the peculiarity of the Buddhas birth we shall next discuss
some selected passages from Hindu religious literature which describe the
as it is experienced by ordinary human beings. Finally we
shall set these two in contrast and investigate some problems which may
have contributed to the formation of legends of the Buddhas birth.
68 HARA

I
After careful scrutinies from the heaven when and where to be
incarnated (paca-mah-vilocana), the Bodhisatta, mindful and conscious
6 descended therefrom into the womb of his mother. Four

deities accompanied him as his guard with swords in their hands


(N), saying: Let no one, be he human or non-human or whosoever, do
harm to the Bodhisatta or to his mother (m M, D;
N). No sickness arose in his mother, she was
happy, with unwearied body. She could see, within her body, the Bodhisatta
as plainly as one could see a thread passed through a transparent gem (M, D).
When he was born, gods received him first and then human beings. Prior
to his touching the ground (M, N) four deities received him. According to N
four pure-minded (suddha-citta) deities brought a golden net upon which
they received the Bodhisatta. He came forth stainless (visada) from the
womb of his mother, undefiled (amakkhita) by liquid (udda,) mucus
(semha) or blood (ruhira). Completely immune from uncleanness, the
Bodhisatta and his mother are compared to a gem laid down on Benares
muslin, the one does not stain the other, but both embellish the other by
their purity. Nevertheless, two streams of water fell from the sky, one cold
and one hot, for the deities to do the necessary bathing of the Bodhisatta
and his mother. According to N four kings received the Bodhisatta from the
hands of the four deities who had received him in the golden net on a cloth
of antelope skin soft to the touch. A large, white parasol was held over him
and a pair of chowries (cmara) were fanned to avert insects from him.7
The Bodhisatta then surveyed all the quarters and in a lordly voice
proclaimed: I am the chief in the world, I am the eldest and I am the
foremost. This is my last birth. There is now no rebirth (punabbhava).
Admitting some minor differences in details, such are the main lines of
the Buddhas birth story as preserved both in Pli and Sanskrit texts.
However, in addition to them the Sanskrit tradition introduces a new
specific element unknown to the Pli materials, namely that the Bodhisatta
was born out of the right side ( prva) of his mother, instead of
passing through her yoni; and this element of ayonija has been transmitted
into the Chinese translations and equivalents.8

II
From these miraculous birth stories of the Buddha, the Wunderkind, let us
turn to the descriptions of birth stories of ordinary human beings as given in
Hindu literature. In addition to general physiological and embryological
descriptions in medieval Hindu medical treatises,9 We have a number
of Hindu religious texts which tell us of the process of human birth in the
light of the theory of transmigration, especially in connection
with .10
BIRTH OF EXTRAORDINARY PERSONS 69

Let us start with the description of as given in


, a commentary on Pupatastra. After giving the well-
known threefold (dhytmika, dhibhautika and adhidaivika) definition of
suffering ( ,) proceeds to introduce another classification of
it which is of five kinds, being composed of garbha, janman, ajna, jar
and . Below we shall give a translation of the passages which
describe the garbhaand with that of the first part of
.11
First, suffering in the womb is as follows: when an individual soul
is placed in his mothers womb (udara,) like a man whose limbs are
crammed into a broken cart, he necessarily experiences the
annoyances of confinement; he has no room, not sufficient space to bend,
stretch out etc.,12 but is obstructed in all his motions like a prisoner
stupefied in a dark and doorless chamber. Why? Because he has
consciousness (cetanatvt) and the power of experiencing and
because he identifies himself with those properties (tan mayatvt). The
body and the sense-organs , on the other hand, do not
[suffer]. Why? Because they lack consciousness (acetanatvt) and the
power of experiencing and because they do not identify themselves with
those properties.
Also there is suffering at birth ( ) . When a child is born,
his face is immersed in a mud of faeces, he is splashed with showers of urine,
he is tormented by having all the apertures of his body squeezed shut by the
tightness of the passage through the vagina; and crushed in his bones, soft
spots and joints, he is born wailing and screaming. Then, as he is touched
by the unaccustomed outer air which meets him at birth13 his sharp pain is
obvious. It is this [suffering at birth] that brings about the loss of latent
impression ( ) which is the cause of memory of his previous
births ( ). It is the individual soul himself who
experiences this suffering at birth. Why? Because he has consciousness and
the power of experiencing and because he identifies himself with those
properties.
Also, there is the suffering of ignorance ( ). With his body
completely given over to egoism , he does not know who he is,
whence he has come, to whom he belongs, by what form of bondage he has
been bound,14 what he should do, what he should not do,15 what he should
eat. what he should not eat, what he should drink, what he should not drink.
what is truth (satya,) what is falsehood (asatva,) what is knowledge
(jna,) what is ignorance (ajna). It is the individual soul himself who
experiences the suffering of ignorance
A reader who is well versed in the texts will be struck by the
similarities of this classification of by to those found in
the VP 6, 5, 1ff. and the BrahP 233, 1ff.16 Despite differences which exist
between version and that of the , whose accounts are very
70 HARA

much abridged and composed in verses and whose classification is sixfold,


with the addition of hell (naraka) suffering, the similarity between them is
remarkable. They share also the threefold definition of suffering mentioned
above. Here is the version:
An individual soul (jantu,) possessing a subtle body (sukumra tanu,)
resides in his mothers womb which is imbued with various sorts of
impurity. He stays there being folded in the membrane surrounding the
foetus (ulba) and distorted all around his back, neck and bones. He
experiences severe pains, while being tormented immensely by the foods
his mother takes which are to him extremely acid, bitter, pungent, hot and
saline.17 Incapable of extending or contracting his own limbs and reposing
amidst a mud of faeces and urine, he is in every way incommoded. He is
unable to breathe. Yet, being endowed with consciousness (sacaitanya) and
thus calling to memory many hundreds of [previous] births, he resides in
his mothers womb with great pains, being bound by his previous deeds.
When he is about to be born, his face is turbid with faeces, blood, urine
and semen. His bones and muscles are hurt by the prjpatya wind. He is
turned head downwards and is finally expelled in a state of extreme
exhaustion from his mothers womb by the vehement wind which causes a
final delivery. No sooner is he born than he swoons in contact with the
external air and then is deprived of knowledge (vijna). He is tormented as
if his limbs are all pierced with thorns or cut into pieces by a saw.18 He is
like a worm which falls down upon the ground from a foul-smelling sore. He
is not in a position to scratch, nor even to turn himself, but is completely
left to the will of others for his bathing and nourishment. Laid down upon a
dirty bed, he is bitten by insects and gadflies and yet has no power to drive
them away.
[Thus] there are many sorts of suffering attending birth and immediately
succeeding to birth that one meets at his state of being a child (or stupefied,
bla-bhva). These derive from outside world and so forth, Enveloped by
the gloom of ignorance (ajna) and with his inner organs bewildered, he
does not know whence he has come, who he is, whither to go, and what is
his nature (kimtmaka,) by what form of bondage he has been bound, what
is the cause, what is the non-cause, what he should do, what he should not
do, what he should say, what he should not say.
These two passages of the and the VP, which are
unfortunately still undatable, but similar in the process of their presentation,
illustrate the following points: it is the , the severe pains one
experiences at the time of his birth, that is responsible for the loss of
memory ( ) and knowledge (vijna) which the ordinary human being
in the state of embryo is supposed to possess until the last moment of his
stay in his mothers womb; this is caused in the conscious
embryo by his co-residence with the turbid elements, by the tightness of
passage through the vagina,19 and by the inevitable encounter with the
BIRTH OF EXTRAORDINARY PERSONS 71

vehement winds of various sorts both inside and outside of his mothers
womb. Becuase of this suffering at birth the ordinary human being becomes
bla, meaning both stupefied and child. This is also the starting point of
further suffering caused by ignorance.
However, what is the embryo doing while still in his mothers womb
with knowledge and full memory of previous births? This can be illustrated
by a passage from the GU20 which describes the physiological development
of the embryo from the time of conception (kalaha, arbuda etc.) and which
finds its parallel in the second of the Nirukta :21
Now, in the ninth month [from the conception] he comes to possess in
entirety the distinctive marks and knowledge (jna). He calls to
memory his previous births and recognizes his karman, virtuous as well as
sinful. [Then, he laments.]
Seeing through thousands of wombs, [I have dwelt in the past, now I
remember that] I ate many sorts of food and sucked various breasts. I
repeated birth and death again and again. I am now tormented alone by the
karman, virtuous and sinful, which I have done for the sake of my
attendants. They have gone away, partaking of the fruits (of their own
karman). Alas, I sink into the ocean of suffering and find no remedy. If I am
released from this womb, I shall resort to Mahevara who destroys sins and
grants emancipation (mukti) as a result. If I am released from this womb, I
shall resort to who destroys sins and grants emancipation as a
result. If I am released from this womb, I shall study and Yoga
which destroys sins and grants emancipation as a result. If I am released
from this womb, I shall meditate upon the eternal brahman.
But when he reaches the orifice of the womb (yoni-dvara,) he is afflicted
by restraint (yantra) and expelled forcibly22 from the womb with great
difficulty. No sooner is he born than he is touched by the wind and
he neither remembers the number of births and deaths [he has experienced
in the past] nor recognizes his karman, virtuous or sinful.
This passage tells us how the embryo recalls his previous births and is so
disgusted with the pains of transmigration that he makes up his mind never
to repeat the same in future. He is intelligent enough to think of
philosophical teachings and pious enough to resort to a particular god. But
all this is reduced to naught because of the suffering at birth which makes
him a stupefied child. However, the recollection of previous births, disgust
with transmigration and determination to obtain final release on the part of
the embryo are recurring motifs in the literature. Two excerpted
examples are given here, one from the Pretakalpa of GP 6, 9ff., which is
almost parallel to BP 3, 31, 5ff., and the other from MP 32, 63ff. paralleled
by Uttarakhanda of GP 32, 63ff.23
With his head placed in his belly and his back and neck curved in his
mothers womb, he lies unable to move his limbs like a bird in a cage. Due
to the divine ordinanfce (daivt,) memory comes back to him. While calling
72 HARA

to mind the deeds produced during hundreds of [previous] births, he sighs


deeply [thinking] where to find refuge (1213).
Then the soul, which is called jantu, jva and also ,24 implores the god
with his hands clasped and faltering voice (14).
I seek refuge in , the husband of ri, the supporter of the world and
the destroyer of sins, who is compassionate to those who resort to him.
Bewildered by your my I came to the cycle of transmigration
due to my self-conceit (abhimna) with regard to my body, son and wife
(1617)If I am released from the womb, Ill remember thy feet. I shall
take means (upya) by which I may obtain the final emancipation (mukti).
Fallen into a well of faeces and urine I am burnt by the fire of the belly. I
wish to get out of it, but when can I get out? I seek refuge in him alone who
has given me this knowledge (vijna) and is compassionate to the afflicted.
Let not this transmigration occur to me again (1921).
Despite this solemn determination with pious devotion to the
god, the wind of delivery pushes him head downward to birth. He
experiences intolerable pain when he issues forcibly out of his mothers
womb. He can hardly breathe and then loses memory ( ).
Fallen upon the ground, he moves like a worm on excrement. Deprived
of knowledge (jna) he cries repeatedly, being led to the course opposite
[to his determination]. If one could keep holding his determination (mati)
with regard to his previous birth, illness and death, and if the determination
remained firm enough, who would not be liberated from the bondage [of
transmigration] (267).
No sooner has he come out of his mothers womb than my
assaults him and by this everything becomes out of control of his own
independent will. He is nourished by people who do not understand his
wishes and is unable to refuse what is done by them against his will (28
30). Laid upon a dirty bed which is befouled by perspiration, he is neither
able to scratch his own limbs, nor to sit, rise and move. Mosquitos, gadflies,
bugs and others bite the soft-skinned one who is crying and deprived of
knowledge (jna,) just as insects bite a little worm (312).25
The second example from MP II, 1320 follows in full:
Numerous stages of his transmigration ( ) occur to his
memory, hence afflicted by this or that he becomes disgusted. He thinks:
Never again shall I thus act, when once I am delivered from this womb.
Assuredly, I shall so strive that I do not again undergo conception. Thus he
meditates, recollecting the hundreds of pains attending birth which he
himself experienced aforetime and those [pains] which also derived from
fate (daiva) and the outer world (bhta). Then, in the course of time, he
(jantu) is turned head downwards when he is born in the ninth or tenth
month. While he is being expelled, he is pained by the prjpatya wind. He
then issues out wailing, because he is afflicted by pains in his heart. Once
expelled out of the womb, he falls into an intolerable swoon. But he gains
BIRTH OF EXTRAORDINARY PERSONS 73

consciousness (cetan) again when he comes into contact with [outer] air.
Then my which effaces [consciousness] assails him. Then his
tman is bewildered by it and he loses his knowledge (jna). Bereft of
knowledge he (jantu) partakes then of the state of being a bla (stupefied
child).
The sublime thought (mati) on the part of the embryo to put an end to
transmigration26 may or may not be accompanied by an appeal to particular
deities. The decisive factors which cause the fatal loss of memory and
knowledge vary from text to text: the tightness of the vaginal passage in K,
contact with the outer air in K and VP, vyu in GU, parturition
wind in GP and my in MP.27
Despite minor differences these passages of Hindu religious literature
agree with each other in making responsible for the loss of
intelligence. They contrast the prenatal mental situation with the postnatal
one, while attributing to the former the blissful state of being fully furnished
with insight and to the latter its loss with misery of all sorts. The
intervenes between the two. Two Buddhist treatises have
come to my notice which describe it in a comparable manner, namely Vism
and Akb, but neither of them attributes the complete loss of insight to the
. However, it is met occasionally in some texts of the Chinese
.28

III
From the descriptions of suffering which the ordinary human beings meet
at the time of birth, let us come back to the Buddhas birth stories and
compare the two.
First, ordinary human beings are said to pass through five stages of
embryonic development, kalala, arbuda, pe, ghana and prakha29 and it
is toward the end of the prenatal period that the embryo is endowed with
consciousness (caitanya) and knowledge (jna).30 The Buddha, on the
other hand, is said to possess consciousness and knowledge from the very
beginning.31 He made the five investigations from the heaven,
entered into Mys womb, stayed there and issued therefrom, all while
being conscious and mindful (sata sampajna).
Second, the ordinary embryo experiences pain while he resides in his
mothers womb. He is confined in a dark, doorless chamber of the womb
which is often compared to hell.32 Not only is he tormented by his mothers
actions, but he torments her.33 The Buddha, however, stayed in his mothers
womb comfortably without giving her any pain.34
Third, the ordinary embryo is infested with all sorts of impurity (mala)
both in his prenatal state and at the time of delivery. The baby newly born
out of his mothers womb35 is often compared to a worm falling from a
foul-smelling sore. The Buddha is immune from impurity . He
74 HARA

and his mothers womb are compared to a gem placed on Benares muslin;
both are pure and embellish each other.36
Fourth, when an ordinary human being is born he falls on the ground like
a worm from a sore on excrements. Bereft of free will he is left in complete
dependence on others for bathing and nourishment. But the Buddha was
received by the devaputras before he reached the ground and was bathed
with two jet-streams descended from the sky.37
Fifth, an ordinary baby is laid on a dirty bed and is unable to turn around.
Insects bite him, but he cannot scratch and drive them away. The Buddha
was laid on a beautiful bed with canopies guarded by four deities with
Brahma holding an umbrella over him and ngas fanning him with their
chowries to protect him from the insects.38
The succeeding events of the Buddhas seven steps and his famous
proclamation are by themselves miraculous enough to require no further
comment.39 They are, of course, contrasted by accounts about
newly-born infants inability to move, walk and speak anything other than
inarticulate loud cries.40
However, above all these distinctive features which embellish the
Buddhas birth, a point of far greater importance seems to rest in the fact
that he is ayonija41, that is, he was born not by passing through the tightness
of his mothers yoni, but issued out of her right side ( prva). Human
beings endowed with extraordinary qualities are supposed to have an
extraordinary origin and even a particular mode of coming into existence
similar to extraordinary birth of gods and sages abounding in Sanskrit
literature.42 Indra himself is said to have been born from his mothers right
side, Aurva from the thigh, from the hand, from the head
and from the armpit.43 But, besides this intention on the part of
Buddhist authors of legends to raise their founder to the rank and dignity of
ancient gods and sages, we have an impression that this birth story may
well have been designed to release the Buddha from the suffering at birth.
If the Buddha is ayonija, he is free from which normally
brings about stupefaction. He is therefore privileged to preserve the
memory of his previous births ( )44 and the sublime thoughts (mati,
jna) which the embryo holds in his prenatal state.45 As we have seen
above, the embryo recalls the suffering of transmigration, and being
disgusted with it (nirveda,) he determines not to repeat the same in future.
This determination, blotted out by in ordinary babies is
retained by the infant Buddha thanks to his being ayonija so that he can
proclaim after his birth: In all the world I am the chief, best and foremost.
This is my last birth, and I shall never be born again. The last portion of
this proclamation gives us an impression as if it were an outgrowth of the
determination made by the embryo as seen in the previous chapter.
These points of contrast given above may illustrate some peculiarities of
devices used by the Buddhist authors of the Buddhas birth story for the
BIRTH OF EXTRAORDINARY PERSONS 75

mythification of their founder. This process of mythification is strongly


tinged with the general cultural background of India as revealed in Hindu
religious literature. One perceives that these devices are in evidence
particularly in the Buddhist Sanskrit texts: Mahavstu, Lalitavistara,
Buddhacarita and their Chinese equivalents. It is obvious that mythification
is much stronger here than in Pli. If it is true that the story of the Buddhas
birth out of his mothers right side is peculiar to the Sanskrit tradition and
unknown to the Pli literature,46 it may mean that Pli Buddhists had no
need to save the Buddha from the which is so prominent a
feature among Hindus. This could be a theme for future research by a
competent Buddhist scholar.

NOTES

1 E.Windisch, Buddhas Geburt und die Lehre von der


Seelenwanderung, Leipzig 1908, pp. 172 & 197.
2 Ibid., p. 222.
3 .Lamotte, La Lgende du Buddha, Revue de lhistoire des
religions 134 (1948), pp. 3773. Cf. also Histoire du Bouddhisme
Indien, Louvain 1958, pp. 718ff.
4 .Lamotte, Le trait de la grande vertu de sagesse, tome II. Louvain
1949, repr. 1967, p. 890.
5 The following sources have been used:
The Majjhima Nikya, ed. R.Chalmers, London 1889, vol. 2, pp.
11923. Its Chinese counterpart is found in Taisho I, pp. 46971.
The Dgha Nikya, ed. T.W.Rhys Davids & J.E.Carpenter. London
1903, vol. 2, pp. 1215. Here the story is related in connection with
the Bodhisatta Vipassin. The corresponsing Sanskrit text has been
edited by E.Waldschmidt, Das Mahvadnastra, Abhandlungen der
Deutschen Akademie der Wissenschaften zu Berlin 1953, pp. 1820.
Its Chinese equivalent is in Taisho I, pp. 1ff.
The Jtaka, ed. V.Fausboll, London 1877, vol. I, pp. 513.
Le Mahvastu, ed. E. Senart, Paris 1882 & 1890, vol. I, pp.
193229 , and vol. II, pp. 145.
Lalita Vistara, ed. S.Lefmann, Halle 1902, pp. 7693.
The Buddhacarita, ed. E.H.Johnston, Calcutta 1935, pp. 13.
Comparative and analytical studies have been made by A.Bareau,
La lgende de la jeunesse du Buddha dans les
anciens, Oriens Extremus 9, Wiesbaden 1962, pp. 633; and La
jeunesse du Buddha dans les et les anciens,
BEFEO 61, Paris 1974, pp. 199274.
6 For this phrase cf. R.O.Franke, Der Buddha als ernst bedacht und
vollbewusst, Festgabe H.Jacobi, Bonn 1926, pp. 32930; H.Lders,
Beobachtungen ber die Sprache des buddhistischen Urkanons,
76 HARA

Berlin 1954, pp. 1578. As regards its Sanskrit usage in the Buddhist
texts, see F.Edgerton, Buddhist Hybrid Sanskrit Dictionary, New
Haven 1953, p. 577.
7 Cmara in this context is unknown to M and D. In N, however, a
white parasol is held by the Mahbrahma, also in the Sanskrit
tradition, cf. Mhvs I, 220, II & II, 22, 122; L 84, 3 & 84, 1718. Cf.
Windisch, op. cit., pp. 1306.
8 Cf. E.J.Thomas, The Life of Buddha as Legend and History, London
1927, p. 34. Cf. also B I, 11 (yoni-ajta). For Chinese versions see
Taisho I, 4b, 153c154a; III, 463c, 473c, 494a, 553a, 618a, 627a,
6867; IV, 1a, 58c. In the corresponding Chinese version of the Pli
Acchariyab- bhutasutta (M) the Bodhisatta is said to have stayed in
the right side of his mother, but not issued out from there (Taisho I,
470a). However, it is generally believed that the male embryo resides
in the mothers right side and the female one in the left. Cf. J.Jolly,
Medizin, Strassburg 1901, p. 55.
9 Cf. e.g. Jolly, op. cit., pp. 535, Windisch, op. cit., pp. 86ff. and
Reinhold F.G.Mller, Altindische Embryologie, Nova Acta Leopol
dina, Neue Folge 17, Leipzig 1955, pp. 552.
10 For Vedic references cf. P.Rolland, Un fragment mdical vdique;
Le premier du bhtotpati, Mnchener Studien
zur Sprachwissenschaft 30 (1972), pp. 12938. For Jaina embryology
cf. C.Caillat, Sur les doctrines mdicales dans le Tandulaveyliya,
Indologica Taurinensia 2 (1975), pp. 4555. For further references to
in Chinese and Japanese literature cf. my Japanese
article Shoku, Festschrift K.Tamaki, Tokyo 1977, pp. 667ff.
11 Pupatastra with Panchrthabhshya of , ed. R.A.Sastri,
TSS 143 (1940), p 141, lines 16ff. For the threefold division of
suffering see the I. For further references cf. M.Hara,
Indo-Iranian Journal 16 (1974), pp. 5960.
12 For this etc. cf. stra 1, 1, 7 (
kucanam gamanam iti ).
13 The phrase here tasyanucitena bhyena vyun jananvartena
may be rendered as he was touched by the unaccustomed
outer air and whirlwind (varta) which causes ones birth.
14 Or it may simply mean who is my relative?
15 We read kim akryam for kim in
conformity with the following and peyam
apeyam, although we have kim in a similar
context of the VP 6, 5, 22.
16 , The Shri Venkateshwar Press, Bombay 1910, pp.
2767; , ASS 28 (1895), pp. 5612.
17 For these influences of the mothers food and drink over the embryo
see E.Abegg, Der Pretakalpa des , eine Darstellung
BIRTH OF EXTRAORDINARY PERSONS 77

des hinduistischen Totenkultes und Jenseitsglaubens, Berlin und


Leipzig 1921, p. 93, note 6 (VI, 11); Visuddhimagga, London 1921, p.
500, lines 1720; ad 96, 32 (The Adyar
Library Series 93, p. 864); MhB 13, 117, 28; and Taisho 14, p. 796a,
17, p. 412c, etc.
18 The similes of thornes and saw are also met in Surevaras
Taittiryopani- 2, 193 (ASS 13, p. 82), tr. by
J.M.van Boetzelaer, Leiden 1971.
19 This is the same as in
the Vs 96, 133, and possibly as yoni-yantra (restraint in the yoni)
which is found in the AP (ASS 41) 369, 27 (yoni-yantratah
pidyamana), PP 2, 66, 95 (yoni-yantra-prapidana) and BrP 30 (yoni-
yantra-pidita, BI text 1891, p. 376, line 7). According to PP 2, 8,
1213 the yoni expands to 24 at the time of birth, whereas the
embryo expands to 25, hence its pain (cf. also and Vs
Adyar Library series 93, p. 865). On the general meaning of yoni cf.
L.Renou, Lacception premiere du mot sanskrit yoni (chemin),
Bulletin de la socit de linguistique de Paris 41 (1941), pp. 1824.
For yantra itself cf. GU 4 (BI text, p. 14, line 6 ),
Ysm 3, 83 ( iva ), and Su 2,
197 and 198 (yantrd iva vinirmukta, ASS 13,
p. 82).
20 The Atharvana Upanishads, BI 249, Calcutta 1872, pp. 1314. For
studies on this see A.Weber, Indische Studien 2, Berlin
1853, pp. 6571; R.Schmidt, Beitrge zur indischen Erotik, Berlin
1922, p. 396; and E.Windisch, op. cit., p. 87.
21 R.Roth, Yska Nirukta mit den Darmstadt repr. 1976, pp.
1901. This portion of Nirukta is quoted by ad Ysm 3, 83.
22 ; here yantra may be equivalent to yoni-yantra or
simply an adverb , forcibly.
23 The (Sroddhra), with English translation, Sacred
Books of the Hindus, vol. 9, Allahabad 1911, pp. 4651.
Le , ou histoire potique de Krishna, traduit et
publie par E.Bournouf, tome I, Paris, 1840, pp. 2735. The
ed. K.M.Banerjea. BI 28 (1862), pp. 824.
The , The Shri Venkateshwar Press, Bombay 1906,
p. 199. Cf. also W.Kirfel, Ein medizinisches Kapitel des
, Asiatica (Festschrift F. Weller). Leipzig 1954, pp. 3423.
24 The individual soul is called by a large variety of names: tman in PP
2, 7, 34 & 42; 2, 8, 3, & 8 etc.; in PsS; jva in PP 2, 66, 39 &
43 etc.; jantu in VP 6, 5, 10, MP 11, 9 etc.; dehin in NP 1, 32, 12 &
21 etc.; in BP 3, 31, 11 & 22 etc.; nara in MhB 14, 18, 4 etc. Cf.
also Windisch, op. cit., pp. 12ff. (sattva, gandharva, devaputra,
vijna, nmarpa) and pp. 84ff. (buddhi, ).
78 HARA

25 I owe a critical translation and copious notes to the work of E.Abegg,


op. cit., pp. 919. Cf. also J.J.Meyer, Sexual Life in Ancient India
(Indian ed. 1971), pp. 3669.
26 For other occurrences of this sublime thought cf. Abegg, op. cit., p.
95, note 2; AP 369, 26 (ASS 41); PP 2, 8, 10; and Su 2, 18996
(ASS 13).
27 In the Buddhist texts the wind which causes ones birth is said to be
brought about by karman. Cf. N, p. 52, line 25; Vism, p. 500, line 27
(kammajavta;) and , ed. P.Pradhan, Patna
1967, p. 130, lines 78 (karma-vipkaja-vyu). The idea of this wind
is preserved further in the Chinese and Japanese Buddhist literature.
The concept of karmdi-marut is also met in Su 2, 181.
28 Cf. Taisho 13, 169b; 32, 726b; 15, 188a; 234c; and 17, 412c-413a.
As for the references in the Jaina texts, cf. Ta 25 (tena
sarai nappano,) text ed. W.Schubring,
Wiesbaden 1969.
29 For these terms cf. L.de la Valle Poussin, LAbhidharmakoa de
Vasubandhu, Louvain 1926, p. 58; .Lamotte, Le trait, p. 270 &
La somme du grand vhicule , Louvain 1974, p. 54 & p.
*13*; Caillat, op. cit., p. 51 (Ta 17); Windisch, op. cit., pp. 879;
Abegg, op. cit., p. 92 (P 6, 67); van Boetzelaer, op. cit., p. 84
(Su 2, 170- 1); R.A. Stein, Le danses masques lamaques
et la thorie des mes, Liebenthal Festschrift (Sino-Indian Studies 5),
ntiniketan 1957, p. 214; S.Tsuda, The , Tokyo
1974, p. 75. For Chinese texts see Taisho 17, 412c; 30, 283a & 284c
& 285a etc.
30 The time of entering of consciousness into the embryo fluctuates from
the seventh to the ninth month in the texts. Cf. Abegg, op.
cit., p. 94, note 7.
31 Cf. Akb 3, 16 and Poussin, op. cit., p. 54.
32 Cf. Abegg, op. cit., p. 93, note 6; MaiU 3, 4; Vsm p.501,
line 25 (gtha-narake viya mtu-gabbhe); Akb 3, 15; Ta 27
. In Su 2,194 & 196 ones mothers womb is said to
be worse than hell.
33 Cf. e.g. BrP p. 376, lines 46 (mtu cpi kurvan)
34 Cf. Windisch, op. cit., pp. 11617.
35 A description of the impurity of the womb is a recurring motif in
Sanskrit literature. O.Bthlingk, Indische Sprche, St. Petersburg
187073, nos. 223:2259, 3411, 4777, 7186; MhB 11,4,4; 12,206,6;
13,117,28; Akb p. 130, lines 12ff. (Poussin p. 59); Vism p. 500, lines
58; Ta 2730; Su 2,194.
36 Cf. Windisch, op. cit., pp. 1279.
37 Ibid., pp. 126 & 12930.
BIRTH OF EXTRAORDINARY PERSONS 79

38 Cf. B 1,17 & N p. 53, lines 1617; Mhvs, 1, 220, 1112 & II, 22,
1213.
39 Cf. Windisch, op. cit., pp. 13035.
40 Cf. Pr 6, 31; 6, 29; 6, 26; 6, 32; MP 11, 17; K (TSS 143) p. 142, line
3; Su (ASS 13) 2, 198.
41 For ayonija in general, cf. Windisch, op. cit., pp. 1846. As regards
Sts birth, we have now an article by C.Bulke, La naissance de
St. BEFEO 46 (1952), pp. 10717.
42 Cf. Hara, Indra and Tapas, The Adyar Library Bulletin 39 (1975), p.
157; E.Senart, Essai sur la lgende Buddha, Paris 1882, p. 249; A.
Foucher, La vie du Buddha, Paris 1949, p. 43; A.Bareau, BEFEO 61,
p. 206.
43 Cf. B 1,10 and E.H.Johnston, note ad loc. Also Taisho 24, p.
100c101a; and R. Gnoli, The Gilgit Manuscript of the
vastu, Rome 1977, pp. 16ff. I owe this reference to the late Prof. J.
Brough.
44 Johnston translated B 1, 11 na as he was
born not ignorant but fully conscious and rightly commented:
probably it means remembering his previous births in this
connection. Windisch also often translated (Pli sata) as mit
der Erinnerung [an sein frheres Dasein], op. cit., p. 35, p. 88 etc.
45 For prenatal experiences in general cf. F.B.J.Kuiper, Cosmogony
and Conception. A Query, History of Religions 10 (1970), pp.
91138, esp. pp. 115ff. The first reference in Sanskrit literature to
prenatal experience and memory of previous births is found in RV 4,
27, 1 and AU 4,6. For studies on this story cf. also U. Schneider, Die
Komposition der , Indo-Iranian Journal 7, pp. 58
9; Der Somaraub des Manu, Wiesbaden 1971, pp. 10ff. Also:
Windisch, op. cit., pp. 62 & 91.
46 In N p. 50,. lines 213 we read only that the Bodhisatta entered his
mothers womb through her right side, but there is no mention of his
birth therefrom. Cf. also Thomas, op. cit., p. 34 and our note 8 above.
80
6
CONSCIOUSNESS MYSTICISM IN
THE DISCOURSES OF THE BUDDHA
Peter Harvey

In this paper I seek to investigate central descriptions of mystical


experience in the suttas of the Pli Canon. This literature clearly concerns
itself with forms of mystical experience and the path which leads to them.
Though mysticism can also exist in a doctrinal form, not much is said on
this matter. The Pli suttas represent, in general, an early phase in the
development of Buddhism and only contain hints at what doctrines might
best fit their descriptions of the higher forms of mystical experience,
especially those pertaining to nibbna.
In the Theravda school mystical doctrine on the nature of nibbna is
still minimal, but there is a tendency to stress the complete otherness of
nibbna from .1 There are good grounds for doing this in the Pli
suttas, but there is in them also material suggestive of a Vijnavda-type
interpretation (nibbna as a radical re-ordering of consciousness), and other
material suggestive of nyavda-type interpretation (linking nibbna to
the seeing through of empty phenomena). It is on this material that I shall
focus. In showing thus the common experiential ground of different
doctrinal formulations in Buddhism, this paper will provide a case-study of
how one group of mystical experiences can contain the seeds of a range of
mystical doctrines which emphasize one or other aspect of these
experiences.

NIBBNA
The classic description of nibbna, apparently as a metaphysical state, is
at Ud 80:
There exists, monks, that sphere (yatana) where there is neither solidity,
nor cohesion, nor heat, nor motion, nor the sphere of infinite space, nor the
sphere of infinite consciousness, nor the sphere of nothingness, nor the
sphere of neither-perception-nor-non-perception; neither this world, nor a
world beyond, nor both, nor sun and moon; there, monks, I say, there is no
coming (gati) and going (gati,) no maintenance (thiti,) no decease (cuti)
and rebirth (upapatti); that, surely, is without support, it has no functioning,
82 HARVEY

it has no object ( appavattam )this is just the


end of dukkha.2
This example of negatively couched mysticism certainly seems to present
nibbna as a non-comprehendable, radically transcendent metaphysical
state. I would like to suggest, however, that when this passage is compared
with other accounts of the goal in the Pli suttas, it starts to become more
amenable to analysis, and to bear a meaning which is consonant with a
Vijnavda-type interpretation of nibbna as a kind of vina,
consciousness, or Mdhyamika-type interpretation which links the
experience of nibbna to the seeing through of as empty.

NIBBNA AS A STATE OF VINA


Terms used in the second half of the description of nibbna in Ud 80 also
occur in a passage at S III.534 (cf. also S II.667):
As an approach to material shape, a persisting consciousness would
persist ; with material shape as object , with material
shape as support , seeking means of enjoyment, it would come to
growth, increase and abundance. [Similarly with]feelingperception
mental activities.
Were one to say this, monks: Apart from material shape, feeling,
perception and mental activities, I will show forth the coming or going, or
the decease and rebirth, or the growth, increase and abundance of
consciousnessthat is not possible.
If attachment (rga) for the element (dhtu) of material shape, monks, is
abandoned by a monk, by that abandonment of attachments [its] object is
cut off, and there is no support for consciousness. Similarly, it has no support
if a monk abandons attachment for the elements of feeling, perception,
mental activities or consciousness.
That unsupported consciousness has no increase and is
without karma formations , released (vimutta); by
[its] release it is steadfast ( ;) by its steadfastness it is content; by [its]
contentment it is not disturbed; not being disturbed it just by itself attains
nibbna (parinibbyati). It/he comprehends: Destroyed is birth
The underlined words indicate the parallels with Ud 80. The passage refers
to two states of consciousness: (1) Normal consciousness which persists
with one of the first four khandhas3 as object and support. Due to this
there is a coming and going and decease and rebirth; these processes are
seen as being processes of consciousness itself. (2) A state of consciousness
which exists in a person when there is no attachment for any of the five
khandha-elements (including ordinary consciousness); as such it is without
object, unsupported, without karma-formations, and attained to nibbna in
the experience of arahantship. It knows that no further rebirth will be
undergone.
MYSTICISM IN THE PLI SUTTAS 83

The second state of consciousness seems perfectly described by the


second section of Ud 80, from there is no coming or going to it has no
object.4 This implies that Ud 80 is describing nibbna not as a far-off
metaphysical state, or simply nibbna entered at the death of the arahant,
but (also) as nibbna as it can be experienced during life. It also indicates
that nibbna is not an object of consciousness in the full realization of
nibbna, but that it is the very state of objectless, supportless
consciousness: a revolutionized state of consciousness.
Other passages indicate that nibbna beyond death can also be seen as
such a form of consciousness. At S III, 124 and I, 122 Mra is portrayed as
looking for the consciousness of a recently deceased arahant, asking,
Where is the consciousness of a recently deceased clansman Vakkali-
Godhika supported? The Buddha explains in each case that the clansman
Vakkali/Godhika, with consciousness unsupported, has attained nibbna
(parinibbuto).
These passages on their own could be interpreted to mean that the post-
mortem consciousness of an arahant does not exist, because it is
unsupported. S III, 534, however, shows that things can be predicated of
a consciousness which is unsupported. A passage at S II, 103 also shows
that to be unsupported is not to be non-existent. The passage concerns the
consciousness which has no attachment for any of the four nutriments
(hra,) and which is thus unsupported there, nor is it growing. A simile
is then used to illustrate this: a ray of sunlight which meets neither a p
earth, nor water etc. does not alight anywhere, being
unsupported Such a sunbeam is not non-existent, though it
is described as unsupported! Thus one can talk of the post-mortem
consciousness of an arahant which in some sense exists, but in an
unsupported form. Given that the suttas indicate that nibbna during
life is such a state of consciousness, it is very likely that it is so beyond
death, too.5
It is, indeed, worth noting that later Buddhist literature also talked of
unsupported consciousness (or citta) in connection with . The
Vajrachedika PPS states:
Therefore, Subhuti, the bodhisattva, the great being, should produce an
unsupported thought , produce a
thought which is nowhere supported, a thought unsupported by visible
objects, sounds, smells, tastes, touchables or mind-objects.
Conze sees this as final .6
So far comment has only been made on the second half of the Ud 80
description of nibbna. Can the first half also be elucidated in harmony
with the analysis advanced so far? A passage of considerable help is D I,
223. Here a monk, after having asked many devas, finally comes to the
Buddha with the question, Where, now, Venerable Sir, do these four great
84 HARVEY

elements (mahbht) stop (nirujjhanti) without remainder? Having


rephrased the question, the Buddha answers:
Consciousness, non-manifestive, infinite, accessible from all round
( anidassanam sabbato )7here it is that
solidity, cohesion, heat and motion have no footing (na gdhhati) ; here
long and short, coarse and fine, foul and lovely [have no footing]; here
nma and rpa are stopped without remainder; with the stopping of
consciousness, here, this is stopped.
This is, fairly obviously, a passage on nibbna. as DA 3934 takes it to be.
It portrays nibbna both as (1) a state of consciousness8 and (2) a state
where the material elements and various contrasts have no footing (rather
than ending absolutely). and where nma and rpa stop without remainder.
While the reference to consciousness links up with the second half of Ud
80, the other aspect of D I, 223 seems to relate to the first half of Ud 80. In
both there is reference to the four material elements. Ud 80. however, then
refers to the four formless (arpa) spheres, not mentioned at D I, 223. In
these spheres as places of rebirth there is nothing of rpa and as
meditational states there is no awareness of rpa in them; only nma,
mentality, exists there. Ud 80, then. seems to describe a realm where
neither rpa nor nma exist, while D I, 223 says that these have stopped
in nibbna. That both are describing the same situation is supported by a
passage at Ud 8 spoken on the death of the arahant Bhiya:
Where solidity, cohesion. heat and motion find no footing, there stars do
not shine, the sun is not made manifest, there the moon appears not. no
darkness is there found. So when the sage, the brahmin. by wisdom knows
thus by himself, then he is freed from rpa, arpa, happiness and suffering.
Here the reference to the four elements having no footing is closely
parallel to D I, 223 while the non-appearance of sun and moon are also
found at Ud 80. The particular point to note here is that Ud 8 talks of rpa
and arpa in place of the rpa and nma of D I, 223; it thus seems
justifiable to see the first half of Ud 80 as describing a state where nma
and rpa are absent or have stopped. D I, 223 makes the point that in this
state, while nma-rpa, the sentient personality with its mental and
physical components, stops, the four physical elements of the physical
component of the sentient body do not cease, but rather have no footing
this suggests that they have no place in perception.
So far, then, it has been seen that Ud 80 describes nibbna as a state
where nma-rpa is absent, or is stopped, and consciousness is objectless
and unsupported. Now D I, 223 also refers, in its description of nibbna,
to consciousness as being stopped. Can consciousnessin whatever
formbe said to exist if it is stopped? Must one accept
commentary of D I, 223 saying that the stopped consciousness refers to
the ceasing of the last (carimaka) consciousness of the arahant at the time
of his death? The answer is, no. Stopped consciousness can occur during
MYSTICISM IN THE PLI SUTTAS 85

life; it is the same as unsupported consciousness and is not equivalent to


non-existent consciousness, This is shown in a passage at S II, 66:
If one does not will (ceteti,) plan, or have a latent tendency for anything,
then there is no object for the maintenance of consciousness; when
there is no object, there is no support for consciousness. When
consciousness is unsupported and not growing, there is no
descent of nma-rpa. From the stopping (nirodh) of nma-rpa is the
stopping of the sixfold sense-sphere.
This clearly deals with the undoing of the links of paticcasamuppda,
specifically with the stopping of the karma formations leading to the
stopping of consciousness, thence to the stopping of nma-rpa and the
following links. Talk of consciousness being stopped, though, is replaced
by talk of it being unsupported. As we have seen, the parallel passage at S
III, 534 shows unsupported consciousness as occurring during life, and it
has also been shown that such a consciousness, whether in life or beyond
the arahants death, is not a non-existent one.
It can be seen, then, that Ud 80, in conjunction with other passages,
indicates nibbna, whether during life or beyond death, as a state where
nma-rpa and consciousness are stopped and consciousness is objectless
and unsupported. The S II, 66 shows the connection between these two
aspects: it is from consciousness being unsupported, and thus stopped,
that nma-rpa stops, for the nma-rpa nidna arises dependent on the
consciousness nidna in its normal, non-stopped state. It is particularly
appropriate that Ud 80 should describe nibbna in terms of stopping of
consciousness and nma-rpa, because other passages assert that the
central process of and its suffering is the interplay between these
two. E.g.:
nanda, in so far only can one be born or grow old or die or decease or
be bornin so far only does the round [of ] turn for there to be
disclosure in this present state, that is to say, nma-rpa with consciousness
(saha vinena).
Another such passage is D II, 32:
Indeed, this consciousness turns back round on to (paccudvattati) nma-
rpa, it does not go beyond. In so far only can one be born, grow old, die or
decease or be reborn; that is to say [from the extent that] consciousness is
from nma- rpa as condition, nma-rpa is from consciousness as
condition, the sixfold sense-sphere is from nma-rpa as condition
This interweaving of these two states exists because consciousness arises
with mental and physical phenomena as its objects (as D II, 63 explains,
consciousness has nma-rpa as its support) and consciousness then goes
on to condition the continual arising of the mental and physical phenomena
that comprise its accompanying sentient body. It is attachment that binds
these two states together so that consciousness keeps turning back round
on to nma-rpa. The components of nma- rpa, indeed, act as a
86 HARVEY

confining home for consciousness. This is seen at S III, 9 which describes


consciousness as having the four other khandhas as its home (oka) when it
is bound by attachment to them, but that it is a home-abandoner when this
attachment for any of the five khandhas is cut off at the root. It is worth
noting, here, that there is ambiguity over whether the vina khandha is
included in the home of consciousness, just as S III, 534 omits, and then
again mentions, consciousness as one of the objects of attachment of
consciousness. This may be a reflection of an equivocation over whether
nibbnic consciousness is truly a form of consciousness.

THE NATURE AND STATUS OF NIBBNIC


CONSCIOUSNESS
The above discussion has indicated that, in the Pli suttas, there are a
number of hints implying that nibbna is a stopped, unsupported,
objectless consciousness. Examination of the epithets of nibbnic
consciousness at D I, 223 gives further indications as to its nature. First, it
is described as non-manifestive (anidassana,) a term used also at S IV,
3701 as synonymous with nibbna.9 Nidassana is variously used to mean
visible10, appearance, manifestation11 or example, i.e. that which
makes manifest.12 At M I, 1278 it is said that just as one cannot, by using
paint, delineate or make appear (ptubhva) material shapes in space
(kse,) because space is anidassana, so one cannot provoke to anger the
citta which is immeasurable through the development of loving-kindness.
This suggests that anidassana can mean not only that which is itself
invisible, but also that on which it is impossible to make anything else
appear. This would fit the unsupported consciousness, for it is objectless
and so beyond the manifestation of all objects: they gain no foothold in
it. The above passage also suggests that nibbnic consciousness is, in one
respect, like empty space.
D I, 223 also describes nibbnic consciousness as infinite (ananta). One
just might take it to mean that it had some connection with the sphere of
infinite consciousness, but it has been seen that Ud 80 describes nibbna
as beyond such a realm. The consciousness of this sphere has infinite
space as its object, while nibbnic consciousness is infinite because it has
no object. As described at S II, 103 it is like a sunbeam which does not
alight anywhere, but continues infinitely. Bearing in mind the image of the
khandhas, or nma-rpa as the home of consciousness, one can conjure
up the further image of infinite nibbnic consciousness as being trapped in
the khandhic process, and being freed from it by non-attachment.
Finally, D I, 223 describes nibbnic consciousness as sabbato icon@@.
The meaning here is uncertain as indicated in note 7. It may mean that
nibbnic consciousness is accessible by many meditational routes, or that it
draws back from everything, being without any object. There is also the
MYSTICISM IN THE PLI SUTTAS 87

possibility that should read shining, as in a parallel passage


at M I, 32930. Here the Buddha is speaking to Baka the Brahma who
thinks he created the world and is superior to the Buddha in knowledge.
The Buddha says:
I, O Brahma, knowing solidity as solidity, to that extent knowing that
which does not partake of the solidness of solidity ,13
do not think: [I am] solidity, [I am] in solidity, [I am different] from
solidity. I do not think solidity is mine, I do not salute solidity.14
This is then repeated of the three other elements, creatures, devas, Prajpati,
Brahma, four other types of gods, and everything Baka replies,
If, good sir, it does not, for you, partake of the allness of the all, take care
lest it be vain, lest it be empty (tucchaka), i.e. what in heaven or on earth
could such a thing be? The Buddha15 then replies: Consciousness, non-
manifestive, infinite, shining in every respect (sabbata pabha)that does
not partake of the solidness of solidityof the allness of the all.
The first line of the last quoted passage is almost identical to that of D I,
223 and the parallel of the passage is strengthened by the mention of
various gods in the lead up to both. The passage clearly refers to something
which does not partake of the nature of various particulars or even the
nature of all: this must surely be nibbna. Here again, it is described as a
form of consciousness, in this case as one which is shining in every
respect. This must be because it has the shine of wisdom which is said to
have the supreme pabh or bh.16 It is like the infinite sunbeam. It is for
this reason that in nibbnic consciousness sun and moon are absent and
the sun is not made manifest; there the moon appears not, no darkness is
there found (Ud 80). The shine of such a consciousness means that the
much lesser light of sun and moon are inapprehendable and yet there is no
darkness.
If nibbna is a certain form of consciousness, however, it is necessary to
face certain subsequent questions as to the status of nibbna understood in
this way. As it is unborn (ajta,) should it be seen as a beginningless form
of consciousness present in all but known only by the arahant?
Alternatively, is nibbna unborn in some other sense and only pertains to
the arahant? The first possibility would make nibbnic consciousness
somewhat like an inner self (atta). Being objectless, however, nibbna
could not serve as the subject of experience or perform any useful function
in personality. As a stopped consciousness it would seem to entail the
stopping of all other nidnas which, for a person to exist normally in the
world, must function normally. If consciousness is stopped, the whole
world stops with it. It would, then, seem unlikely that nibbnic
consciousness should exist in all people or even in arahants in normal
waking state. However, nibbnic consciousness, being sabbato pabh,
might be the same as the pabhassara citta of A I, 10. This citta is a crucial
factor in descriptions of mystical experience in Pli suttas. It will be
88 HARVEY

examined below in relation to the present question as well as in its own right.
Other matters must come first, however, starting with the second possibility
outlined above.
Nibbna is described as (unconstructed, unconditioned) at Ud
80 and elsewhere. How can it come about? S II, 66 gives a clue:
unsupported consciousness, shown to be a stopped consciousness,
comes about from the stopping of various such as willing. S III,
534 also describes the unsupported consciousness . Ud
80 describes nibbna as without functioning (pavatta,) while Miln 3256
makes clear that the functioning, absent in nibbna, is the functioning of
. So it seems likely that nibbnic consciousness is
unconstructed in the sense of being no longer constructed.
This is supported by S III, 867 which explains that
construct a compound of the five khandhas:
material shape into the state of material shape (rpattya) etc., but
consciousness into what is meant by consciousness (vinatthya). This
would mean that, when the suspend operation in nibbna, the
first four khandhas are not constructed into states of themselves and
consciousness is no longer constructed into what is meant by
consciousnessit is unconstructed and hardly what one would call
consciousness any more. This is in line with the equivocation, noted at the
end of the last section, over whether nibbnic consciousness is truly a form
of consciousness. That an unconstructed state can have a beginning in
time is also supported by Ps II, 1267: it says of a state of stopping
temporarily entered: Immeasurable is stopping in the sense that it is
unmoving and unconstructed.
Next comes the question: In what sense is, then, nibbnic consciousness
unborn? The clue is in Ud 801 where nibbna is described as the
leaving behind of the born (jtassa ). Being stopped,
nibbnic consciousness entails the stopping of all the other nidnas of the
paticcasamuppda, including birth (jti). In the stopped consciousness
nothing of what is born remains; it is non-manifestive like space on
which one cannot make appear (ptubhva) material shapes by painting
(M I, 1278); it is objectless and there is in it no appearance (ptubhava)
of the khandhas, a description included in S II,3 in its definition of the
birth-nidna. At Ps II, 241 nibbna is unborn because it is the stopping of
the five khandhas which are subject to birth (jtidhammato).
The above does not mean that nibbna did not exist before a buddha
attained it. One can say that while entry into nibbna (in life or at death)
is an event in time, the experience itself is timeless, neither past, present or
future (Dhs 1416, Miln 270). Moreover, whether or not any person
experiences nibbnic, unsupported consciousness at any time, the timeless
sphere of such unconstructed consciousness remains.
MYSTICISM IN THE PLI SUTTAS 89

This interpretation also means that nibbna during life, with remainder
of what is grasped at (saupdisesa,) cannot be experienced by an arahant
all the time: one cannot have objectless consciousness and perceive and act
in the world. Nibbna during life, then, must be seen as a radically
transforming experience, such as is described as the destruction of
attachment, hatred and delusion (It 389), which may be subsequently re-
entered during life. At death only this unconstructed consciousness
remains, without remainder of what is grasped at (anupdisesa).
Nevertheless, the experience of such a transforming state means that the
living arahant has greatly changed dispositions of thought and action so that
he is always one whose fires of attachment, hatred and delusion have been
extinguished.

THE APPROACH TO NIBBNA BY THE SEEING-


THROUGH OF EMPTY PHENOMENA
The path to the full experience of nibbna itself involves a variety of
mystical experiences. Some of them have been little investigated. In A V,
31826 there is a number of intriguing descriptions of a samdhi bordering
on the full experience of nibbna. At A V, 3213 nanda asks the Buddha:
May it be said, Venerable Sir, that a monks achievement of samdhi may
be of such a sort that, though he does not attend (manasikareyya) to the eye
or visible shapesto the body or touchablesto solidityto the sphere of
infinite spaceinfinite consciousnessthis world or a world beyond;
though, whatever is seen, heard, sensed, discerned, attained, sought after,
thought round by mindto all that he does not attend, and yet he does
attend?
The Buddha confirms that there is such a samdhi :
Herein, nanda, a monk attends thus: This is the real, this is the excellent;
that is to say, the calming of all , the renunciation of all
substrate, the destruction of craving, detachment (virga,) stopping,
nibbna.
When one compares this description to that of nibbna at Ud 80, one might
think that this samdhi was the full experience of nibbna as attained by the
arahant.17 This cannot be so, however, for the arahants experience of
nibbna is such that consciousness has no object, while this samdhi clearly
has an object: nibbna itself. What is more, the contemplations: This is the
realdetachment, nibbna, and This is the realstopping, nibbna, known
as the perception of detachment and the perception of stopping
(A V, 10), lead, if developed, to the gnosis of the arahant or to the state of
non-returning (S V, 1334); a samdhi in which these contemplations
occur is thus less than the full experience of nibbna. It is, in fact, better
identified with the signless (animitta) samdhi or cetovimutti as described
at M I, 296:
90 HARVEY

There are two conditions, your reverence, for the attainment of signless
cetovimutti : not attending to any nimitta, and attending to the signless
element. A nimitta is a perceptual sign or meaningful indication,18 and the
items listed at A V, 3212 are surely a wide-ranging list of all the main
types of signs which may engage the attention. The signless element is a
term used for nibbna (as explained here by MA II, 352). A V, 3212 then
seems to describe a samdhi in which no attention is paid to any signs,
but attention is paid to nibbna, the signless element, i.e. it describes a
signless samdhi. As such it clearly is not nibbna, it is still a
constructed state (M III, 108).
There is another, quite intriguing description of this signless samdhi at A
V, 3189 where nanda asks the Buddha: May it be, Venerable Sir, that a
monks acquiring of samdhi is such that in solidity he is not percipient of
solidity [this formula is then repeated for
each of the items following solidity at A V, 3212]and yet he is
percipient (sa)?
The Buddha replies that there is such a samdhi in which a monk
perceives: This is the realdetachment, stopping, nibbna. The
description of this samdhi is indeed paradoxical. It is not so much that a
person just does not attend to solidity etc., but that in solidity no solidity is
perceived. It is perceived, as it were, as being empty of
solidity: saperception, cognition, recognition, interpretation, that
which classifies and labels experience (correctly or incorrectly)does not
latch on to a sign as a basis for seeing solidity as solidity. Rather, the
mind attends to or perceives nibbna, the signless element, that which does
not partake of the solidness of solidity (M I, 32930, above). Not attending
to signs of solidity etc., solidity etc. are perceived as empty of themselves,
and the mind sees through them and focuses on nibbna, the signless
element.
The explanation of the signless samdhi in Ps II, 58 sheds light on why
the mind should be able to see through phenomena as empty:
When one with great resolution gives attention [to phenomena] as
impermanent, he acquires signless liberation. When one who has great
tranquillity gives attention [to them] as dukkha, he gains desireless
liberation. When one who has great wisdom gives attention [to
phenomena] as anatta, he wins void (suat) liberation.
This means that the signless samdhi is one of a set of three states in which
there is a very strong insight into the three marks. In such states
consciousness, weary of ephemeral, unsatisfactory, conditioned states, is
wholly detached from them and views that which lies beyond them. The
signless samdhi sees through the signs of solidity etc., because there is in
it contemplation of all conditioned states as limited and
circumscribed (Psm II, 48). Vism 657
comments: both as limited by rise and fall and as circumscribed by them,
MYSTICISM IN THE PLI SUTTAS 91

while Vism 668 explains that in the signless state there is effecting the
resolution of the compact (ghana katv ): In the signless state
great insight into impermanence leads to resolving the seemingly stable and
lasting signs, presented by the senses, into a complex of components which
have weak sign-value to the grasping mind and which themselves come and
go so fast as to be insignificant and unworthy of attention. As Ps II, 36 says,
in the signless liberation, one construes (karoti) no sign in what one
contemplates.
The movement of insight up to the signless samdhi and then beyond to
nibbna is well illustrated at M III, 104ff. A monk is said to be
progressively attending to the perception of human beings, a village, the
forest, earth (or solidity; it probably refers here to a meditational kasina),
each of the formless states and signless samdhi, with each of the
perceptions being empty (sua) of the previous ones. The items
transcended here in the signless samdhi broadly correspond to those not
attended to in the signless samdhi described at A V, 3212. Both passages,
then, seem to describe the signless samdhi as one reached by a progressive
emptying in which the signs of both gross and subtle phenomena come to
be transcended or seen through. M III, 108 goes on to explain that, once the
signless samdhi is reached, the meditator goes even beyond this, thinking:
This signless samdhi is constructed and thought out (
abhisa cetayita). But whatever is constructed and thought out is
impermanent, liable to stopping. When this is known, the four cankers
are destroyed, arahantship attained and nibbna fully experienced. As has
been seen above, this means that consciousness becomes objectless,
unsupported, stopped and unconstructed. It does not even take nibbna as
object, as signless samdhi does, but transcends all objects so as to be that
which is the signless element, the desireless element, the void element,
nibbna (Ps II,48).

THE BRIGHTLY SHINING (PABHASSARA) CITTA


It is now appropriate to investigate this citta (heart/mind or mind-set) as a
possible candidate for a nibbna within, as promised earlier, and as a focus
for what might be called a Buddhist version of the mysticism of light and
illumination,
There is a reference to this shining citta in A I, 810 which begins by
speaking of the uncovered citta which is well-directed so as to
realize nibbna. A person whose citta is corrupt and disturbed cannot
experience the excellence of truly riyan knowledge and vision
and will go to hell if he dies in such a state. A
person whose citta is clear and undisturbed can attain such knowledge and
would go to heaven. The Buddha then goes on:
92 HARVEY

I know of no other single dhamma which, thus developed and made much of,
is pliable (mudu) and workable (kammaa) as is this citta. Monks, a
developed and made much of citta is pliable and workable.
After referring to this citta as also supremely quick to change (or
adapt, lahuparivatta) he continues:
Monks, this citta is brightly shining (pabhassara,) but it is stained by
adventitious stains (gantukehi upakkilesehi )Monks, this
citta is brightly shining, but it is freed (vipamutta) from adventitious stains.
There is here a clear reference to a brightly shining citta present in all
people, be they corrupt or pure, whether it is stained or pure. When
passages parallel to the quoted ones are examined, however, it becomes
clear that the citta referred to is still unenlightened and has an object.
Therefore it cannot be regarded as the nibbnic consciousness within all
beings. D I, 76, having spoken of the attainment of the fourth jhna,
continues:
With this citta thus serene, made pure (parisuddha,) translucent, without
blemish, with stains gone (vigatpakkilesa,) become pliable, workable, firm
and imperturbable, he applies and bends down his citta for[the
attainment of the six higher knowledges (abhi,) including arahantship.]
The terms pliable and workable and the use of the language of purity
show that the praised developed citta of A I, 810 is being described here.
It is also confirmed by the use of the term with stains gone which shows
that the citta in the fourth jhna, poised for the abhis, is the developed,
brightly shining citta free from adventitious stains. Nevertheless, as it
still must have an object in the first five, mundane, abhis, and as it still
has to go on to attain nibbna, it cannot yet be the objectless, unsupported,
consciousness.
To free the shining citta from stains, not just samdhi, but wisdom is
necessary. D I, 2078, commenting on the series of processes at D I, 76ff.,
classifies the fourth jhna as samdhi, but the abhis and
which follow it, as wisdom. It is also said that both samatha and vipassan
are necessary for the abhis (M I, 494). As the stain-free citta is applied
directly to the abhis, it must already have some wisdom or insight. This
is supported by D III, 101: by putting away the five hindrances, by
suppressing the stains of mind by wisdom
While D I, 76 indicates a jhnic route to freeing the shining citta from
stains, this is not the only one. At D I, 110 (cf. A V, 86) the Buddha gives a
graduated discourse on, among other things, the defilement of
sense desires. As a result the citta of the hearer becomes pliable and clear,
without hindrances. This state certainly resembles that of the citta at A I,
810. S V, 92 confirms that the suspension of the five hindrances is the
crucial, if not the only, factor in freeing the citta of stains. It specifically
refers to these hindrances as upakkilesas, impurities, just as various metals
are impurities of gold. Such stains are said to prevent citta from being
MYSTICISM IN THE PLI SUTTAS 93

pliable and workable or showing its brightly shining nature. The situation at
D I, 110, then, can be seen as one where the hearer of a discourse enters a
state which, while not an actual jhna, could be bordering on it. As it is free
from hindrances, it could be seen as access concentration with a degree of
wisdom. This then would be sufficient to render the shining citta free from
stains, though this is more typically the case in the fourth jhna with the
mind poised for the abhis, as citta is there more fully developed and
made much of.19
Another point to take note of is that, although wisdom is required to
free the shining citta from stains, one need not be an riyan person
(stream-enterer, arahant, etc.) for this stainless state to occur. D I, 110,
quoted above, continues by saying that the Buddha teaches the four riyan
truths to the person whose citta is pliable etc. so that the pure, stainless
(vitamala) dhamma-eye of the stream-enterer arises, as a clean cloth readily
takes dye. This shows that the pliable, stain-free state of citta precedes
stream-entry (which makes one an riyan person), just as it precedes the
abbhis and arahantship: it can, however, be seen as an ideal spring-
board for attaining any of these.

WHAT IS PABHASSARA CITTA?


It has been seen that radiance (pabh or bh) is associated with wisdom,
but it can also be seen to be linked to the devas of the world of (pure) form
(rpa loka,) and to jhnas and loving-kindness. Deva itself means shining
or illustrious, and devas of the Form-world have such names as bhassara
(radiant) and subhakinka (lustrous; e.g. D II, 69). The bhassara Devas are
said to be feeders on joy (Dh 200) and Vibh 424 sees their existence as the
result of previously attaining the second jhna.
The It 15 also notes that the Buddha, when still a bodhisatta, had been an
bhassara Deva due to developing a citta endowed with loving kindness.
Similarly, the discourse following A I, 810 praises loving-kindness
after referring to the brightly shining citta. It can thus be said that in
Form-world, devas, whose state is gained by practising jhna on loving-
kindness, the brightly shining citta is relatively unstained. In line with this,
Brahma at D I, 247 is said to have an undefiled citta.
Bearing the above situation in mind, it is quite plausible to see the
brightly shining citta as a basic mode of mind in terms of which the
evolution of beings through the round of rebirths may be understood. It
should be noted that the bhassara Devas play a crucial role in the
evolution of the world at the beginning of a world cycle (D III, 845, cf. D
I, 17, A V, 60). It is said that when the world is destroyed at the end of a
cosmic cycle, most beings are reborn as bhassara Devas. When the
physical world begins to re-evolve, the proto-humans who come to inhabit
the earth are mind-made (manomaya,) feeders on joy, shining in themselves
94 HARVEY

, traversing the air, continuing in lustre . This


portrays the proto-humans who later decline into present humans (and
animals?) as living in a state akin to second jhna, with the natural radiance
of the citta defiled by little, if anything.
This suggests the role for brightly shining citta as a kind of radiant
basis which is normally covered and coloured by various defilements and so
undergoes various good and bad forms of rebirth according to the degree of
defilement. At the purest phase of the world cycle most beings cittas are in
a pure state corresponding to the second jhna and they are bhassara
Devas. They then decline and their cittas get recovered by defilements. The
stronger the defilement the worse the rebirth: even the diverse creatures in
the animal world are thought out (cittata) by citta (S III, 1512). But the
natural radiance of citta can be uncovered by meditation. When the
hindrances are suspended and the citta has developed some wisdom and the
bases of psychic power (see again note 19), it is in its brightest, undefiled
state and is poised for the abhis and, in particular, for the destruction of
the cankers at arahantship (cf. S V, 92). In perhaps less bright state it is
equally poised for stream-entry.
As the unstained brightly shining citta is supremely poised for
arahantship, it could be conceived as the womb of the arahant who is
sometimes also referred to as the tathgata (see again note 5). The term
tathgata garbha as found in the Mahyna LS20 could thus be applied to
it. It is described there (p. 77) as by nature brightly shining and pure
( ,) and as originally pure (divi- uddha) ; it
is also said to be enveloped in the garments of the skandhas, dhtus and
yatanas and soiled with the dirt of attachment, hatred, delusion and false
imagining. The realm of the tathgata garbha is said to be naturally pure
( ,) but it appears impure as it is stained by adventitous
defilements (ivagantu ; p. 222). The LS thus sees the
brightly shining citta as the tathgata garbha which it also identifies with
(p. 78). But it also holds within itself the causes for both good and
evil, and all forms of existence are produced by it (p. 220; cf. S III, 1512
above).
The Pli material would support the idea of the brightly shining citta
going through various rebirths, shaping their forms, and as being the
fruitful womb of arahantship, the tathgata garbha. Nevertheless, it
would not really support seeing it as nibbna, the unsupported, objectless
consciousness. A passage at S III, 54 could, though, be taken to imply that
it is the brightly shining citta which becomes nibbnic consciousness. This
is a passage on the supported consciousness with nutriment (shra) as
being attached to the first four khandhas, just as five seeds are planted in
the earth. The names of the seeds are such that the last four can be seen to
correspond to the four nutriments (material nutriment, stimulation, mental
volition and consciousness). Here, the khandha-seed represents the
MYSTICISM IN THE PLI SUTTAS 95

consciousness nutriment which S II, 13 shows to be equivalent to the


consciousness nidna or the six forms of consciousness (visual, aural,
nasal, gustatory, tactile and mental consciousness, S II, 4); these are also
equivalent to the consciousness khandha (S III, 59ff.). This means that the
first of the five seeds, the root-seed (mlabja,) is left to represent the
consciousness described as with nutriment.
Now the root-citta would be a very appropriate term for brightly
shining citta, considering its nature as underlying other more superficial
mental activity.21 Now the above passage then goes on to say that this with-
nutriment consciousness may become unsupported (S III, 545 as at S III,
534, quoted above). In this state it is without attachment for any of the
khandha elements, including that of consciousness which has been argued
to be equivalent to the consciousness nutriment. Thus one may say that the
unsupported consciousness is a root-consciousness or brightly shining citta
which has shed its nutriments and any supporting objects.
Another Mahyna interpretation of brightly shining citta is as bodhicitta,
the altruistic thought of enlightenment. It is described in the
PPS thus; That citta is no citta since it is by nature brightly shining
( prabhasvara).22 This is appropriate, as A 1, 10 moves from
a reference to brightly shining citta to saying that even the slightest
development of loving-kindness is of great benefit. This implies that loving-
kindnessand the related state of compassionis inherent within this citta
as a basis for more conscious development.
The Theravda tradition takes brightly shining citta as citta
(AA I, 60 on A I, 10), the latent dynamic continuum which is the
ground state of mental functioning. It flows on uninterrupted in dreamless
sleep, while in normal waking consciousness there is a rapid flicking
between the operation of this type of citta and its more active forms which
perceive and react to sense and mind objects. AA I, 61 explains that the
naturally pure (pakati-parisuddha) citta is stained by stains which
arrive at the moment of impulsion (javana) on account of cittas
accompanied by greed, etc. citta is thus the ground state of
consciousness in any existence and is seen to be defiled when it gives rise to
more conscious dealings with the world. It thus more or less fits the model
of brightly shining citta as a root citta which is defiled to different degrees
in different levels of rebirth. As the Theravda school says that
citta has an object, viz. that of previous death-moment,23 it cannot be
objectless unsupported consciousness, just as brightly shining citta cannot
either.
One possible problem with the Theravda interpretation is that jhna is
said to be composed only of impulsion cittas, without any cittas
occurring. How does this square with seeing brightly shining citta without
stains as occurring in the fourth jhna with the mind poised for the
abhis? It is the aspect of being poised for the abhis that makes the
96 HARVEY

difference. Vism 139 says that in the mundane abhis (the first five),
impulsion lasts only a single conscious moment (ekacittakkhanika,)
being immediately followed by citta, such that the flickering
between the two is especially rapid. Thus the stainless, brightly shining citta
poised for the abhis can be seen as citta after all. It is the
shining state of mind that is rapidly flicked in and out when accomplishing
the abhis. In beautiful accord with this is the A I, 810 description of
the well-developed citta as supremely quick to change.
However the brightly shining citta is described, it is certainly an essential
component of Buddhist mysticism and may even be used as a Buddhist
basis for understanding other forms of mysticism. Other mystical traditions
also use the language of purity and light. But there is a danger that the
notion of awareness of brightly shining citta could lead to views about
tman, or even God within: the LS in fact says that the tathgata garbha
might be held to be tmanwhich it is not (p. 78).
Summarizing what has been said of the brightly shining citta and its
potential, it can be seen that there is a progressive cleansing of its surface
defilements through the four jhnas as these suspend the five hindrances
and other stains. This process culminates when the fourth jhna is
supplemented by wisdom and the bases of psychic power necessary for
the anhis. A I, 253ff. compares this state to that of purified gold which
can easily be used for many purposes. The mind in such a state can, indeed,
overcome many limitations: it can hear things at a great distance, thus
overcoming the barrier of space; it can read the minds of others, thus
overcoming the self-other barrier; it can remember previous lives of oneself
and others, thus overcoming the barrier of time; finally, and most crucially,
it can be used as the springboard for attaining freedom from the cankers.
With this last abhi, we might say, the shining nibbnic consciousness
flashes out of the womb of arahantship, being without object or support, so
transcending all limitations.24

CONCLUSIONS
It has been seen that in the early Pli material nibbna is less like a totally
other transcendent metaphysical realm and more like a revolutionizing of
consciousness gone through its mystical stages of jhnas and signless
samdhi. Nibbna has been shown to be a form of objectless, unsupported
consciousness (vina,) unaffected by the actions of and
unconstructed. Being stopped, all other nidnas such as nma-rpa and
birth stop with it so that it is unborn, non-manifestive, like empty space,
without object. Material elements and worldly contrasts find no footing in
it, it is infinite like a sunbeam which settles nowhere; it also has the shine
of wisdom.
MYSTICISM IN THE PLI SUTTAS 97

The features of the signless samdhi, in which the mind sees phenomena
as empty of themselves, and the objectless consciousness of nibbna seem
to have been taken up in the nyavda and Vijnavda literature,
respectively. But the Pli material is a long way from saying that everything
is mind-only, although most of what we experience of the world is just
our (mis)interpretation of it, and there is no indication that nibbna is seen
non-different from , since an objectless consciousness is not the
same as consciousness with an object.
The brightly shining citta, related to the theme of cosmic evolution as
well as the evolution of the individual in mystical experience, is given no
direct doctrinal interpretation in the Pli discourses, but the LS sees it as the
tathgata garbha, the Praj Pramit literature as bodhicitta, and the
Theravda commentaries as citta, the latent dynamic continuum
from which normal waking consciousness springs.
The unsupported consciousness represents consciousness as nibbna
which springs from the brightly shining consciousness which underlies
. This relationship is perhaps reminiscent of the turya
in relation to dreamless sleep. The former also seems to be objectless and
the latter is seen in Theravda as consisting purely of (brightly
shining) cittas.
My treatment of nibbna might be criticized for portraying it during life
as a particular experience, rather than an ever-present disposition of the
arahant shown by his destruction of the cankers. But this destruction first
takes place in the objectless experience of nibbna and it is the ability to
return to it which makes one an arahant and radically alters ones
dispositions to thought and action.
I would further argue that it is more useful to look at passages relating
nibbna to vina, which has a more precise meaning, than to citta.25 In
any event, there is support to be found in the contemporary Theravda
practice tradition, as well as in some forms of Mahyna Buddhism.
Speaking of the reputed arahant Acharn Mun, Maha Boowa states: Within
such a lofty condition mind rests with dhamma and dhamma with mind;
mind is dhamma and dhamma is mindThis condition is the entire
extinction of the mundane world26
Given the equivalence of dhamma and nibbna in such passages as A I,
156 and 158, the above statement seems to portray the arahants mind in a
certain state as being nibbna. It can thus be seen that an aspect of the
understanding of nibbna, which is absent in the Theravda tradition of
commentaries and Abhidhamma, is to be found in the Pli discourses and
the contemporary Theravda practice tradition.
Finally, if one would characterize the forms of mysticism found in the
Pli discourses, it is none of the nature-, God- or soul-mysticism of
F.C.Happold.27 Though nearest to the latter, it goes beyond any ideas of
98 HARVEY

soul in the sense of immortal inner self and is better styled


consciousness-mysticism.
Happold also refers to the mysticism of Love, of Union and of
Knowledge and Understanding. As loving-kindness is linked to the brightly
shining citta, there are aspects of love mysticism in it. Developing loving-
kindness to the level of jhnas can lead to the union with Brahma at
death, though it is transcended in Buddhism in its higher mystical states. Of
course, the mysticism of knowledge and understanding is certainly found in
it as well.

NOTES

1 By Theravda I mean the school whose particular ideas are found


mostly in the Abhidhamma and Pli commentaries and in certain late
sutta materials such as Niddesa and Ps. I do not regard the bulk of
Pli suttas as Theravda, because they represent a collection and
arrangement of common material circulating in the early Buddhist
community. It is only when particular interpretative theories are then
applied to such material that one has the Theravda or
Sarvstivda etc.
2 The translations given are generally my own; the text references are
to the PTS editions.
3 These are the four (maintainers of consciousness)see
D III, 228.
4 One possible disharmony between the two is that Ud 80 says there is
no maintenance ( ,) while S III, 534 refers to the second state of
consciousness as being steadfast ( ). Yet the latter passage also
clearly suggests that such a consciousness does not persist
on any object. Thus, though the consciousness of S III, 534 may be
, it has no and so can be the same as nibbna at Ud 80.
5 For a discussion of the implications of this for the undetermined
question of the state of a tathgata after death see the authors The
Nature of the Tathgata in Buddhist Studies, Ancient and Modern,
ed. P.Denwood & A.Piatigorsky, Curzon Press, London 1983. This
matter is discussed more fully in the authors PhD thesis, chap. 12.
6 E.Conze, Buddhist Wisdom Books. London 1958, pp. 478; Sanskrit
from Conzes Rome editions of Vajracchedika PPS.
7 Paha may mean a ghat or be a contracted form of pajaha meaning
drawing back from everything.
8 DA II, 3934, tries to avoid the obvious conclusion that
a form of vina is being described as nibbna by glossing the term
as meaning vinatabban, to be discriminated (by consciousness).
i.e. while he admits that nibbna is meant, he makes it an object of
consciousness. This is just distorting the text.
MYSTICISM IN THE PLI SUTTAS 99

9 With both being the destruction of greed, hatred and delusion, i.e,
nibbna during life.
10 D III, 217; Vibh 64, 70ff.
11 A IV, 305.
12 Sn 137.
13 MA II, 412: nibbna.
14 Cf. M I, 14.
15 The PTS edition of the text takes this speech as still coming from
Baka, but it comes more logically from the Buddha; MA II, 413 takes
it as coming from the teacher, too.
16 S I, 6; A II, 139.
17 This error was made in the original version of this paper.
18 The meaning of nimitta is surveyed in the authors Signless
Meditations in Pli Buddhism, Journal of the International
Association of Buddhist Studies, Vol. 9, no. 1 (1986).
19 For citta to be poised for the abhis, with its shining nature
apparent, the four bases of psychic power (iddhipd) need also to be
developed; at S V, 227 it is said in connection with these: Thus with
an open citta which is not overgrown he cultivates a citta which has a
bright shine (sappabhsa).
20 D.T.Suzuki, The Stra, London 1932; Sanskrit text from
P.L.Vaida (ed.), , Dharbhanga
1973. The cited passages are also quoted by W.Rahula, Zen and the
Taming of the Bull, London 1978, p. 98.
21 Cf. the who postulated a mla-vijna as the support
of visual consciousness, etc. See A.Bareau, Les Sectes Bouddhiques
du Petit Vhicule, Paris 1955, p. 72.
22 E.Conze, The Perfection of Wisdom in 8000 Lines, Bolinas (USA)
1973, p. 84; Sanskrit from his Rome edition of the PPS.
23 Vism 458; cf. Asl 278.
24 On related matters see the authors Developing a self without
Boundaries, Buddhist Studies Review, vol. I, no. 2 (19834).
25 As R.Johansson does in The Psychology of , London 1969.
26 Ven. Phra Acharn Maha Bowa, The Ven. Phra Acharn Mun
Bhuridatta Thera, Meditation Master, Bangkok 1976, p. 140. My
thanks to Lance Cousins for pointing out this passage to me.
27 F.C.Happold, Mysticism, Harmondsworth 1970.
100
7
THE STAGES OF CHRISTIAN
MYSTICISM AND BUDDHIST
PURIFICATION: INTERIOR CASTLE
OF ST TERESA OF VILA AND THE
PATH OF PURIFICATION OF
BUDDHAGHOSA
Lance S.Cousins
There have been many attempts to define or describe the nature of mystical
experience: some have argued for a uniform mystical goal, others have
asserted the uniqueness of some particular type of mystical experience, still
others have sought to erect a hierarchy of stages or levels of mystical
experience either within one religion or across the boundaries of traditions.1
No real consensus has yet been reached.
I am convinced that to think of a single transcendental mystical
experience is in certain respects misleading. I would look at the phenomena
of mysticism in terms of a mystical way, involving a series of experiences,
some quite distinct from others. But I do not wish to prejudge whether
mystical experience in different religious and cultural contexts can be
regarded as identical. What I wish to argue is that there is considerable
similarity in the structure and stages of the mystical way as conceived in
different traditions. It is this question which I wish to explore here. I believe
that this is possible without regard to the general question as to the nature
and validity of mystical phenomena. Theistic religions tend to view the stages
of the mystical ladder as more or less supernatural and involving some kind
of contact with the divine. A psychologist might think in terms of a series
of psychological experiences or altered states of consciousness without
feeling the necessity of introducing any external criteria. In either case we
are dealing with a series of experiences or perhaps transformations which
can, I think, be examined in their own right.
The two examples chosen for this paper may seem at first sight far apart:
on the one hand, a sixteenth-century Spanish sister, a devout and loyal Roman
Catholic, a lady with little higher learning but great involvement in the
practice of spiritual life; on the other, a fifth-century Buddhist scholar,
probably not without experience on the Buddhist path, but perhaps not of its
higher stages. One would not generally think that the two would have much
in common. But this is just what seems to be of the greatest advantage to
making a comparison. No one would doubt the existence of resemblances
between Christian, Jewish and Muslim mystical traditions and explanations
102 COUSINS

for them through mutual influence would not be lacking. The same would
hardly apply if resemblances are found between Theravda Buddhism and
Catholic Christianity. It is also particularly useful to cross the gap between
theistic and non-theistic religions which is often portrayed as if it were a
yawning gulf.
St Teresa was an extremely fine observational psychologist as is evident
particularly in the Interior Castle, the work of her maturity. It contains a
wealth of fine detail and exact description which is obviously the product of
many years of introspection and careful recollection of her own experiences.
She also developed considerable skill in giving spiritual guidance and
herself drew on the experiences of her fellows in the Reformed Carmelite
communities.
We have no comparable account from a Buddhist equally experienced in
the path of his tradition, but in Buddhaghosas Visuddhimagga (The Path of
Purification) we have at least an account of the Buddhist path which enjoys
wide authority in the Theravda tradition and appears to derive from
sources based on genuine personal experience. Buddhaghosa was very
conservative and a traditionalist. His work is little more than a
systematization and reorganization of materials available to him. He can,
therefore, be relied upon, but it will be useful to supplement his account of
the Buddhist path with materials from the living tradition of Buddhist
practice.
He begins the Vism with a verse from S:

A man of wisdom developing mind and wisdom founded on


morality, a monk both energetic and skilful, he might untangle this
tangle.2

A yogi, he says, needs to know the way to purification, i.e. to nibbna. The
Buddha taught various methods and Buddhaghosa gives a number of
examples of how the path can be divided, but he points out that in the
quoted verse it is divided under the headings of morality (sla,)
concentration (samdhi) and wisdom (pa). He then elaborates the image.
A man of natural intelligence, standing on firm ground and taking up a
knife well sharpened on a stone, will be able by making an effort to
disentangle a great tangle of bamboos. Similarly a person who is by nature
intelligent, established on the firm ground of morality and taking up the
knife of insight well sharpened on the stone of concentration with the hand
of awareness will, by making an effort, be able to untangle the tangle of
craving. Based on this image Buddhaghosa structured his whole Vism on this
threefold division as well as upon a parallel sevenfold division.
St Theresa also starts with an image: I began to think of the soul as if it
were a castle of a single diamond or of a very clear crystal in which there
are many dwelling places just as in Heaven there are many mansions
MYSTICISM AND PURIFICATION 103

(T p. 7).3 We can hardly imagine the great beauty of a soul and its great
capacity. It is beyond our comprehension, for God, created us in His
image and likeness. We pay too little attention to our souls. All our
interest is centred in the rough setting of the diamond or the outer wall of
the castlethat is to say in these bodies of oursThis castlehas many
mansions, some above, others below, others at each side; and in the centre
and midst of them all is the chiefest mansion where very secret things pass
between God and the soul. As the simile is elaborated in the book it
becomes clear that progression is envisaged from the lowest and outermost,
perhaps in a spiral, to the central area where God dwells as King. St Teresa
divides this into seven stages, but is at pains to point out that each stage has
a very large number of dwelling places, making clear that the path can take
a number of different forms, but herself making the division into seven
stages the structural basis of the work.
It is probably safe to assume that the traditional Christian threefold
division of the mystical way (outlined in the introductory paper of this
collection), which would of course have been well known to St Teresa,
partly underlies her account. Since the first member of the division is
purification or via purgativa, it is natural to expect a measure of
correspondence between the earlier mansions of the Interior Castle and
Buddhaghosas initial section on morality. Neither work attempts to give a
full account. St Teresa probably assumes that the reader will have read her
other works which gave a fuller treatment of this topic and Buddhaghosa
would no doubt refer to his commentaries to Pli Nikyas. St Teresa
certainly assumes that her reader will know the distinction between mortal
or venial sin and the state of grace and she says little about such matters as
confession, repentance, penance or observation of the sacraments apart from
stressing, at intervals, their value and importance. Equally the Vism
assumes that the reader will know the detailed precepts of Buddhist training,
the different types of kamma and the conditions necessary to constitute its
full course (kammapatha) which would be capable of bringing about an
appropriate rebirth in due course. He often refers, in an abbreviated manner,
to relevant texts and lists, assuming their knowledge on the part of the
reader.
In fact there is a great deal in common between Buddhist sla and
Christian moral theory. Their differences could be accounted for by the
basic difference between a theistic and non-theistic system. But then there
is a great deal of variation on particular matters also within each of the two
traditions. But setting aside general questions it will be more appropriate to
examine what the two writers envisage as being of particular value in the
spiritual life beyond simple avoidance of wrongdoing.
For the First Mansions St Teresa particularly stresses the need for self-
knowledge, humility, courage and not giving way to doubts. To come to the
Second Mansions withdrawal from unnecessary cares and business is
104 COUSINS

needed. Those who have reached the Second Mansions have begun to
practise prayer, but are troubled by worldly habits and the bad example of
friends. Their perseverance is stretched and they need a firm resolve, and
association with others who lead a spiritual life is essential for them. Right
attitude to spiritual practice is also important and expectations of sweetness
in prayer and the like will be a serious obstacle; it is better to strive to conform
ones will to the will of God and be intent on enduring trials. In the Third
Mansions St Teresa describes people who have lived in an upright and
well-ordered way, both of body and mind (T p. 37); they avoid venial sins,
love penance, spend hours in recollection, employ their time rightly,
exercise themselves in works of charity to their neighbours, are well
ordered in their conversation and dress and govern their households well.
But they may experience dryness in their meditation due to excessive desire
for spiritual favours and there is perhaps an underlying lack of humility and
true detachment. St Teresa seems to imply that they think well of
themselves and their behaviour. We should look at our own faults, not
those of others, she writes, for many of those with well-ordered lives are
shocked at everything (T p. 43). Obedience to a good spiritual director is
of great value to them.
Buddhaghosas account of sla is very elaborate, but only some of the
more important features can be indicated here. The word is commonly
translated by morality or ethics, although its original meaning is more
like nature or character. Buddhaghosa in fact cites this meaning in
connection with canonical passages which refer to unskilful (akusala) sla,
but rejects it as the sense which the word has in the world (Vism p. 14).
The sla of the Vism is different and not unskiful. To explain it he employs
an invented etymology of sla as meaning (1) concentrating (samdhana,)
i.e. stilling the mind and settling it so that undesirable states do not occur
and (2) upholding , i.e. acting as the support or foundation for
skilful states. For the advantages of sla he refers the reader to various
canonical texts, e.g. A V, 12 describing skilful slas as having the goal and
advantage of absence of remorse which itself has the goal and advantage of
pleasant feeling (pmujja). The series continues with joy, tranquility,
happiness, concentration and various stages of insight, knowledge and
vision of liberation.
The Vism goes on to give detailed series of numerical classifications of
sla from various points of view, partly to define particular types of
observance, but mostly to suggest different degrees of observance or levels
of practice. Three examples may suffice. (1) Sla is twofold: with limits, in
which case it will be broken for the sake of gain, fame, kinsmen, limb or
life, or without limits, i.e. kept regardless of such considerations. (2) Sla is
threefold: under the overlordship (i) of self, i.e. undertaken to abandon what
is not fitting for oneself, (ii) of other people, to avoid the censure of others,
and (iii) of dhamma, to pay homage to the greatness of the dhamma. (3) It
MYSTICISM AND PURIFICATION 105

is also threefold as inferior when based on things of the world, middling when
undertaken for the sake of ones own liberation and superior if pursued for
the sake of the liberation of all beings (Vism 1016, 46f.).
The most important section on sla is, for us, the last one as it describes
its purifying (vodna). It is achieved by not breaking the precepts of
training, by penance in case of breach, by absence of sexual activity in any
guise, by removal of mental defilements such as anger, jealousy or pride
and by developing such qualities as having few wants, complete
satisfaction, renunciation, being easily looked after and having generated
effort (cf. M I, 13). One should also see the dangers in failure of sla and the
advantages of success in it.
Next follows a long section on the thirteen . According to
Buddhaghosa they are the means to develop the above qualities of having
few wants and the like in order to bring about the purifying of sla. Dhuta,
from a verb meaning to shake or wash, may refer to a person who is being
washed or cleansed or it can be an abstract noun with the sense of washing
or cleansing. , literally a limb, is often used in contexts where it
means a factor, constituent or attribute of something. The compound would
therefore mean either attributes of the person being cleansed or factors of
cleansing. Elaborating further, Buddhaghosa makes the role of the
clear by a simile: sla will be purified and vows successfully accomplished
when washed clean of stains by the water of special qualities such as having
few wants. The are, in effect, a series of special practices
involving considerable renunciation and asceticism without going to
extremes of self-mortification, e.g. eating only alms food, eating only one
meal a day, possessing only the one set of three robes, living at the root of a
tree or in the open air and sleeping without lying down. One Thai monk
described it as camping meditation. Buddhaghosa describes the particular
advantages of each of the thirteen, making clear that the purpose is very
much to induce a detached state free from expectations and preferences. He
also discusses what kind of person they are suitable for. Most of these
practices would have parallels in the Christian monastic tradition well-
known to St Teresa. Indeed. she herself touches on some of them in her
Way of Perfection.
Most of the points covered in the first three Mansions of St Teresa seem
to be paralleled in Buddhaghosa, although not always obviously so at first
sight: e.g. having few wants is used in ways equivalent to humility. The
importance of not having expectations and conforming ones will with that
of God do not appear explicitly but in various guises in the Vism.4 A
modern teacher writes: Do not think of attaining the results of what you are
doingthat they will be as you want them to beAs the old saying puts it,
Dont snatch at happiness before it is ripe, because the mind will not then
be steadfast, knowledge will not be clear, diligence and energy will
diminish, faith will deteriorate and the final result will be revulsion,
106 COUSINS

disheartenment, laziness and carelessness. Conforming ones will to that of


God may in practice amount, in one context, to complete satisfaction
with whatever one gets, in another context to the knowledge that
one is heir to ones deeds, in yet another to equipoise (upekkh) and in still
another to acting for the sake of dhamma. It should occasion no surprise if
we find that it is not possible to match concepts on a one-for-one basis.
Indeed, it would be very surprising if we could. What we may, and I believe
do, find is parallel clusters of concepts functionally similar in their
psychological effects.
It is clear that for Buddhaghosa and the whole Buddhist tradition there is
an intimate connection between the three aspects of sla and pa, as is
indeed illustrated in the well-known image of the eightfold path as an eight-
spoked wheel. Equally, for St Teresa and the long tradition of Christian
mysticism which precedes her the spiritual path is founded in purification.
The present discussion of altered states of consciousness which sees them
purely as the result of techniques or of genetic accident would, I suspect,
have seemed trivial to both. For both of them the disciplining of mind and
body was a sine qua non. One of the clearest explanations of this feature is
given by St Augustine in De Quantitate Animae,5 probably following
Neoplatonic sources, where he describes seven stages or levels of the soul.
In the fourth stage begins a mighty struggle for purification which he
describes under the image of cleansing and healing the eye of the soul. At a
later stage he points out that just as the injured eye should not be exposed to
the full light of the sun before it is fully healed and grown strong, so also
the eye of the soul should not be exposed to the light before it is fully
cleansed and strengthened lest it may think there is in it not only no
goodness but even great evil.
It might be argued that there are forms of mysticism where this is not the
case. No doubt St Teresa and Buddhaghosa would admit that there might be
individual exceptions. St Teresa comments on occasional cases
exceptions and not the rulewhich for her are gifts of the Lord and not for
us to judge. They may be a special aid given to weaker brethren. For the
Buddhist such cases would simply be the result of practice undertaken in
previous lives and hence not real exceptions. For both of them such cases
would merely mean that purification had been achieved in some other way
and they would expect the effect to be a definite if not necessarily
permanent improvement in character. Neither would admit to any kind of
higher state without prior purification.
The objection that such views are merely a kind of dogmatism is, I
suspect, mistaken. In some states of mind there is an intimate connection
between our emotions and attitudes on the one hand and the form taken by
the experience on the other. In dream states we can often find that
attachment or fear related to a dream object can transform the dream into a
nightmare. The same comes across from many accounts of altered states
MYSTICISM AND PURIFICATION 107

under hallucinogenic drugs. It is known that the prior setting can have a
crucial influence on the course taken by an LSD trip. St Augustine was
determined to avoid similar phenomena.
With the Fourth Mansions St Teresa describes the Prayer of Quiet and
the Prayer of Recollection where the natural and the supernatural are
mingled. These mansions are nearer the Kings dwelling and very beautiful;
so subtle are the things seen and heard in them that the mind cannot give a
sufficiently lucid description of them to make them clear to the
inexperienced, but those who enjoy such favours will easily understand.
There is nothing ineffable about this stage. Difficulties in description are
the same as those which normally accompany any attempt to describe inner
experience.
Although St Teresa describes the Prayer of Recollection after the Prayer
of Quiet, she comments that it almost invariably begins before it, meaning
perhaps that it becomes deeper and fuller as the Prayer of Quiet becomes
deeper and more frequent: Without the display of any human skill there
seems gradually to be built a temple for the prayer already described; the
senses and all external things seem gradually to lose their hold while the
soul is regaining its lost control (T p. 59). She uses the simile of the Kings
gentle call summoning inhabitants who have strayed from the castle to
return. Then they become markedly conscious of a gentle interior
shrinking (T p. 60) like a hedgehog or tortoise retiring into itself, but while
they can do so at will, with us it is not a question of our willit happens
only by Gods favour. She suggests that God grants it to those who are
already leaving the things of the world.
At this point St Teresa remarks that one should not try to suppress
thinking prior to obtaining the absorption, because that would bring more
harm than profit. Our effort would get in the way. When His Majesty
wishes the understanding to cease, He employs it in another manner
(T p. 63).
But the main part of the discussion of the Fourth Mansions is dedicated
to the Prayer of Quiet. Its key feature is the experience of a new kind of
religious emotion. Here St Teresa distinguishes between spiritual
enjoyments (contentos) and spiritual joys (qustos) in a very careful and
precise manner (T p. 46ff.). The former are pleasant emotions aroused by
prayer and good works and stem from our own nature even if aided by
grace and they are not fundamentally different from strong pleasant
emotions in ordinary life, although they may be nobler. But they do not
make one holier and may be even connected with the passions and lead then
to intense results of an undesirable kind.
The joy or delight in God of the Prayer of Quiet is something quite
different. To make the difference between the two clear, St Teresa uses a
traditional expression: spiritual joys widen the heart whereas spiritual
enjoyments narrow it. She further uses the simile of two fountains. One is
108 COUSINS

fed with water brought in conduits from a distance and is therefore noisy
and requires labour. It represents the spiritual enjoyments which occur
particularly in the first three Mansions. The other one draws directly from a
spring, is noiseless and represents the spiritual joys of the Fourth Mansions.
We experience the greatest peace, calm and sweetness in the inmost depth
of our being, she writes. This joy does not appear to me to originate from
the heart, but from some even more interior part, as it were from the depths
it appears to dilate and enlarge our whole interior and to benefit us in an
inexplicable manner (T p. 545).
All of this can be recognized by results: In the after effects and the
subsequent behaviour one discerns the true value of the prayer; there is no
better crucible to test it (T p. 56). If this prayer occurs frequently, the soul
will be strengthened in all virtues. St Teresa maintains that the soul is less
constrained in the service of God: there is no fear of hell or servile fear of
God; the soul has firm confidence in its destiny which is like a dilation or
enlargement of the soul, as if the fountain were equipped with some
contrivance so that its basin grew larger as the water flowed more freely.
She warns, however, that if the health is poor, interior joy may lead to
physical weakness and a kind of spiritual sleep or absorption. One person,
she writes, was in this state for eight hours; she was not unconscious nor
was she conscious of anything concerning God (T p. 66). This can easily
lead to self-deception and is quite different from the genuine case in which
there will be joy in the soul and the experience is not long-lasting, nor does
it overcome the body or produce any exterior sensation.
In the Fifth Mansions St Teresa describes the Prayer of Union. Do not
think it is a state, like the last, in which we dream; I say dream, because
there the soul seems to be, as it were, drowsy, so that it neither seems asleep
nor feels awake. Here we are all asleep, and fast asleep, to the things of the
world and to ourselves; in fact, for the short time that the condition lasts,
the soul is as if without consciousness, for it has no power to think, even
though it may desire to do so (T p. 70). It is as a death full of delight.
Hands and feet cannot move and breathing either stops or occurs without
the soul realizing it. Neither imagination nor memory nor understanding
can hinder this blessing. Essentially the soul seems to have left the body in
order to abide more fully in God. In this state the soul can neither see nor
hear nor understand. The period is always short and seems to the soul even
much shorter than it probably is (T p. 73).
St Teresa acknowledges that there are many other kinds of union which
she treats as being of diabolic origin. But they are quite different in quality.
There is not the same delight and satisfaction of soul nor the same peace
and joy. The quality is very different. It is as if the one kind had to do with
the grosser part of the body, and the other kind penetrated to the very
marrow of the bonesWhat has been said will be sufficient for anyone who
has experienced this; for there is a great difference [between the false and
MYSTICISM AND PURIFICATION 109

the true]. The clearest indication of the true union is the sense of certainty
it leaves behind. God implants himself in the interior of that soul in such a
way that, when it returns to itself, it can in no way doubt that it was in God
and God was in itAlthough for years God may never grant it that favour
again, it can neither forget it nor doubt that it has been received. St Teresa
in fact cites here the doctrine that God is in all things by presence and
power and essence. Indeed, if this certainty is absent, she would say that
union of the whole soul with God has not been experienced.
She elaborates the account of the Prayer of Union with the simile of the
silk worman ugly worm which has to die in order to become a beautiful
butterfly. It must spin its cocoon which is compared to good works
necessary to prepare for this favour. The image of the emergence of the
little white butterfly seems intended to suggest a new purified state of the
soul. But the result of union is intense dissatisfaction with worldly things
which leads to a great increase in detachment. This results in fresh trials and
renewed motivation together with a sense of exile and desire to leave the
world. A deep grief arises which without any effort on the souls part, and
even at times without the soul wanting it, seems to tear it to pieces and
grind it to powder (T p. 82). The intention seems to be to portray a further
process of purification.
Unexpectedly St Teresa goes on to suggest that this Prayer of Union is
not the real characteristic feature of the Fifth Mansions. The Lord has the
power to enrich souls in many ways and bring them to these Mansions by
many other paths than the short cut which has been described (T p. 87). In
fact, the Prayer of Union proceeds from another, much more important
union which consists in submitting ones will to the will of God. This is
shown by the two consequences of love of God and love of ones
neighbour. But then she returns again to the Prayer of Union and compares
it to a meeting between a couple prior to becoming engaged. In a secret
way the soul sees who this spouse is that she is to take (T p. 94).
In the Vism Buddhaghosa specifically excludes discussion of unskilful
and other types of samdhi on the grounds that there are too many kinds
of them for it to be practical to discuss them all. He also excludes, at
this stage, the discussion of transcendent samdhi, reserving it for a
later section, and limits himself to the definition of samdhi as skilful
one-pointedness of mind. But he devotes a large space to answering the
question how samdhi is developed which can be summarized as follows.
Having already purified sla, the meditator should remove himself from
possible distractions and approach the good friend, the giver of a
meditation subject, and receive from among the forty meditation subjects
one that suits his own temperament (Vism p. 89). Having ensured that the
monastery in which he lives is suitable to develop concentration, he should
sever any minor obstructions such as cutting nails or hair, mending robes,
110 COUSINS

cleaning the room and so on and not overlook any of the detailed
instructions for development.
Comparing his procedures with those of St Teresa we do not seem to
meet a clear equivalent of her Prayer of Recollection, although her
description does recall Patajalis withdrawal (pratyhra) and the simile
of the tortoise is familiar to the Indian tradition. But Buddhaghosa does not
describe the process of withdrawal as such. Yet the frequently mentioned
guarding of the sense faculties and his description of jhna do imply such a
withdrawal. The latter is illustrated by the development of the nimitta in
practice. It is the stage at which the object of meditation, previously
external, becomes a fixed mental impression or an eidetic image and the
external object can be discarded. This is clearly a feature of the process of
withdrawing the mind within, though of different type than the one
described by St Teresa. We may nevertheless assume that in practice the
Prayer of Recollection would have been quite recognizable to Buddhaghosa
as part of the process of developing jhna.
With the Prayer of Quiet the case is much clearer. St Teresas description
of the distinction between spiritual enjoyments and spiritual joys makes it
quite clear that we are dealing with the jhna factors of joy (pti) and
happiness, especially the former. I have dealt with this subject extensively
elsewhere,6 so I will now only summarize the matter, Buddhist tradition
distinguishes between smisa-pti and nirmisa-pti, effectively joy derived
from the senses and joy not derived from the senses. The latter will only
be fully developed at a stage in meditation when the hindrances are
suppressed and the mind takes as its object a pure idea not in sensory form:
the Buddhaghosas semblance nimitta. Technically the senses do not
operate at this time, but in practice such moments are intermitted with some
sensory perception. Buddhaghosa elaborates different stages in the
development of this joy, of which the last is both more stable and free from
excitation. So we can loosely affirm that the access concentration (upacra-
samdhi) which precedes full jhna in the Vism account corresponds
reasonably closely to St Teresas Prayer of Quiet without necessarily ruling
out the possibility that there are also significant differences.
A modern account may make it clearer: by using one of these forms
of for controlling the heart with mindfulness, one will
gradually be able to curb the outgoing exuberance of the heart. Calm and
happiness will then arise and develop, and there will be only one thing
influencing the heart which will be a knowing of the heart alone without
any disturbance or distraction, or there will be nothing which can irritate or
disturb the heart to make it fall away from this state. This is the nature of
happiness of heart freed from all vain imaginings and thought creations.
When this state is attained, the person who is doing the practice will know
that which is wondrous in his heart, the like of which he has never
MYSTICISM AND PURIFICATION 111

encountered before. This is a deeply-felt state of happiness, more so than


anything which he has previously experienced.7
To understand Buddhaghosaa account of the jhnas it is necessary first
to remember the abhidhamma description of consciousness. This may be
compared to one type of colour television screen in which the picture is
actually built up by the activation of tiny dots of different colours one after
another. Similarly, our conscious experience in which we appear
simultaneously to see, hear, remember, feel, think, know is in fact to a large
extent a construct. Most of these activities are not simultaneous but
successive. They appear simultaneous only because we cannot discriminate
them properly, just as we are not aware of the dots on the television screen
as successive, but experience them as simultaneous.
So when Buddhaghosa declares that in jhna absorption it is possible for
the mind to remain for long periods with the semblance nimitta as its
object, this is equivalent to saying that there is no articulated thought, no
sense perception, no remembering the past and no awareness in the ordinary
sense. The mind remains aware of the pure concept that is its object and is
alert, lucid and qualitatively superior to ordinary consciousness. For
Buddhists this is the consciousness of the Brahma gods.
It is quite clear that there is much similarity between that type of
consciousness and St Teresas Prayer of Union. Both are ecstatic trances
involving immobility of the body and the suppression of many of the
ordinary mental activities. Both are characterized by peace and joy. Both
are also in a slightly ambiguous position in relation to the larger path: the
Prayer of Union is really only a kind of short cut and not the direct route
which is the union of the will with that of God, while jhna is sometimes
portrayed as a side-track in relation to the more direct development of
insight. Many more similarities could be elaborated. One might perhaps sum
up by saying that jhna is certainly what St Teresa would call union, but
whether she would call it union with God is perhaps another matter. For
Buddhaghosa the Prayer of Union would perhaps be acceptable as a form of
jhna, but probably not as lokunara or transcendent jhna.
In the third section of the Vism when he comes to describe how pa is
developed, Buddhaghosa introduces a new image. Taking the canonical
division of the path into seven purifications (visuddhi,) he describes the first
two stages, purification of sla and of mind, which are equivalent to the
subject matter of the first two sections of the Vism, as the root of a plant or
tree.
The traditional formulae of the Buddhist teaching such as the faculties,
the four noble truths and dependent origination then constitute the soil in
which the plant can grow. The body of the plant is made up of the five
remaining purifications as stages in the development of insight. Possibly
one reason for the image is to indicate that as the body of the plant grows
up, so also the root will develop. This is certainly so for sla which
112 COUSINS

improves as the higher stages of insight are developed and we may assume
that equally samdhi will advance. It may therefore be no accident that the
fifth purification involves a number of jhna-like factors.
Beginning his account of wisdom, Buddhaghosa is careful to define the
wisdom with which he is concerned as insight knowledge connected with
skilful consciousness. After giving a numerical analysis of different kinds
of wisdom in the same way as for the first two sections of the Vism he goes
on to treat the doctrinal analyses which constitute the soil, mentioned above,
in considerable detail. But we shall turn to the description of the actual
development of insight.
It begins with the purification of view which is defined as seeing mental
and physical phenomena exactly as they are and hence equivalent to insight
knowledge which comprehends to a certain degree the First Noble Truth.
The fourth purification, the one accomplished by crossing over doubt, is
defined as comprehending the conditions which give rise to phenomena and
hence as equivalent to understanding the Second Noble Truth. All of this
might be expressed in terms of realizing the worthless and relative nature of
ordinary existence and ceasing to value itnot merely conceptually but
rather as an existential realization and letting go.
The fifth purification due to knowing and seeing what is path (magga)
and what is not path is explained as equivalent to comprehending and
developing the Fourth Noble Truth, i.e. the Eightfold Path. It is achieved by
seeing the general characteristics of phenomena of impermanence, suffering
and not-self. From this arises what is called young insight
, equivalent to a direct perception of the constant rise and
fall of phenomena. At this point the Vism introduces a description of the ten
defilements of insight (Vism p. 633f.). Most of them are states which
appear in themselves desirable: joy, knowledge, tranquility, happiness,
mindfulness and equipoise are included in the last. Their danger is that the
meditator may be overwhelmed by the intensity of these experiences and
imagine that he has already obtained his goal. Only when he is able to
distinguish these tempting but illusory states from the true path is the Fifth
purification completed and only then can he continue his journey.
This may all seem far from St Teresas account of the Sixth Mansions.
Yet a great deal of it is concerned with the problems of recognizing the
exact nature of particular experiences. St Teresa gives very precise
descriptions in order to differentiate between locutions, visions and raptures
derived from God, those originating in the imagination and those coming
from the devil. While one may not agree with her cosmology it would be
foolish to dispute the accuracy of her perceptions or the genuineness of her
experience. Her account is very detailed. No less than eighty of the 206
pages of the standard Spanish edition are taken up with the Sixth Mansions.
To summarize it in brief, these Mansions begin with severe trials, both
internal and external. The soul has been wounded with love for the Spouse
MYSTICISM AND PURIFICATION 113

and seeks more opportunity of being alone, trying so far as is possible, to


someone in its state, to remove everything which can disturb it in this
solitude (T p. 99). But these very trials make it fly still higher (T p. 107).
The result is an awakening of the soul arising in various ways. One of these
ways is by means of locutions which St Teresa discusses at length. In due
course God confirms the Spiritual Betrothal by bestowing raptures. These
may involve imaginary or intellectual visions or an experience of the flight
of the soul. Sometimes the occurrence of raptures becomes very frequent
and they cannot be avoided even in public. An uncontrollable jubilation
may occur. It may last for a whole day and the soul goes about like one
who has drunk a great deal, but not so much as to be deprived of his senses
(T p. 143). And not as someone in a state of hysterical excitement which St
Teresa is also able to distinguish clearly. But such experiences also greatly
increase the sense of sorrow for sin. Both intellectual and imaginary visions
of the presence of Jesus may occur. Various truths may be revealed. It may
be seen how this world is all lying and falsehood and as such cannot
endure (T p. 171). It is a very great truth that we have no good thing in
ourselves, but only misery and nothingness; and anyone who fails to
understand this is walking in falsehood (ibid.). Finally she describes a kind
of spiritual dying which precedes entry to the Seventh Mansion,
Only a little of this could be paralleled from the Vism, but probably
nearly all could be found somewhere in the Buddhist tradition. By way of
example let me cite a passage written by a contemporary meditation master:
As for external nimittas which come and go, one may or may not know
whether a nimitta is external or arises from oneself. But when one has
become skilled with internal nimittas which arise from oneself, one will be
able to know which are external nimittas. External nimittas are associated
with many different happenings of people, animals, pretas, bhtas, the son
of a deva, a devat, Indra or Brahma, any of which may at that time be
associated with ones samdhi, even as one talks to a guest who comes on a
visit.8
The Vism continues with the sixth purification and gives a full account
of the eight contemplation knowledges which represent the stage of strong
insight (balava-vipassan). Buddhaghosa explains the first seven
knowledges with a simile. A man fishing with a net reaches into it and takes
hold of a snake. Thinking it to be a fish, he is delighted. This is a figure for
our delighting in . When he sees the three marks on the head of the
poisonous snake, his delight changes to fear. This represents the first two
contemplation knowledges which comprehend the three signs of
impermanence, suffering and not-self and lead to our realizing that
is a fearful place. Realizing the danger the man experiences revulsion
towards the snake in his hand and feels a strong desire to be free from it.
Similarly the meditator knowing the danger in compounded things
experiences revulsion for them and arouses a strong desire for liberation.
114 COUSINS

The fisherman seeks to get free and unwraps the coils from his arm starting
with the tail. This corresponds to the contemplations on emptiness
(sut) which characterize the seventh contemplation knowledge. Finally
the fisherman swings the snake two or three times around his head in order
to weaken it and throws it away from him. He then scrambles back up on to
dry land and stands looking back at the way he had come and thinking I am
freed from a great snake.
A modern master writes: Of the nine aspects [of insight knowledge]
not all of them occur to all aspirants. Even their occurrence does not
necessarily take place in that order. Any one of the seven may take place, to
be followed immediately by the eighth and the ninth.9 It is not clear how far
Buddhaghosa would agree with this, but the difference is perhaps fairly
typical of the kind of variation one finds between the practice tradition and
the theoretical literature.
The eighth contemplation, knowledge, is portrayed as a stage in which no
further effort is required and equipoise is well established. It is perhaps
worth mentioning that at this point the meditator can only wait for the right
conditions to occur for the break-through to the supramundane.
Buddhaghosa illustrates it with the simile of the land-finding crow which
may be carried on board ship. If there is land in sight it will go towards it. If
not, it will remain on board. Likewise if this knowledge sees nibbna, the
sphere of peace, it will abandon the whole process of conditioned things
and leap forth to nibbna. If not, it will continue with conditioned things as
its object. One might note that this is the kind of psychological situation in
which a theist would have recourse to notions of grace or supernatural
favour. The Buddhist of course interprets it in terms of the accumulation of
pram and the law of relational conditions. St Teresas Sixth Mansions and
the account given by Buddhaghosa of the sixth purification have at least
this much in common: both describe an acute rejection of ordinary worldly
life in order to make a further extraordinary leap.
For St Teresa this brings us to the Seventh Mansions where the soul
arrives by means of an intellectual vision in which the Trinity is revealed:
First of all the spirit becomes enkindled, as it were, by a cloud of the
greatest brightnessthese three Persons are distinct and yet, by a
wonderful kind of knowledge which is given to it, the soul understands as
most profound truth that all three Persons are one Substance and one Power
and one Knowledge and one God alone; so that what we hold by Faith the
soul may be said to grasp by sight, although nothing is seen by the eyes,
either of the body or of the soul, for it is no imaginary vision (T p. 182).
Henceforward they are constantly present. The soul perceives quite clearly
that They are in the interior of its heartin the very interior, in some very
deep place. Yet such a person is not entranced: In all that belongs to the
service of God it is much more alert than before; and, when otherwise
occupied, it rests in that happy companionship. Even on occasions when
MYSTICISM AND PURIFICATION 115

this experience is not realized so fully, some awareness remains. St Teresa


compares it to being with companions in a very bright room when the
shutters are closed. Even in the darkness one retains an awareness that the
others are present. She also suggests that it is as if the soul is divided into
two parts. One part remains undisturbed even when the other is concerned
with trials and occupations.
St Teresa appears to distinguish the Seventh Mansion from the Spiritual
Marriage itself which takes place at a later point. She writes: When
granting this favour for the first time, His Majesty desires to reveal Himself
to the soul through an imaginary vision of His most sacred Humanity (T p.
185). She points out that this will take different forms for different people.
It seems, however, that the more normal form of the Spiritual Marriage is
an intellectual vision more subtle than the previous ones in which the Lord
appears in this centre of the soul. This is much more central, interior and
stable. The difference between the Spiritual Marriage and the Spiritual
Betrothal which occurs in the raptures of the Sixth Mansions is the same,
says St Teresa, as that between two betrothed persons and two who cannot
be separated any more. For her then the Spiritual Marriage is not a mere
union in which two things have been brought together but could be again
separated. In this other favour of the Lord it is not so: the soul always remains
with its God in that centre (T p. 187). Again: It is like rain falling from the
heavens into a river or spring; there is nothing but water there and it is
impossible to divide or separate the water belonging to the river from that
which fell from the heavens. She also gives as similes a tiny streamlet
entering the sea and light entering a room through two large windows and
becoming one inside it. It is here that the little butterfly of which we have
spoken dies, and with the greatest joy, because Christ is now its life. All
this is perhaps best summed up when she declares: It is quite certain that,
when we empty ourselves of all that is creature and detach ourselves from it
for the love of God, that same Lord will fill us with Himself. (T p. 18899)
It is very interesting to find that Buddhaghosas Seventh purification is
also an experiential realization of fundamental doctrine, in this case the Four
Noble Truths. At the moment when the path of stream-entry, or one of the
higher paths, is aroused a number of things are accomplished: defilements are
abandoned, some temporarily others permanently, conditioned things are
relinquished as objects supporting the mind, nibbna becomes the object of
consciousness, the thirty-seven states connected with awakening become
fixed (vsan) in the personal continuity and the Four Noble Truths are
comprehended by a single knowledge. This amounts in a sense to the last
achievement. By making cessation its object, path knowledge reaches, sees
and pierces the Four Noble Truths (Vism p. 690).
This is a highly sophisticated understanding of the objects of the four
truths: With respect to the first truth one knows: dukkha is the
conditioned; the second: arising is the cause of the conditioned; the third:
116 COUSINS

cessation is the unconditioned; and the fourth: path is the means to the
unconditioned. Each of these knowledges performs a particular function.
The first truth is to be comprehended, the second abandoned, the third
realized and the fourth developed. According to Buddhaghosa a single
path of knowledge accomplishes all these four functions in a single
moment. Just as a lamp performs four functions simultaneously in a single
momentit burns the wick, dispels darkness, makes light appear and uses
up the oil. This is really quite a startling statement in abhidhamma terms
and ought really to imply that the conditioned and the unconditioned are the
same thing, although of course Buddhaghosa does not draw this conclusion.
What it certainly does indicate is a state in which a knowledge arises which
is permanently impressed in the mind and involves an awareness of the
nature of the phenomenal world, abandonment of mental defilements, direct
experience of the unconditioned and the structuring of consciousness in
terms of the factors of the path and of awakening, etc. This is potentially
accessible at all times.
I do not wish to argue that the Trinity and the Four Noble Truths are
identical or even that one is a misunderstood form of the other. Both
however are statements of the relationship between the ultimate and the
temporal. They are therefore functionally similar in the present context.
Both also involve reoriented or fundamentally changed outlook and some
kind of restructuring of consciousness. With St Teresas description of the
Spiritual Marriage as such we are on less firm ground. Of course, the stream-
enterer is the breast-born son of the Buddha, heir of dhamma, he has
joined the family (gotra) of the Buddhas, and so on. Whether this amounts
to anything similar is hard to assess. The difficulty is, however, that St
Teresa does not really make clear the distinctive features of this stage.
With the effects of the two, however, we are on firmer ground. In the
words of St Teresa, there is a forgetfulness of the self which really seems
no longer to exist (T p. 193). The motivation is renewed and there is great
interior joy and much more peace. Desire for union is partly replaced by
desire to serve the Lord. Fear of death ceases and there is no longer desire
for consolations and favours. These souls have a marked detachment from
everything and a desire to be always either alone or busy with something
that is to some souls advantage. Love is increased and if negligence
occurs, the soul is awakened by God through an impulse from the interior
of the soul which awakens the faculties. The soul is almost always in
tranquility and has an unwavering certainty that it comes from God.
Compare this with the stream-enterer who is particularly characterized by
the absence of the three fetters of , often translated as
personality belief, of adherence to sla and vows as a means to liberation
and of doubt. Elaborated, this means that the view of self is removed,
attachment to the body given up, ritualism is dropped and certainty arising
MYSTICISM AND PURIFICATION 117

from seeing nibbna is always present. Equally defilements in general are


reduced and wrong actions of the more serious kind will no longer occur.
Many more detailed comparisons would be possible than are given here.
To enumerate them would require a book rather than a paper. What I would
wish to argue in this context is that there are between the accounts of St
Teresa and Buddhaghosa a whole series of similarities. In particular the
models of the path which both of them give run parallel. Each begins with
purification, each moves on to states of interiorization, joy and peace, then
to trance phenomena, then to rejection of the world combined with non-
normal acquisitions of knowledge, and each finishes with a transformatory
knowledge which remains permanently accessible. Although there are many
differences of detail and a very different context, the general structure is
remarkably similar.

NOTES

1 See for example S Katz (ed.), Mysticism and Philosophical Analysis,


London 1978; and P.G.Moore, Recent Studies of Mysticism,
Religion III, no. 2 (1973), pp. 14656.
2 S I, 13=p. 163; also Udnavarga v. 156.
3 P. Silverio de Santa Teresa, Obras de Sta. Teresa de Jesus, Burgos
1917. vol. IV, pp. 1210. ( = T, i.e. the text of Interior Castle.) I have
mostly used the expression mansions rather than dwelling places
as this is still the most familiar translation of John XIV, 2.
4 For example, in the above discussion of the advantages of the thirteen
. It is not explicitly mentioned, but it is certainly part of the
force of what Buddhaghosa is saying.
5 The Greatness of the Soul, tr. J.M.Colleran, London 1950, pp.
98104. Nevertheless, Augustine does not repudiate this basic
structure of the spiritual path when he moves further away from
Neoplatonism. Elements of it are reformulated in various of his
writings, e.g. Serm. 330.3.
6 Buddhist Jhna: Its nature and attainment according to the Pli
sources, Religion III (1973), pp. 11531, esp. p. 120f.
7 Phra Mah Boowa nasampanno, Forest Dhamma, tr. Bhikkhu
Pavaddho, Bangkok 1973. p. 11. The excerpt included in Jack
Kornfield, Living Buddhist Masters, Santa Cruz 1977, p. 169 omits
part of this passage.
8 Ibid., pp. 1819.
9 Phra Acharn Thate Desarans, Dhamma in Practice, tr. Pabhsa
Bhikkhu & Siri Buddhasukh, Bangkok 1977, p. 88; also p. 40 and p.
255. The list of nine is reached by including as the
ninth.
118
8
LIVING BETWEEN THE WORLDS:
BHAKTI POETRY AND THE
CARMELITE MYSTICS
Deirdre Green

[The mystic] thinks of herself as a person suspended aloft, unable to come


down and rest anywhere on earth or to ascend to Heaven.1
Thus St Teresa of Avila describes the spiritual pain and torment created by
the mystics longing for God. In proportion as the mystics yearning for
union with the divine Being increases, so too does his or her acute
awareness of his or her own shortcomings, sins, failings and finitude. The
mystic is struck between two worldsthat of the divine and that of the
everyday; the former seems out of reach and the latter cannot satisfy.
The purpose of this paper is to explore theistic mysticism as exemplified
by the Spanish Carmelites St Teresa of Avila and St John of the Cross on
the one hand and some of the bhakti poet-mystics on the other. The
investigations will be undertaken particularly with a view to the attitudes
shown to this world, namely the material world of our day-to-day activities
with all its limitations and frustrations, and the other world or the realm of
the divine which the mystic claims to encounter directly in personal spiritual
experience.
As we shall see, some very close similarities of expression and
symbolism between these particular Christian and Hindu forms of
mysticism may be observed. They both illustrate a type of experience in
which the mystic feels a more or less constant sense of suffering, pain and
disorientation in spite of the joy and bliss that also often accompanies this
experience due to the awareness of distance or separation between the
mystic and the Deity which brings about the conflict of living between the
worlds and the inability to reconcile these worlds once and for all. I shall
also suggest that the theories of Victor Turner regarding liminality may
throw some light on the stance of these types of mysticism.
It may be helpful initially to outline what is meant by theistic
mysticism. Over the years scholars have attempted to put forward various
definitions of mysticism as a phenomenon, but it is difficult to find a single
definition that will fit all cases. Within the context solely of the mystics to
be discussed here, however, we are concerned with what is perceived as an
unmediated inner experience of a personal Deity. The key element of this
120 GREEN

type of religious experience is this encounter with the personal divine Being
within the depths of ones own soul or self. Such experiences are deeply
felt and transforming personal experiences which may alter the course of
ones whole life and through which one feels that divine reality has been
revealed to oneself. The mystical journey, the process of self-integration
and integration of the self with the reality thus revealed, culminates in
theistic mysticism in union with the divine Being.
It should be noted, however, that there are other forms of mysticism not
discussed in this paper, equally worthy of attention, from which theistic
mysticism must be distinguished.2 For example, in monistic mysticism the
mystic, rather than enjoying a relationship of communion with a personal
Deity, merges into and becomes one with a non-personal divine Principle; or
in nature mysticism the beauties of nature are seen as revealing divine
reality. Again, in Buddhist forms of mysticism, if indeed Bhuddist spiritual
experiences can be classed as such,3 the content of spiritual experience is
not reified, that is to say, the experience is not seen as referring to a union with
a substantial divine Being or Principle which has reality of its own
independent of the experience, but is seen simply as a transcendent state
entailing insight into the true nature of ourselves and reality.
The suffering brought about by the constant sense of separation from
God in theistic mysticism is well illustrated in the writings of St John of the
Cross (154291). He was a contemporary, friend and fellow Carmelite of St
Teresa and many correspondences between their writings can doubtless be
traced to mutual influence, while others seem rather to be based on the fact
that they describe what appear to be similar spiritual experiences. St Johns
prose works show a great depth of theological learning with meticulously
detailed analyses and expositions. His poetry is, by contrast, rich in colour
and texture and full of symbolic complexity (he is widely acclaimed as one
of Spains greatest poets).
St John is one of those writers who conceive of the mystical path as
consisting of more or less distinct phases of transformation or sequences of
attainment of more and more exalted levels of religious consciousness and
understanding. Like many other writers who put forward such schemes of
mystical progress, however, he emphasizes that such stages of experience
represent only a broad generalization or rough scheme; the stages intermingle
with and merge into each other so that St John does not mean to imply that
mystical experiences fall into a rigidly strict sequence. He utilizes the
classical three stages of Catholic mysticismpurgation, contemplation and
unioninterspersed with what he calls the Night of Sense and the Night of
Spirit.4 We shall be particularly concerned here with St Johns two nights.
These are both times of terrible spiritual suffering and trials. The soul
suffers great aridity and can no longer find the consolation and sweetness
that it used to have in spiritual things. It is profoundly conscious of an inner
emptiness, feeling that God has deserted it, and suffers the agonies of
LIVING BETWEEN THE WORLDS 121

separation from God and of seeing its own utter unworthiness. It feels
acutely and is painfully conscious of its own inadequacies and iniquities.
The external things of the world and of the senses also give no joy so that
the soul feels lost, wandering in darkness, unable to find stability and
happiness either in this world or in the other world. These nights of sense
and spirit are purificatory processes, leading ultimately to a deeper
knowledge of God; the soul is tested by its trials and sufferings almost to
breaking point, until a crisis is reached which will carry the mystic over the
threshold to a new and higher level of religious understanding.
The two nights are very similar in their general effects, as outlined
above, but whereas in the night of sense, which occurs after purgation and
before contemplation, the senses and imagination are purified, in the night
of spirit, after contemplation and before union, the higher faculties, that
is, the understanding, memory and will, undergo this purificatory process.
The nights are processes of transition from one form of spiritual awareness
to another, demanding great adjustments in the mystics orientation. An
interior struggle is going on between the limited life of his humanity and the
greater life of the divine which is being revealed. The mystic must die to the
limited self with all its narrow and hedonistic desires and attitudes in order
to be reborn in God. St John in fact says that the pain of the night is like
dying and that the soul must die a living death until it is transformed.5
Here already a point of interest may be noted in connection with Victor
Turners studies. As an anthropologist investigating ritual action,
particularly among the Ndembu of north-west Zambia, Turner has
developed, from his own fieldwork and from the earlier research of Van
Gennep and others on rites of passage, a concept which he calls liminality
and which has since attracted considerable interest among scholars of
religions in general. According to Turner people or objects playing a key
role in the rituals he investigated are in a liminal state, that is, they elude or
fall between the boundaries of the normal classificatory system of their
culture. They are betwixt and between the usual states or conditions
assigned by social structure or intellectual convention; a concept which, I
suspect, may elucidate the feeling of living at the interface between two
worlds shown in the experiences discussed in this paper, with their
accompanying dual emotive tone (of sorrow and joy, as shall shortly be
illustrated) and polarized frame of religious reference (this world/other
world; finitude/infinity; humanity/God).
We may leave aside here Turners particular conclusion regarding the
Ndembu, since he also demonstrates that liminality is a concept of
considerable importance for the study of religion in general and not only in
a ritual context. He lists various characteristics typical of those in a liminal
state, some of which will be seen to correspond, as we proceed, with the
evidence given by the mystics discussed in this paper. For the present we
may note that the liminal state, according to Turner, is frequently linked to
122 GREEN

death and to darkness as are the spiritual trials of St John; and that people in
liminal state often exhibit humility, acceptance of suffering, total obedience
to religious dictates, withdrawal from the usual social norms and roles of
their culture, stripping off of wordly distinctions and status in search of
simplicity and equality, and repudiation of property, privileges, material
pleasures and sexuality.
All these characteristics are marked in the Christian monastic tradition,
as Turner himself discusses, noting that Nowhere has this
institutionalization of liminality been more clearly marked and defined than
in the monastic and mendicant states in the great world religions.6 He
further uses the term communitas to refer to institutionalized liminality or
the attempt to construct a community of individuals bonded together by
liminal experience.
St Johns conception of the spiritual path is effectively illustrated in his
poem The Spiritual Canticle which uses the language and imagery of the
Song of Songs to recount the quest of the bride (the soul) for her divine
bridegroom. We are fortunate in that St John himself wrote long
commentaries on his major poems in which he explains in precise detail
how the allegories used are intended to illustrate the phases of the mystical
life. The Spiritual Canticle, he says, deals with the whole course of the
mystical path. We shall be concerned here mainly with those aspects of the
poem that deal with the two nights and with the experiences connected with
separation from God; however, as we shall see, since the stages of mystical
experience in St Johns scheme merge into each other, the experience of the
night and of separation is in fact more or less continuous. In the opening
verse of the poem the soul longs for union with the bridegroom; she has
been wounded by an arrow of love (a symbol which we shall find reflected
in the writings of St Teresa and the bhakti mystics) and cries out to the
bridegroom to reveal to her how she may find him:

Where have you hidden,


Beloved, and left me moaning?
You fled like the stag
After wounding me;
I went out calling You and You were gone.7

A number of verses follow which describe how the bride seeks the
bridegroom with all her faculties and with the aid of angelic intercessors,
personified as shepherds and sheepfolds respectively. She cultivates virtue,
represented as journeying to the mountains, and spiritual exercises ( =
journeying to the waters); she ignores the temptations of the world ( = wild
beasts) and denies herself the pleasures and gratifications of the material
realm ( = refusing to pluck the flowers by the wayside). Although she is
able to see traces of the beauty of the Beloved in the world of nature which
LIVING BETWEEN THE WORLDS 123

he has created, this is no possible substitute for seeing him face to face. She
soon realizes that nothing less than her Beloveds presence will satisfy her;
the sight of the messengers (Gods traces in the physical world) only
increases the agony of love-in-separation:

Oh! who can heal me?


Give me at once Thyself,
Send me no more
A messenger
Who cannot tell me what I wish.

All they who serve are telling me


Of Thy unnumbered graces;
And all wound me more and more,
And something leaves me dying,
I know not what, of which they are darkly speaking.

But how thou perseverest, O life,


Not living where thou livest;
The arrows bring death
Which thou receivest
From thy conceptions of the Beloved.

Why, after wounding


This heart, hast Thou not healed it?
And why, after stealing it,
Hast Thou thus abandoned it,
And not carried away the stolen prey?8

St Johns forms of expression and symbolism here are very similar to those
used by the bhakti poets when describing the mysticism of love-in-
separation. Like those poets he makes use of romantic symbolism of the
secular love poetry of his age, adapting its techniques and style to spiritual
themes. (This is known in Spanish as divinizacon.)
St John comments on the above verses that the soul complains of Gods
absence with particular agony because it has abandoned all wordly things
on account of its consuming desire for union; yet it still has to endure the
sense of distance from God.9 We see again, then, that the soul can find no
comfort or resting place in either of the two worlds.
The heart cannot rest in peace without the possession of something, and
when its affections are placed [i.e. given to God], it has neither the
possession of itself nor of anything else; neither does it perfectly possess
what it loves. In this state its weariness is in proportion to its loss until it
shall enter into possession and be satisfied; for until then the soul is as an
124 GREEN

empty vessel waiting to be filled, as a hungry man eager for food, as a sick
man sighing for health, and as a man suspended in the air without support to
his feet.10
Compare St Teresas statement that the mystic is like a person suspended
aloft, unable to rest either on earth or in heaven; a vivid illustration of the
betwixt-and-between nature of the liminal state.
St John speaks of the trials of the dark night in terms of an inner fire
which purifies, purges and transforms the soul until it is refined like gold in
the crucible,11 and itself becomes a living flame of love.12 He adds that
when a soul is on fire with loveit will feel as if a seraph with a burning
brand had struck italready glowing as coal or rather all aflameand had
burnt it utterly. When the burning brand has thus touched it, the soul feels
that the wound it has received is delicious beyond all imaginationThe soul
beholds itself now as one immense sea of fire.13
I must state at this point that I do not by any means wish to imply that
theistic mysticism has no sense of joy or that it is unduly pessimistic
because of the tension and suffering expressed. Indeed, paradoxically, there
is a joy in the suffering itself; the night is not a wholly negative process,
for it is also a guiding Light. Mystics say that if we can learn to accept our
suffering and to empty ourselves of all worldly attachments, both of which,
incidentally, Turner finds to be attributes of the liminal state, we shall find
that our suffering is transmuted to joy and love and that we become filled with
the divine life. This is quite apart from the fact that the mystic has moments
of unitive experience when the suffering of living between the worlds is
transcended, when the two worlds seem briefly to unite as the mystic enters
into contemplative communion with God. But it seems to me that many
previous studies of mysticism have focused almost solely on the final goal,
the culmination of mystical experience, the unitive state with its associated
joy and religious bliss.
If only to redress the balance, it is important to note that in certain types
of mysticism the sense of suffering and of separation from the Deity takes
equal prominence. Indeed, in St Johns writings the night never really ends;
one enters it near the beginning of the spiritual life and never really
emerges from it, although there are moments of respite when the sufferings
are only intermittent. The trials of the soul never quite cease; they merely
reappear under different forms. The further we progress along the mystical
way the more deeply we become aware of our own shortcomings and
inadequacies and the harder and more difficult the trials and testings
become. The night does not end until the soul achieves perfect union with
God; but St John, as a Christian, holds that completely perfect union cannot
be attained in this earthly life but only in the life to come in the other world.
The theological belief that we can never fully know God in this life, then, is
crucial to the stance of this type of mysticism. The tension between this
world and the other world is more or less constant.14
LIVING BETWEEN THE WORLDS 125

St Teresa of Avila (151582), unlike St John, was no learned theologian


and her writings show a direct simplicity and a down-to-earth,
unpretentious humour. In many ways she comes over as a quite different
personality from St John, and yet she also speaks at length of the suffering
of the mystical life and of the great distress and confusion felt by the soul as
it is torn between its desire for earthly things and its growing love for God;
and, like St John, she often uses imagery reminiscent of the Song of Songs
or refers to this scripture to illustrate a point. Perhaps even more than it is
the case with St Johns writings, however, her teachings illustrate the
ambivalent emotive tone of suffering for Gods sakethat is, love-in-
separation contains elements of both suffering and joy. Indeed, Teresa, like
many Christian mystics, sees suffering as something to be embraced,
because it is a way of imitating Christ, as something to be valued, because
it shows us that God is working in us.
I am reminded of an apocryphal story about Teresa which illustrates both
this belief and her sense of humour. During a period of intense spiritual
suffering and of endless worldly annoyances over the organization of her
Carmelite order, Teresa was out on a journey one day when she fell into a
ditch and was covered in slime; no doubt she felt that on top of all her other
troubles this was the last straw. Then suddenly a divine voice spoke to her:
Do you not know, Teresa, that this is how I treat my friends? To which
she retorted: Well, if thats so, its not surprising that you dont have many
of them, is it?
Of particular relevance to our theme is a phase of the spiritual life
described by Teresa similar to St Johns dark night which she calls the Pain
of God or the Wound of Love. There is an acute awareness of separation
from God combined with an ever greater love and yearning for him,
producing desolation and inner anguish; a bitter-sweet pain of insatiable
love. Teresa speaks of a grief that reaches to the depths of our being and
seems to tear the soul to pieces and grind it to powder (T p. 57). Like St
Johns night, this is a time of purification through suffering. Again like St
John and many other mystics, Teresa speaks of this experience in terms of a
burning inner fire which refines and purifies the self and says that the soul,
through its suffering, is refined like gold in the crucible.15
I have just been wondering if my God could be described as the fire in a
lighted brazier, from which some spark will fly out and touch the soul in
such a way that it will be able to feel the burning heat of the fireAlthough
occasionally this experience lasts for a certain length of time, it goes and
comes again; it is, in short, never permanent and for that reason it never
completely enkindles the soul [i.e. so as to burn it up altogether and unite
it fully to God]; for, just as the soul is about to become enkindled, the spark
dies and leaves the soul yearning once again to suffer that loving pain
(T p. 77)
126 GREEN

Teresa also speaks of the heart being pierced by a fiery arrow or spear. She
had, in particular, one intense vision of an angel with his face all aflame,
reminiscent of St Johns seraph with the burning brand:
In his hands I saw a long golden spear and at the end of the iron tip I
seemed to see a point of fire. With this he seemed to pierce my heart
several times so that it penetrated to my entrails. When he drew it out I
thought he was drawing them out with it and he left me completely afire
with a great love for God.16
Because of this vision Teresa is often depicted in ecstasy with an angel
piercing her heart with an arrow or spear, as for example in Verninis
sculpture Ecstasy of St Teresa. She says; the soul has been wounded
with love for the spouse (T p. 69); it is conscious of having been most
delectably woundedit is certain that this is a precious experience and it
would be glad if it were never to be healed of that wound. It complains to
its spouse with words of love and even cries out aloud, being unable to help
itself, for it realizes that He is present but will not manifest Himself in such
a way as to allow it to enjoy Him, and this is a great grief, though a sweet
and delectable one (T p. 76): note here the dual emotive tone of both
agony and ecstasy. Teresa says that this distress seems to penetrate [the
souls] very bowels; andwhen He that has wounded it draws out the
arrow, the bowels seem to come with it, so deeply does it feel this love
(T p. 77). The arrow of fire makes a deep wound, not, I think, in any
region where physical pain can be felt, but in the souls most intimate depths.
It passes as quickly as a flash of lightning and leaves everything in our
nature that is earthly reduced to powder (T p. 124).
It is of this phase of the spiritual life that Teresa says that the mystic is
like a person suspended aloft, unable to come down and rest on earth or to
ascend to heaven. She elsewhere elaborates on this experience of living
between two worlds and its accompanying sense of being unable to find
repose in either one. She uses the analogy of a silkworm turning into a
butterfly to describe the spiritual death to the old self, with its attachment to
earthly things and to self-will, and the emergence of the transformed soul.
But the butterly, once it has emerged from its cocoon, knows not where to
settle and make its abodeeverything it sees on earth leaves it dissatisfied
(T p. 55). Earthly comforts are no consolation; indeed, they only increase
the souls torment. Yet no comfort can be obtained, either, from prayer or
the interior life of the soul in God, for All that (the soul) can do for God
seems to it slight by comparison with its desires (T p. 55). Everything
wearies itit can find no true rest in the creaturesas this little butterfly
feels a stranger to things of the earth, it should be seeking a new resting
place. But where will the poor little creature go? (T p. 56) The mystic is
now conscious of a strange solitude since there is not a creature on the
whole earth who can be a companion to her (T p. 125); other people, and
all earthly things, seem like shadows (T p. 127).
LIVING BETWEEN THE WORLDS 127

Teresa says that this state involves peril of actual physical death
(T p. 125), but whether we are to believe this or not, it is certain that the
intensity of the spiritual death to the limited self undergone by the mystic
can be such as to make one feel that one is near physical death. The soul at
this time also has longings for actual death, because it is so anxious to attain
complete union with God, and yet it knows that this can never be achieved
in this world (T p. 97). Although Teresa does speak of unitive experiences
which the mystic may briefly enjoy where the divine realm seems to unite
with the material world in the mystics consciousness of God, she also
holds, like St John, that we cannot fully know God in this life, and contantly
constrasts Gods glory with our own wretchedness and sin. It is not possible
to be in a continual state of absorption in God in this life (T p. 31); we must
bear crosses in one way or another for as long as we live. And if anyone
told me that after reaching this state [of union] he had enjoyed continual
rest and joy, I should say that he had not reached it at all (T p. 56)
though angelic spirits, freed from everything corporeal, may remain
permanently enkindled in love, this is not possible for those of us who live
in this mortal body (T p. 104). For Teresa, perhaps, the pain of separation
from God and the resultant longing for him are necessary if our love is to be
entirely selfless and full of humility; for the experience of love-in-
separation makes us realize that we can do nothing without God.17
This sense of unworthiness and helplesness of the embodied soul is also
emphasized by the bhakti poets. The religious position of the various bhakti
movements which arose in India from the sixth century onwards
emphasizes separation between the devotee and the Deity, in contrast to the
Advaitic model. In bhakti the human soul is seen as unable fully to
understand the Divine and the vision of the Divine in this earthly life is
necessarily incomplete. There is therefore a strong accent on love,
devotion, ecstasy, adoration and on the grace of the personal Deity. The
mystic throws himself or herself into a passionate relationship, surrendering
to and putting all trust in the Deity.
A favourite image of the bhakti poets is that of love-in-separation, with
wide employment being made of romantic and sexual metaphors. The
bhakti mystics rejected the outward forms and ossified rituals of the
Brhmanism of their time, emphasizing instead inner purity, devotion and
personal religious experience. They also rejected the class/caste system,
holding that the path of devotion was available to all regardless of social
background. The emphasis on spontaneous, immediate experience, the
rejection of accepted cultural and religious standards, the repudiation of
property, marriage, the institution of family and regard for social position
shown by many of the bhakti poets are all cited by Turner as characteristics
typical of those in a state of liminality. Indeed, Ramanujan adopts some of
Turners terminology in his analysis of the Vraaivas, noting that whereas
the religious establishment attempts to render the universe predictable and
128 GREEN

safe, for the Vraaiva poets the religious life is an unmediated vision,
unpredictable, unconditional, and therefore an example of anti-structure
according to Turners typology.18
Just as the bhakti mystics repudiated the implications of the class/caste
system, so St Teresa, in setting up her Order (the Discalced Carmelites)
upheld absence of hierarchical status, which Turner finds to be a further
characteristic of liminality, as her ideal: she had no time for the concern
with pride in ones lineage and purity of blood (limpieza de sangre) which
had reached obsessive proportions in the Spain of her time. The futilities of
worldly honour (fama) and the niceties of social etiquette and
respectability must be sublimated by followers of her rule into a concern for
true spiritual worth and equality of all before God.
Before proceeding with our discussion of the bhakti mystics we should
note that our own tendency to see the universe in terms of two worlds is
specific to our own culture, being based on the dualism of the Cartesian,
Christian and Platonic schemes, and this pattern does not usually
correspond to that of traditional Indian cosmology which speaks sometimes
of three, sometimes of seven, sometimes of other numbers of worlds,
depending on context. But for the purpose of the present discussion it seems
to me permissible to continue to speak of this world and the other world
as an heuristic device, for we find that the bhakti poets frequently give
expression to the conflict of being caught between two basic modes of
being, this world ( ) and the other world of spiritual liberation and
union with the Deity. (Cf. BU 4, 3, 9: This person has two states [of
consciousness], that of this world and that of the other world.)19 For
example, Mahdev, a member of the Vraaiva or bhakti
movement which arose in the tenth century and whose devotees have left us
a collection of lyrical poems (vacanas) describing their devotion to iva,
exclaims:

Husband inside,
lover outside.
I cant manage them both.

This world
and that other
cannot manage them both. (S p. 127)

It is said that Mahdev was married against her will. Her poems are
certainly full of reference to the contrasts between human and divine love.
From her childhood her only love was for iva as Cennamallik-rjuna, my
Lord white as jasmine, whom she represents in her poems sometimes as
her illicit lover and sometimes as her only true husband. In another poem
she says that she has fallen in love with the Beautiful One who knows no
LIVING BETWEEN THE WORLDS 129

decay nor death, who has no form nor features and uncompromisingly
exhorts that all worldly husbands who are subject to death and decay should
be thrown to the kitchen fires! (S p. 134)
At an early age Mahdev severed her ties with the world of society and
wandered as a homeless ascetic (a liminal state) in order to give her whole
self to love of iva. Perhaps we can detect the disorientation of living at the
interface between the worlds in the final lines of her next poem:

O mother I burned
in a flameless fire

O mother I suffered
a bloodless wound

mother I tossed
without a pleasure:

loving my lord white as jasmine


I wandered through unlikely worlds. (S p. 121)

The flameless fire and the bloodless wound find a parallel in Teresa of
Avilas purifying inner fire and fiery arrow or spear and, indeed, can be
shown to be very widespread symbolic motifs of devotional mysticism
closely connected with the pain of love-in-separation. Compare also the
following verse by Mahdev:

How can the unwounded


know the pain
of the wounded?

O lord white as jasmine


your loves blade stabbed
and broken in my flesh,

I writhe(S p. 138)

Mahdevs love for iva is constantly expressed in romantic and sensual


imagery:
Come to me, O my groom, auspicious-scented, gold-adorned and rich-clad.
Your coming would verily be the coming back of my life.
I am watching the roads, all athirst, hoping that Chenna Mallikrjuna will
come.20
She also makes use of the theme of love-in-separation and lovesickness.
130 GREEN

Four parts of the day


I grieve for you.
Four parts of the night
Im mad for you.
I lie lost
sick for you, night and day,
O lord white as jasmine21

Another of the Vraaivas, , who was both a statesman and a


mystic and therefore truly lived in two worlds, expressed the conflict
between them in a poem which draws on the traditional Hindu imagery of
life in this world as a raging sea :

a grindstone hung at the foot


a deadwood log hung at the neck

the one will not let me float


and the other will not let me sink

O times true enemy


O lord of the meeting rivers

tide me over this life at sea22

He implores iva:

Why why did you bring me to birth,


wretch in this world,
exile from the other? (S p. 71)

and elsewhere accuses his God of taking away earth from under a man
falling from the sky (S p. 62).
Bhakti, of course, was directed not only to iva but also to , most
commonly in the form of his avatra . bhakti is eloquently
expressed by Mr B said to have been a Rjput princess and now a folk
heroine. She lived in the sixteenth century and, like Mahdev, rejected the
values of the society in which she had been brought up to become a
wandering ascetic. Again, her devotion is expressed in the sensual imagery
of the mystical marriage:

Dwell in my eyes, O son of Nanda; enchanting is Your figure, dusky Your


complexion, large are Your eyes. So beautiful looks the flute on Your
LIVING BETWEEN THE WORLDS 131

nectarlike lipsThe belt of little bells round Your waist and the trinkets on
Your arms look charming and tinkle sweetly.23

This blissful experience of beauty is sometimes referred to as


in contrast to , the sorrow of separation from him. Like
many of the passages in Mr Bs writings, the above is similar in tone
and effect to the Song of Songs by which St John and St Teresa were so
strongly influenced:

My beloved is all radiant and ruddy, distinguished among ten thousand.


His head is the finest gold; his locks are wavy, black as raven.
His eyes are like doves beside springs of water, bathed in milk, fitly set.
His cheeks are like beds of spices, yielding fragrance.
His lips are lilies, distilling liquid myrrh.
His arms are rounded gold, set with jewels. His body is ivory work,
encrusted with sapphires. (5, 68)

Mr B also speaks of love-in-separation and of the lovesickness or divine


madness (dvn) induced by the acute sense of absence.
O Friend, I am mad with love; none can know my anguish. Only he who
has been wounded or he who dealt the blow understands the woundedThe
bed of my Beloved is in heaven, what chance have I of meeting (him)?
Smitten with pain, from forest to forest I roam. No physician have I found.
Mrs pain will vanish only when the Beloved (God) Himself becomes the
physician.24

Again we may compare the Song of Songs:

I sought him, but found him not; I called him, but he gave no answer.
The watchmen found me as they went about in the city; they beat me,
they wounded me, they took away my mantle, those watchmen of the
walls.
I adjure you, O daughters of Jerusalem, if you find my Beloved, that
you tell him I am sick with love. (5, 68)

The dual emotive orientation of love-in-separation, the pain and the joy, are
well expressed in Mr Bs next poem:

Not seeing you,


my eyes sting.
Since you left
I have no rest.
132 GREEN

When I hear a sound


my heart trembles
but that in itself
is sweet, lovely25

The Song of Songs:

I slept, but my heart was awake.


Hark! my Beloved is knocking(5, 2)

A number of close parallels of symbolism can be found between Mr Bs


writings and those of St Teresa and St John. Mr B speaks of the inner
fire brought about by the pain of separation from the Deity26 and, like St
Teresa and St John, connects with the experience of this fire, the arrow of
love which pierces the heart:

An arrow from the quiver of love


Has pierced my heart and driven me crazy

Shym shot an arrow


That has pierced me through.
The fire of longing

Is burning my heart
And my whole body is in torment.27

These same forms of expression and symbolism are also used by many other
bhakti mystics.
Turner discusses his theory of liminality with regard to the
bhakti movement of Bengal, citing in this respect the work of Dimock who
in turn offers some illuminating remarks on this movement, which of course
is distinct from the bhakti poets discussed above, but closely related to them.
For the true love is love-in-separation expressed in poetry of
longingwith undertones suggesting the joy of unionLike Christianity
orthodox posits a separation between man and God and
expresess it in love poetry The pain of love-in-separation (viraha) is
a saving grace which fixes the mind on Godman by his nature longs for
union with God, though by the nature of the two actual union is
impossible.28
The Bengal movement base their doctrines on the Bhgavata
which describes the life of in in colourful folkloric
detail and elaborates in particular on his dalliance with the gops.
theory divided women into two classes: svaky or svy (she who is ones
LIVING BETWEEN THE WORLDS 133

own) and paraky (she who is anothers). In the BP the gops come into the
latter category; while being married to other men, so intoxicated are they by
their love for that, setting aside social opinion, they care only for their
tryst with him. This love-in-separation, which Turner calls both divine and
faintly illicit, is contrasted with licit, marital love and, according to
, is the only type that may really be called true love in the
context of the relationship between God and the soul. (It is informative to
reflect here on Mahdevs portrayal of iva as illicit lover and yet also as
true, divine husband, and on her dwelling on the contrasts between human
and divine love.) Marriage, Turner comments, represents in this scheme of
things structure which is the opposite of liminality: personal possession or
ownership of the beloved is antithetical to the liminal state of love-in-
separation.29
Eliade, perhaps thinking along similar lines, considers that the paraky
type of relationship symbolizes the rupture that every genuine religious
experience imposes; by comparison, he says, the conjugal symbolism of
Christian mysticism, in which Christ plays the part of the Bridegroom, does
not sufficiently emphasize such abandonment of all social and moral values
as mystical love implies. I am not at all sure that this is fair on Christian
mystics who, it seems to me, are by no means unaware of the tension
between the implications of their experiences and accepted social norms
and who, even when using the symbolism of the mystical marriage, seem to
be fully aware of the rupture of which Eliade speaks; and yet I think
Eliade is nearer the heart of the matter in his suggestion that the paraky
type of love is pure spontaneity, a love that exemplifies ll.30 The svaky
type of love contains an element of desire for self-satisfaction; only the
paraky type results in a selfless, spontaneous love which is for the sake of
the Beloved alone. Dimock elaborates:

the paraky condition of the gops made their love for Krishna more
pure and real. For svaky leads to kma, to desire for the satisfaction of the
self; only paraky results in the prema, the intense desire for the
satisfaction of the beloved, which is the characteristic, to be emulated by
the bhakta, of the love of the gops. It is because the love of Krishna and the
gops is paraky love that it is so intense. The pain of separation, possible
only in paraky, and the resultant constant dwelling of the minds of the
gops on Krishna, is their salvationTheir viraha, their pain of separation,
draws their interest away from worldly concerns and leads to the meditation
on Krishna which is the essence of bhakti and leads to attainment of him.31

Hence the bhakta may find joy even in the pain of separation if he or she
cares only for the happiness of the Beloved and is able to be indifferent to
contingent pains and pleasures, finding fulfillment in the all-consuming
134 GREEN

love for . The Christian mystics likewise exhort us to cultivate just


these attitudes in our relationship to God.
In both the bhakti poets and the Carmelite mystics we find a tension,
which often makes itself most poignantly felt, between the desire for the
ultimate unitive experience and the desire to continue to experience the
bitter-sweetness of love-in-separation. It has often been said that the
mysticism of love presupposes a degree of duality: that is, that mutual love
between the Deity and the soul cannot be part of an experience where the
mystic has become absolutely one with the Godhead or Absolute. As
Dimock points out:

There could be no such love as this (namely the love between the soul and
God) if lover and beloved were the same. Although the jva is part of the
Bhagavatjva and Bhagavat are not the same. There is a quantitative
difference between the two. The jva shares in the qualities of, yet is
eternally distinct from, both the Bhagavat and other jvasThus, when by
bhakti the jva gains releasehe is near the Bhagavat, in a perpetual
attitude of worship of the Bhagavat; but he is notthe same.32

Dimocks statements would have to be reconsidered and quite possibly


modified if they were to be applied to aiva bhakti which has always tended
more towards a monistic interpretation of the final goal of the mystic while
interestingly still retaining the typically bhaktic attitudes of ecstatic love
and devotion and, indeed, of separation from the Deity in the earlier phases
of experience.
Carman discusses what he calls this paradoxical dialectic of presence
and absence of God in bhakti and outlines the solutions of various Indian
theologians to the epistemological and ontological questions raised by this
typically bhaktic perception of the Divine as omnipresent and yet ever
elusive, one with the devotee and yet separate from him or her; he
concludes that this paradoxical dialectic is one of a number of important
similarities between bhakti and Western theistic mysticism.33
In bhakti, then, we often find a tension between the more traditional
Hindu ideal of liberation from and, on the other hand, a desire to
continue to experience in both the bliss and the agony of love-in-
separation. In contrast to many forms of Hindu mysticism, therefore, the
experience of the joy and pain of the mutual love between the jva and
Bhagavat in a state of duality, rather than liberation from with its
accompanying unitive experience, has often come to be seen as the true
mystical goal; although on other occasions these two goals may be seen as
coexisting. But the fact that the experience of love-in-duality is a very
important aspect of the types of mysticism I have discussed here should
lead us to question (as I have in fact done elsewhere) the theories of earlier
scholars such as Stace who asserts that the essence of all mysticism is the
LIVING BETWEEN THE WORLDS 135

apprehension of undifferentiated unity and who holds that even theistic


mystics actually have this same experience, but interpret it in terms of their
relationship to God; this theistic interpretation is held by Stace to be a
concrete metaphor denoting an abstract state of undifferentiated
awareness.34
Stace therefore implies that theistic mystics misinterpret or
misunderstand their own experiences; his claim that theistic mystics are
really experiencing undifferentiated unity is simply a mirror image of the
more commonly encountered theological claims that monistic mystics are
really experiencing union with God or that they should be experiencing
union with God if their experiences were fully developed (the latter type of
bias is seen, for example, in the works of Zaehner)
As I have argued elsewhere, it seems to me that the most satisfactory
approach to a cross-cultural study of mysticism is one that recognizes the
validity and worth of both monistic and theistic experiences and that sees the
similarities and the points of divergence between the two without
attempting to reduce one of them to the other.36
This is not the place to elaborate on the many differences between
monistic and theistic forms of mysticism, but it may perhaps be added by
way of conclusion that in theistic mysticism this world and the other
world cannot be fully equilibrated or united; whereas in some forms of non-
theistic mysticism, while the dynamic play of polarities may take on an
important role, the opposites (including this world and the other world)
are seen as complementary and indeed as ultimately one. The mystic then
endeavours to realize this oneness within his or her own being. One
essential distinction that must be drawn, then, in conclusion to this paper is
that in theistic mysticism the opposites are antagonistic; in many forms of
non-theistic mysticism they are equilibrating.

NOTES

1 St Teresa of Avila, The Interior Castle, London 1974, p. 125. For this
and other quotations from Teresas writings I have also consulted the
Spanish text in Santa Teresa de Jess: Obras Completas, eds. Efren
de la Madre Dios & Otger Steggink (Biblioteca de Autores
Cristianos), Madrid 1974.
2 Many of these other forms of mysticism are discussed in my doctoral
thesis A Study of Mysticism and its Forms of Expression, Stirling
1983. See also my Unity in Diversity, Scottish Journal of Religious
Studies vol. 3, no. 1 (1982).
3 Cf. Robert M.Gimello, Mysticism and Meditation, in Mysticism and
Philosophical Analysis, ed. Steven T.Katz, London 1978; also
Frederick J.Streng, Language and Mystical Awareness, ibid.
136 GREEN

4 The work by St John often called The Dark Night of the Soul is in the
original Spanish simply the Dark Night. He does not in fact refer to a
dark night of the soul as such, but to the Nights of Sense and Spirit.
The Spanish text of St Johns writings consulted by me can be found
in San Juan de la Cruz, Vida y Obras, eds. Crisogono de Jesus,
Matias del Jesus & Lucinio Ruano (Biblioteca de Autores
Cristianos), Madrid 1973.
5 St Johns own commentary on The Spiritual Canticle in
R.J.H.Steuart, The Mystical Doctrine of Saint John of the Cross,
London 1974, p. 153.
6 Victor W.Turner, The Ritual Process, London 1969, p. 107.
7 The Spiritual Canticle, v. 1, in The Collected Works of St John of
the Cross, tr. Kieran Kavanaugh & Otilio Rodriguez, London 1966.
p. 410.
8 Ibid., vv. 69, Steuart.
9 St Johns commentary, Steuart, p. 149.
10 Ibid., p. 154.
11 The Dark Night, II.vi.6, Kavanaugh & Rodriguez, p. 339.
12 Steuart, p. 116ff.
13 Ibid., p. 120.
14 Further on St John see my St John of the Cross and Mystical
Unknowing, Religious Studies 22 (1986).
15 Life, XXX, in The Complete Works of St Teresa of Jesus, tr. E.
Allison Peers, London 1946, I, pp. 199, 200, 203.
16 Life, in Peers, I, pp. 1923.
17 T pp. 74, 115. Further on St Teresa see my St Teresa of Avila and
Hekhalot Mysticism, Studies in Religion/Sciences Religieuses vol.
13, no. 3 (1984); published also in Spanish as Santa Teresa de Avila
y la Mstica Hekhalot, Homenaje a Luis Morales Oliver (Fundacion
Universitaria ), Madrid 1986.
18 A.K.Ramanujan, Speaking of iva, Harmondsworth 1978, pp. 2935,
51.
19 R.C.Zaehner, Hindu Scriptures, London 1979.
20 Mahdev in T.N.Sreekantaiya, Akka Mahdev in Women Saints of
East and West, London 1972, p. 39.
21 Mahdev in S p. 124. Four parts of the day and night means in
effect the whole of the day and night.
22 , ibid. p. 80; see also Ramanujans note to this poem,
p. 189.
23 Mr B in Lajwanti Madan, Mr B, Women Saints of East and
West, pp. 57. Son of Nanda is the title of .
24 Ibid. pp. 567.
25 Mr B in Songs of , tr. Deben Bhattacharya, New York
1978, p. 136,
LIVING BETWEEN THE WORLDS 137

26 The Devotional Poems of Mrb, tr. A.J.Alston, Delhi 1980, p. 114.


27 Ibid. p. 49 and 97. Shym is a name of .
28 Edward C.Dimock, Jr., Doctrine and Practice among the
of Bengal, Krishna: Myths, Rites and Attitudes, ed. Milton Singer,
Chicago University Press 1966, p. 612.
29 Turner, op cit. p. 1578.
30 Mircea Eliade, Yoga, Immortality and Freedom, Princeton University
Press 1973, p. 265.
31 Dimock, op. cit. pp. 567.
32 Ibid. p. 48.
33 John B.Carman, Conceiving Hindu Bhakti as Theistic Mysticism
in Mysticism and Religious Traditions, ed. Steven T.Katz, Oxford
University Press 1983.
34 W.T.Stace, Mysticism and Philosophy, London 1961.
35 R.C.Zaehner, Mysticism Sacred and Profane, Oxford University
Press 1978.
36 See my Unity in Diversity and also my doctoral thesis.
138
9
YOGA PHILOSOPHY AND JUNG
F.W.J.Humphries

We who have done some study of Yoga at University level will avoid the
vulgar error of regarding Yoga as a sort of glorified physical exercise. We
have learned Sanskrit, we can follow scholastic arguments, we know about
Patajali Yoga, Buddhist Yoga, Jain Yoga and can learnedly explain the
meaning of knowledge, karma, concentration and so on. However, it is
still difficult to take Yoga seriously as a guide to life. After all, it rests on the
unprovable theory of reincarnation and its final aim, which appears to be
the annihilation of the individual personality, is repugnant to our instincts.
So we have every encouragement to treat Yoga as a purely intellectual
constructionbut in that case the rest of our nature will be frustrated. We
can of course get emotional and moral uplift by going to those gurus and
divine incarnations who offer instant enlightenmentbut then we shall
sacrifice our intelligence. So what do we do?
What I do is to invoke the name of Jung to resolve this conflict of
opposites. Jung has many critics, but they give him the credit of having
brought mythology out of the museums and showing how ancient
mythological motifs continue to work in the minds of his modern Western
patients.
A person who visits a psychoanalyst does not go as a student or spiritual
seeker but as a neurotic. He lives in a shamefaced world of sin and
incompetence. To stay where he is is wrong and evil, but if he tries to pull
himself together, as his friends keep telling him, he may make matters
worse. He simply does not know what to do. This uncomfortable, lonely
state is very different from going to a University after doing well at
schoolbut I suggest it is a more promising beginning if we want to make
something out of Yoga.
Sin was a central preoccupation in the old Christian writers, but nowadays
it is regarded as a morbid soul-searching and inverted egoism. People will
tell you that in Hinduism there is no sin, only ignoranceeven though YS
II, 5 plainly says: avidy means taking what is impermanent, impure,
painful and not-self for permanent, pure, happy and self. Even the traditional
Protestant Christian confesses his sin in only a general way: We have done
140 HUMPHRIES

what we ought not to have done and it is left to the psychoanalyst first to
reveal and then to straighten out each individual kink or knot of the heart,
as the KaU puts it. But unless we start by admitting that there is an
evildue partly to personal sin and partly to human weaknessfrom
which we need to be delivered, our intellectual effort to understand Yoga
will be frustrated.
Here is another example where a purely intellectual approach may
mislead us. We are told that subtle discernment is needed to understand the
truth of Vednta, i.e. that brahman is real and the world is an illusion. Now
this statement obviously contradicts experience, but even if it was true one
cannot see why any subtlety would be needed in understanding it, since it is
a very short and simple sentence. The same applies to the exhortation to
practise supreme detachment. Even if this was possible (and it is not, as
points out in the Bhagavad Gt) it would be a very unsubtle procedure,
being merely a mechanical, uniform replacement of action by inaction. As
stated in YS I, 12 detachment must be combined with abhysa, practice or
application, in eliminating the activities of the mind and thus achieving the
objective of Yoga. The Yogi must be detached in one way and passionately
intent in another way. But even this does not answer the really interesting
question which iswhen should the Yogi be detached and when not? This
question is answered, not by reasoning from general principles, but by
responding to each particular case with ones whole naturerational,
aesthetic, moral, conscious, instinctiveunder guidance from a teacher, but
ultimately through self-knowledge alone. Compare the difference between a
doctor and a layman with a medicine-chest. The difficulty is not to get hold
of medicine, but to know when to use it. Theoretical study must be
combined with meticulous observation of each case of illness. Yoga and
Buddhism traditionally compare the doctors art with the way of salvation.
We need, therefore, to bring our whole nature to bear when doing Yoga,
and the thing to be eliminated is not ignorance, but perversion, addiction,
sin. Patajali says that evil is caused by (taints or afflictions) and
shapers or predispositions (we who disbelieve in
reincarnation would call them hereditary) which determine our conduct. It
is only in the highest samdhi that we even become conscious of them, but
in doing so we destroy them, and therefore this samdhi is called nirbja,
seedless, because it burns up the seeds of evil. We may compare the belief
of Socrates that if we fully know what we are doing, we shall choose what
is right. Compare also the method of psychoanalysis, whereby we are
confronted with our ancient fears and repressions in the confidence that if we
face them squarely in daylight, we shall see that they are infantile and reject
them. It is also worth comparing the with Freuds doctrine of
the id, that repository of chaotic instinctive drives which have to be lived
with and controlled if civilization is to survive.
YOGA PHILOSOPHY AND JUNG 141

The id is unconscious and, on the whole, evilcertainly if left to


itselfand in these two respects it is similar to the . In this
paper I have been talking about non-rational obstacles to understanding
Yoga, and it is interesting to digress for a moment on the change in
emotional response to Freud. During this century, he was thought of as a
libertine but is now regarded as an austere old patriarch with a low view of
human nature. Again, his view that there are autonomous unconscious
mental processes was regarded as dangerously mystical (he had to defend
himself against nineteenth-century scientific materialists) whereas nowadays
he seems rather drably mechanistic and reductionist. One person who
helped to bring about this change of opinion was Freuds former disciple
and subsequent opponent, Jung. One of the main points of difference was
Jungs theory of the unconscious, as set out in his book Symbols of
Transformation (191112).
Freud has three layersconscious, that to which I am paying attention
now, preconscious, that which I could attend to if I wanted toe.g. my right
kneecap or my bank balanceand repressed unconscious, that which
conceals some disturbing experience and cannot be known directly although
it continually makes its presence felt indirectly, e.g. in the form of irrational
moods, or lapses of memory. To these Jung adds a fourththe collective
unconscious, the inherited dispositions or patterns of behaviour which have
evolved throughout the history of the human race. The collective
unconscious is incomparably vaster than the personal unconscious and
could never be completely brought to light by analysisfurthermore, it
includes unknown good as well as unknown evil. In language reminiscent
of the Jung declares that the inner world of the Self is as vast as
the outer universe. A Catholic theologian wrote a book God and the
Unconscious as if the two terms were equated. But the unconscious is also
nothing but a pattern of instinctswhat we are when we are being natural.
The child or the primitive in undisturbed surroundings can live naturally in
harmony with his deeper nature. On the other hand Jungs patients, victims
of a changing technological society, are those whose consciousness has
developed disproportionately and become separated from the rest of their
nature. Their lives become dull and mechanical, punctuated by moods and
uncontrollable feelings which may go over the borderline of sanity. Jung
cures them by bringing together the conscious and unconscious halves. He
does so by means of the symbol, a word which has a technical meaning in
Jung, and denotes a figurative representation (story, picture or even dance)
of an unknown truth about ourselves. In addition, the symbol has a
fascinating power which can transform the patient. Jung writes so long and
lovingly about his symbols that one might be excused for thinking that he is
advocating irrationality, but nothe symbol is only a stage in
understanding; as soon as its meaning has been fully grasped, the symbol
becomes dead. Furthermore, consulting of the collective unconscious is not
142 HUMPHRIES

to be recommended for everybody. As Jung writes in his commentary on


The Secret of the Golden Flower, para.16:
It would be a great mistake to suppose that this is the path every neurotic
must travel or that it is the solution at every stage of the neurotic problem.
It is appropriate only in those cases where consciousness has reached an
abnormal degree of development and has diverged too far from the
unconscious. This is the sine qua non of the process. Nothing would be
more wrong than to open this way to neurotics who are ill on account of an
extreme predominance of the unconscious. For the same reason, this way of
development has scarcely any meaning before the middle of life (normally
between the ages of thirty-five and forty), and if entered upon too soon can
be decidedly injurious.
When the message comes through from the unconscious it reverses our
nature and attitudes, but we must retain our former values as well or risk
insanity if we surrender uncritically to the unconscious promptings.
The misconception that Jung worships the unconscious is comparable
with and corrective of the idea that the Yogi is an unswerving devotee of
consciousness. I suppose the popular idea of a Jungian analysis is sitting
comfortably in St Johns Wood, surrounded by Eastern objets dart, talking
to a cultured lady about a stream of significant phantasies. The Yogi on the
other hand is a grim athlete who can concentrate on anything with any
degree of intensity for any length of time. After all, is not consciousness
(caitanya) another name for self? However, non-cognitive
samdhi is valued above cognitive, insight ( praj) is rejected
and the mind itself, after its task has been performed, dissolves into
. Note however that insight can be abandoned only by those who
have attained iti.e. by a small, highly conscious minority of mankind.
One of Jungs most well-known contributions to psychology is the
detailed working-out of the difference between introversion and
extraversion. We have relations with objects (extraversion), but we also
judge and value them (introversion). Both activities are necessary for
life, but every individual is biased toward one or the other and so may be
called an extravert or an introvert. A whole civilization may be similarly
biasedEuropeans are extravert whereas Indians are introvert. This does
not mean that every Indian is a religious ascetic. As the KaU says, God
pierced the sense apertures outwards, and therefore one looks outward and
cannot see inwardit is only the sage seeking immortality who resolutely
turns his gaze in the unnatural, inward direction. Even if this degree of
introspection is rare, it is an accepted, authoritative ideal of behaviour, and
this is what I mean by saying that India is introvert. Conversely we
Westerners are not all extraverts, but we think we ought to be. In the 1960s
when we were friendly towards Russia, it was common to read newspaper
articles beginning: Life is much better in the Soviet Union now. There are
more goods in the shops We were gently patronizing the Russians, those
YOGA PHILOSOPHY AND JUNG 143

Marxist materialists, for not being as thoroughgoing and successful in their


materialism as we were.
But an extravert can never understand what an introvert is up to, and this
is another psychological obstacle to understanding India. The British are
particularly extravertwe do not talk about religion unless we are forced to,
and then we tend to become sentimental. The most authoritative British
accounts of Hinduism were by nineteenth-century Christians who felt in
duty bound to understand the system before condemning it. Monier-
Williams Indian Wisdom is one example and another is A Rational
Refutation of the Hindu Philosophical Systems by F.Hall which appeared in
1861. The book is full of useful quotations, in the original and in a clear
translation, by and other authorities, the style is attractive
and even witty (a great contrast to most books on Indian mysticism), but the
final judgement on Hinduism is completely negative. In our century we had
Keith who is said to have disliked nearly every author he mentions in his
History of Sanskrit Literature and who wrote about Indian philosophy in
terms which made it difficult to understand how anybody could ever believe
in it. These scholars were only following the tradition established by the
English empiricist philosophers Locke, Berkeley and Hume, who
abandoned causality and ended with a universe of separate sense data which
can be compared only with that most extravert of systems, the Indian
Nyya.
In Germany, on the other other, the dominating tendency was introvert.
Right from the beginning, Indian literature was welcomed in Germany by
Goethe, Schlegel and Schopenhauer. Deussen, the greatest Western
exponent of Vednta (and who also produced the best translation of the YS)
was a follower of Kant whom Jung picks out as the type of the introvert
thinker. To this day, if we want to penetrate to the meaning of Hinduism,
we are likely to see through German eyes, and no amount of field-work or
collecting of manuscripts will make up for our incompatibility of
temperament. If you doubt this, consider how you would resent it if your
scholarly work was described as subjectiveand yet the subject of
experience, the self, is what Indian thought is mainly about.
The self, in Jung, includes the ego and consciousness, but it also includes
an unconscious part which will never become fully conscious. The
unconscious part is truly ourselves, but it is potential, unrealized. When it is
made real, it seems to come from within us and turn outside us at the same
time. The unconscious self makes its presence known through symbols,
such as a king or a square or a circle. The symbol may be a complete, finished
geometrical figure, but it denotes a processthe union or integration of
the conscious and unconscious parts of the selfwhich is never complete.
The two future partners are complete oppositesthe vast, chaotic
unconscious containing both good and evil, is to merge with the tiny but
human ego which is ultimately to take control but risks being submerged
144 HUMPHRIES

by its monstrous other half. The process of unification is itself largely


unconsciousit often happens naturally and even the analyst is reduced to
watching it happen. Jung says (in the commentary on The Secret of the
Golden Flower, para 18): Now and then it happened in my practice that a
patient grew beyond himself because of unknown potentialities, and this
became an experience of prime importance to me. In the meantime, I had
learnt that all the greatest and most important problems of life are
fundamentally insolubleThey can never be solved, but only outgrown.
The object of the whole process is individuation whereby the child who
trots along obediently with the herd develops into the adult with his own,
independent standards of behaviour. This sounds like a recipe for anarchy,
but Jung reassures us (Psychological Types, para 758): As the individual is
not just a single, separate being, but by his very existence presupposes a
collective relationship, it follows that the process of individuation must lead
to more intense and broader collective relationship and not to isolation.
The process of individuation, though stormy at times, has a happy ending
or rather we should not say ending, since it is never complete. Jung says
(ibid., para 789): In so far as the total personalitycan be only in part
conscious, the concept of the self is, in part, only potentially empirical and
is to that extent a postulateIt is a transcendental concept.
Between the Jungian self and the of Yoga there are differences,
but not quite those which appear at first sight. Jung devotes much attention
to the unconscious whereas the is pure consciousnessbut as we
have explained, the unconscious has to be assimilated and, in a sense,
controlled by the ego, whereas in the highest stage of realizing the
the mind dissolves into a more drastic procedure than any
contemplated in analytical psychology.
As the Yogi advances his intellect or buddhi becomes serene and
luminous, but even so it is nothing compared with the absolute, immutable
purity of the . What a contrast to the boisterous, chaotic, amoral
unconscious. On occasion, it will smash our notions of good, true, beautiful
and decent. At puberty, for example, we learn that the organ which we hid
in shame and used only for going to the lavatory is also intended for the
expression of love, and this was how our father and mother used it. Even if
we reconcile ourselves to the facts of sexwhat about the earthquakes and
floods, the senseless destruction of whole species? But the tman, too, has
its terrible side, as shown in the KaU (II, 15): He whose food is the
brahmin and and whose condiment is deathwho truly knows where
he is? Through fear of him fire burns, through fear the sun shines (VI, 3).
Mahat vajram udyatama great fear, a raised thunderbolt
(VI, 2).
Many aspects of the unconscious, however, belong to . Here again
we may be misled at first sight. The unconscious contains everything, good
and bad, whereas is only to be suppressed and sloughed offthe
YOGA PHILOSOPHY AND JUNG 145

self should never have got mixed up with it in the first place. But is
for both , action, and , cessation; bhoga, experience, and
apavarga, liberation. We must follow the law of our natureour and
and first experience the world before seeking release from it.
Similarly Jung says that in the first half of life we must go out into the
world and adapt ourselves to society; it is only in the second half that we
are encouraged to come to terms with our deeper self. , like the
unconscious, has the power of serving and as it were educating the
. Its operation is inscrutable and beyond our understanding. Like the farmer
in YS IV, 3 we cannot make the rice grow, we can only water the field and
leave the creative powers of nature to do the rest. in its
primal undifferentiated state (pradhna) is an awesome mystery, described
by Vysa (on YS 11, 19) as unmanifest, beyond existence and non-
existence, outside the world of growth and decay.
Jungs theory of individuation has been criticized as egotistic, but he
replies that the self, when it develops according to its own laws, ends by
being more firmly rooted in society. Similarly the Self of Yoga is
sometimes considered narrow compared with the universal tman-
brahman, and cold compared with a loving relation between soul and God.
The English translation of kaivalya as isolation does nothing to help
matters. But the realized has not defaulted in its obligationsit, or
rather the , are , they have done what needed to be done.
What happens to the after that is unknowable, but there is no
reason to think that it is restricted or deprived.
The self is a transcendental concept. This is admitted even by Jung, the
empirical observer. In Yoga transcendence is pushed so far that one
wonders how the self can have any connection with the world. The self
cannot act and, according to , it cannot even perceiveit only
reflects the state of the buddhi. It also cannot be perceived, and in this
respect it is like the Jungian self. In philosophy, perceptione.g. perceiving
a potis distinguished from apperceptionmy knowledge that I am
perceiving a pot. Normally, apperception would be regarded as evidence of
the self, but this is denied by on YS I, 4. The statement I am
acting, I am happy, etc. qualifies the buddhi, not the . The reason
is that sometimes we are happy and sometimes unhappy whereas the
would have to be always happy since it is changeless. It is interesting that
this same argument is used by Kant in discussing what he calls the
synthetic unity of apperception or the transcendental unity of self-
consciousness. Each representation or field of consciousness must have a
unity which enables me to say I think, since otherwise there would be
something unthinkable or some part of my experience which does not
belong to me. But this unity is a necessary, permanent condition of
experience. It is not the same as what Kant calls empirical or primitive
146 HUMPHRIES

apperceptioni.e. the fact that sometimes I notice that I am thinking


whereas at other times I do not.
Individuation, as defined by Jung, means separation and differentiation
from the general and a building up of the particularnot a particularity that
is sought out, but one that is already ingrained in the psychic constitution
(Psychological Types, p. 449). This has a general resemblance to Patajalis
system in that a predetermined self is purified from foreign influences, but
there are important differences. The self evolves whereas is
changeless (though changelessness is difficult to reconcile with the
educative function of ). Furthermore, the evolved self will be more
firmly rooted in the world, whereas the aim of is release from the
world. Here we have two different orders of ideas. In the psychiatrists
consulting room profound symbols may appearthe world serpent, the
world clock, the subterranean pool into which one must plunge and be
purified. But these symbols only show the waythey are not a substitute for
spiritual regeneration. The patient may not take the plungehe may walk
out of the analysis instead. Even if he stays, his object is to be comfortable,
not to reach a lonely spiritual eminence.
The questionWhat does the self do after being liberated, is it quiet or
continually active?is a metaphysical one, of the kind which the Buddha
deplored. It cannot be answered by experience, but it can be approached by
analogy. When we grow old, we go through the phase of involutionour
organs contract and we lose interest in the world, even if we are healthy. In
India, the traditional time for devoting oneself to spiritual things was after
ones working life had ended. There is an association between self-
realization and death, as when Naciketas is taught by Yama. Furthermore in
Indian mathematics there is no infinity but a largest number
(cf. , section 24 and YS I, 25 where the fact that there is a
limit to omniscience is used by Vysa to prove that an omniscient being
must exist). Since everything has a limit, it would follow that the possible
experience of the is also limited and must come to an end.
On the other hand a Christian would maintain that in heaven there is a
permanent, active, loving relation between God and the community of
saints with their resurrected bodiesan ideal society in which Jungs
perfectly evolved self would naturally fit. Can this be another example of
the difference between introvert and extravert when they look at the same
situation?
Finally we come to a less philosophical and more controversial feature of
Jungs later lifethe synchronicity or mystic correspondence between
inner and outer events, and the ghosts, horoscopes and paranormal
phenomena which have increased his following and turned him from a
doctor intowell, into the wonder-working numinous figure of the kind
which has always been associated with the word Yogi. Does Jung really
YOGA PHILOSOPHY AND JUNG 147

have extra powers, or is it only that people think he has? Instead of leaving
the siddhis in the decent obscurity of the Sanskrit, we are seriously asking
whether they can occur in modern Europe. Once again, Jung has brought
mythology out of the museums.
148
10
THREE CONTEMPORARY INDIAN
MYSTICS: NANDAMAY,
KRISHNABAI AND RAJNEESH
John E.Mitchiner

INTRODUCTION
In this paper I shall attempt to give a general and reasonably representative
view of the several paths followed by contemporary Indian mystics. Any
selection of a single or a few present-day mystical thinkers of India will
inevitably contain a considerable degree of subjective preference: and the
present selection is no exception. My choice of these three individuals rests
partly with the fact that they each exemplify a different mystical path:
nandamay is predominantly an Advaitin, who emphasizes above all the
pursuit of jna or spiritual knowledge for the realization of brahman;
Krishnabai tends more towards the pursuit of bhakti or loving devotion,
directed in her case towards her guru Rmds as the personification of
brahman; while Rajneesh adopts a highly syncretic approachrelying
strongly upon active forms of meditationwhich does not easily fit into
any one of the traditional categories of Indian mysticism. My choice was
also influenced by my having met each of these individuals, and having
been able to hear and observe them at first hand: primarily between April
and July 1978, and in the case of Rajneesh on several further occasions.
If it be accepted that mysticism centres primarily upon experienceand
that the words in which the experiencer expresses that experience are
secondary to the experience itselfit then becomes significant to learn not
just what the experiencer says about his experience, but also how he says it,
and how differently he expresses it to different audiences or on different
occasions. Useful insights in this connection can therefore be gained by
studying not just the written teachings but also the sayings and activities of
mystics at first hand. In this paper I shall give, firstly, an outline account of
the lives as well as the teachings of these three individualswhich will it is
hoped be in any case of interest to those who may be unacquainted with any
of thembefore discussing certain more general points raised by this
account.
150 MITCHINER

Finally by way of introductory remarks, I must briefly explain my use of


the term mystic in this paper. Rather than enter upon a detailed discussion
of objective criteria (if such exist) which might validate the claim to be a
mystic, I shall here accept the claims of these three individuals to have
experiencedor to live in awareness ofsome form of union or identity
with what they see as being the One ultimate reality of existence, whether
this be called God, brahman, or whatever. I shall accordingly not
be concerned to attempt any evaluation of such claims, but simply to
describe the teachings and experiences of these individuals, wherever
possible in their own words.

NANDAMAY
nandamay Mthe Blissful Motherwas born on 30 April 1896 in the
small village of Kheora in what is now the Tripura district of Bangladesh. She
was the second of eight children: and was given the name Nirmal Sundar
. Her parents were devout brahmins and strict
followers of caste regulations. They were also poor, since her father had no
regular employment, and for that reason the only formal education which
Nirmal received amounted to less than two years in the local primary
schoolto the present day she writes little and never sees fit to read books.
On the other hand she was greatly influenced and affected as a child
by the music of krtana and by japa or the chanting of the names of God
whichas she later claimedused to induce trances and visions. In 1909,
just before her thirteenth birthday, Nirmal was married to Mohan
Chakravrtlater called Bholnthwho came from the district of Dacca:
But for the first five years of their marriage her husband travelled
throughout Bangladesh in search of work, while Nirmal lived with her
husbands sister-in-law Pramod Dev. Even after she finally went to live
with her husband in 1914, the marriage was never physically consumated,
right up to her husbands death in 1936.
From 1914 onwardsand especially after 1918Nirmal devoted
herself increasingly to sdhan or spiritual disciplines of various sorts
which included fasting and a three-year silence; there was no sudden event
or single occurrence which marked a turning-point in her spiritual career,
but merely a steady development from her childhood onwards. Her husband
was understandably at first somewhat alarmed by her increasing
concentration on spiritual pursuits, and being at one stage convinced that
she must be mentally unbalanced, he summoned first exorcists and then a
doctor. But when both were unable to treat her and instead assured him that
she was not mad but God-intoxicated, he acquiesced and let matters take
their courseand in time became one of her chief disciples. Eventually, in
1922 at the age of 26, Nirmal initiated herselfproclaiming that guru,
and mantra (teacher-initiator, pupil-initiated, and sacred words of initiation)
THREE CONTEMPORARY INDIAN MYSTICS 151

were to her one and the same; and a few months later she also initiated her
husband Bolnth. Two years later they moved to Dacca, and as news about
Nirmal spread, disciples began to gather and sit at her feet and to attend
her regular performance of krtana and pj. From 1926 onwards,
nandamay started to travel, first in Bengal and then throughout northern
India: in 1932 she abandoned Dacca as her home, and ever since then she
has led a life of travel and wandering, stopping only a few days or at most a
few weeks in any one place before moving on again as the mood takes her.
She maintains this wandering life to the present day, despite now suffering
somewhat from ill-health. Her movements are quite unpredictable, and even
her closest disciples can never know at which of her many ashrams she is to
be foundwhether at the main one at the Asi Ghat in Banaras or at such
others as those in Vrindavan, Hardwar and Dehra Dun.
As her name indicates, nandamay is considered by her followers to be
an embodiment of blissa bliss which springs from her union with
brahman and which is undisturbed by any physical or mental discomfort,
which she regards as ll or passing phases in the divine play of life, The twin
themes of lla and my play an important part in her outlook and
teachings: the changing physical world, with all its events and phenomena,
is relatively unreal and false in the sense of being a changing mask which
hides the underlying unitary reality or Oneness of existence. It is at the
same time the manifestation and play of the Divine, where the Divine hides
itself under a veil of change in order that it can again seek and find itself as
the changeless. In her teachingwhich is always verbal or practical and
never written and related to particular needs of particular individualsshe
lays greatest emphasis not only on correct knowledge but also on the
performance of sdhan of various formsespecially on japa or repetition
of the names of God, and on krtana or singing the praises of God: these
being in her view the most effective ways by which the Divine in man can
realize its true nature as the Divine as well as being the two forms of
sdhan which she herself pursued most vigorously. Mans goal, in her
view, is the realization of brahmanor rather the realization of himself as
brahman: there exists no ultimate difference between God and man, only
apparent differences which man in his ignorance believes to be realall
divine qualities already exist in man and he has only to dispel his own
ignorance and illusion in order to realize his true nature as brahman. This
realization does not, therefore, entail the transformation of the human into
the Divine since the human has in essence been the Divine all along and
does not change: divinity lies hidden in man by the veil of ignorance
which, when drawn, enables man to realize his identity with and as the
Divinejust as the waves of the sea are essentially identical with it, rising
from it and going back to it. As she said to Yognanda
when he visited her in Calcutta in 1936:
152 MITCHINER

Before I came on this earth, Father, I was the same. As a little girl, I
was the same. I grew into womanhood, but still I was the sameever
afterwards, though the dance of creation changes around me in the hall of
eternity, I shall be the same.1
nandamays vision of mans ultimate goal is thoroughly non-dualistic:
man is God, and there is no essential distinction or separation between them:
All is THAT, and where THAT is, there is no contradiction. The false as
such must vanish. How can one speak of advaita and include individuals,
the world?Where exclusively Oneness is, how can there be room left for
two?Just consider: the Infinite is contained in the finite, and the finite in
the Infinite: the Whole in the part and the part in the WholeHe who
attains and that which is attained are one and the sameThe One who is
Eternal, the tman, He Himself is the traveller on the path of immortality. He
is all in all, He alone is.2
Everything beyond this statement is merely elaboration and commentary: it
is the One who in ll multiplies Himself and, as it were, plays hide-and-
seek with Himself through the veil of myand it is mans task to raise
this veil of my and thereby find his true self as the One.
nandamay is a firm believer in karma and in the power of destiny. She
is also in several respects a traditionalist when it comes to matters of
religious practice. She gives qualified approval to the practice of saf or the
self-immolation of widows on the part of a widow who is completely
steadfast in mind and body; and she encourages the performance of daily
pj as being of great help for a sdhaka. She lays little stress on the
performance of good deeds or on giving physical and material aid or service
to others: emphasizing instead the need to destroy the ego as the root cause
of all suffering, and teaching that physical suffering and poverty can be aids
for purifying the self and realizing the One. She advocates brahmacarya or
sexual continence for the young as a cure for what she sees as the normal
and spiritual decay of the present age; she strongly sanctions arranged
marriages and family life, but only for those who feel irresistibly compelled
to that pathand even then she advocates the renunciation of sexual
activity as early as possible, holding up as her ideal the lives of the Rishis
in withdrawing from worldly activity and devoting themselves entirely to a
life of renunciation, asceticism and spiritual practice. All foreigners at her
Ashrams are treated as casteless and must eat and sleep separately from
those in the Ashrams for fear of ritual contaminationa restriction which
applies even to the Austrian-born devotee tmnanda who has now been
with nandamay for forty-four years. When questioned about it
nandamay related that she herselfby behaving unconventionally during
her own sdhanhad thereby alienated many orthodox Hindus: and so
now, while she personally treats everyone alike irrespective of caste
differences, she none the less abides by caste regulations in order not to
alienate her orthodox devotees who are still living on a level of
THREE CONTEMPORARY INDIAN MYSTICS 153

consciousness where they have not yet transcended caste feelings. One may
subjectively question the satisfactoriness of this reply: what is undeniable is
that many in the close circle of nandamays devotees are clearly
considered to beand in some cases too clearly regard themselves as
beingin a uniquely privileged position, despite her attempts to inculcate
humility and the destruction of ego; while nandamay herself has enjoyed
and continues to enjoy the patronage and respect of many high-caste and
socially prominent individualsnot least that of Kamala and Jawaharlal
Nehru, and of Indira Gandhi.
In the case of nandamay we can perhaps see the applicability of
Agehanada Bharatis contention that mystical experience does not
necessarily change the personality and behaviour of the mystic.3
nandamay claims to have hadand to live in awareness ofa mystical
experience of the essential unity and oneness of all existence: she tries to
encourage others to realize and experience this awareness, seeking to share
it not just through verbal teachings but also through silencewhich she
deems the most effective expression of her experience, as a result of which
her daily hour-long darans are frequently totally silent events. On the
other hand she still accepts and retains the basic ritual and social values
which were taught to her as a child by her Brahmin parents: these, for her, are
but manifestations of the ll, and of the veil of my, which man must
penetrate in order to perceive the Truth of himselfthey are secondary to
the mystical experience itself, and so it is of little ultimate importance
whether one rejects or accepts them. The fact that nandamay accepts them
tells us more about the psychology and social background of Nirmal
Sundar than about the mystical experience of nandamay: yet by
accepting them and encouraging their pursuit, one may say that nandamay
is implicitly tending to say that in order to gain the experience one must
follow the path of Nirmal Sundar. It is true that she does admit to there
being many paths which lead to the same goal, and that it matters little
whether one calls the One God, Krishna, Christ, brahman or whatever. Yet
she does not claim to teach all of these paths: and if one follows the point to
its logical conclusion, nandamay is essentially teaching a path not for
mankind but for those who would mould themselvesor who are already
mouldedin the stamp of Nirmal Sundar, and who are most attuned to
attain mystical experience through following the path already trodden by
nandamay herself.
The point may be self-evident but is, I think, none the less worth stating
here: namely that the mystical teacher, at least in nandamays case, is
limited in his outlook and teaching by the nature of the path which he
himself has followed in order to gain his experience. I shall again be
referring to this point at a later stage in the paper.
154 MITCHINER

KRISHNABAI
The life of nandamay is in many respects similar to that of Krishnabai,
the mystic to whom I turn next. Mtj Krishnabai was born on 20
September 1903 in the village of Haliyal near Hubli in Karnataka, the
second of six children. Her father died when she was eight years old,
leaving the family in abject poverty: Krishnabai received schooling only
from the ages of four to eight and thereafter devoted herself to helping her
mother with household work. At the age of twelve she was married to
Rao, whose father was a moderately wealthy schoolmaster and
whose mother was an avid devotee of numerous deities and Svamis: and the
next few years of Krishnabais married lifewhich were spent largely in
Bombaywere by all accounts a happy period which saw the births of two
children, Ganesh and Nryan, in her sixteenth and eighteenth years.
During this period her childhood religious devotion increased and when she
was eighteen she was initiated by the teacher Tammanna Shstri
of Hubli. When she was pregnant for the third time in 1923, she went to
visit her own family, promising to return to her husband in Bombay within
a month. But she postponed her return, and meanwhile her husband died
after a brief illness. Krishnabai was distraught with grief, not only at his
death, but also for not having been at his side when he died. She sought a
premature delivery of her child, which died within a month of its birth, and
thereafter she became increasingly detached from her relatives and from life
around her.
On the anniversary of her husbands death she resolved to put an end to
her own life and took a massive overdose of opium. She was only just saved
from death by the speedy actions of her brother-in-law. Krishnabais suicide
attempt formed, as it were, the turning-point in her life: from then onwards
she devoted herself increasingly to religious pursuits, particularly to the
chanting of mantras which she would repeat many thousands of times
daily; and her devotions were particularly encouraged by her mother-in-law
Anasykka who persuaded and accompanied her to meet a number of
religious teachers. Krishnabai was further initiated by the aiva r
Siddhruddha Svami at Hubli and then by the r Chandekar
Mahrj at Nevas. Yet neither fully satisfied her needs and she came
increasingly to believe that all gurus, and all verbal mantras, were
essentially one and the same irrespective of overt sectarian differences and
that they were merely different manifestations and play of a single true
reality. In 1928, at the age of twenty-five, she visited the Ashram of Svami
Rmds near Kasaragod in northern Kerala. Here her search ended and
after one year spent in the company of Rmds he initiated her, giving her
the Rm mantra: om r Rm jai Rm jai jai Rm; and
instructing her to look upon all beings and creatures in the
worldincluding her own relativesas manifestations of Rm. Krishnabai
was by this time deeply devoted to Rmds as her guru, and now an
THREE CONTEMPORARY INDIAN MYSTICS 155

interesting development occurred: she found that whenever she thought of


God as Rm, she felt that He was far away from her. But whenever she
thought of God as Rmds, she felt His nearness; and after some time she
came to look upon everyone and everything as none other than Rmds
himself whom she affectionately called Papa or father. In this way, within
three years of her first meeting with Rmds, Krishnabai attained the
realization, as she later expressed it, of oneness with her Papa and with the
unitary transcendent truth underlying the universe. From that time onwards
she remained with Rmds until his death in 1963, helping with the setting
up and running of nanda Ashram at Kanhangad in northern Kerala,
notably through the establishment of a school, a hospital and services for
the poor; and above all propounding the goal of God-realization by the path
of devotion and by practising universal love and service.
Unlike the case of nandamay, who has a large and influential following
and on whom there is a growing bibliography,4 little has been written about
Krishnabai. Her devotees come mainly from southern India, although there
is also a small following of devotees from outside India; she does not travel
a great deal or go out of her way to proselytize followers. Krishnabai has,
however, dictated an autobiography in her native Konkani which was
rendered into Kannada and then translated into English by Rmds just
before his death.5 It is a somewhat unusual autobiography set out rather in
the style of the Confessions of St Augustine: it is addressed entirely to her
Papa Rmds, and all the characters of her past life who appear in it are
considered as merely manifestations of Papa as the supreme and universal
Spirit, the changeless and infinite Soul of all. Her approach is
predominantly devotional throughoutas for example when she talks about
the path which brought her to her ultimate realization:
O infinite Papa! Verily, I am your own embodimentO all-pervading
Papa! In 1928 you awakened in me a strong urge to become one with your
eternal being, and I came to youO Papa, the Divine Mother! The moment
I saw you, my heart was flooded with joy. The rare delight I then enjoyed was
similar to that of a child when it meets its mother after a long separation.
Papa, you are indeed compassion personified. Within only three years of
this childs entry into your divine presence you enabled her to realize your
static, changeless and infinite Being. Just as the feeling of I-ness in me
pervades all parts of my physical being from head to foot, and yet this I is
distinct from the body, so also I came to know that I am at once the
universal consciousness and the transcendent truth.6
There is thus a very personal element in Krishnabais outlook, even though
it is otherwise closely similar in many further respects to that of
nandamay. The Supreme is manifested in creation as her Papa Rmds
who is at once her guru and the supreme transcendent Creator and Sustainer
of the universe; her past life is seen as the play of her Papas ll, drawing
her ever closer to himself and to the truth of herself which is himself, and
156 MITCHINER

while she experiences herself to be the entire universe while also


transcending it, she none the less maintains an attitude of awed respect and
loving worship towards her infinite Papathe One who pervades and
transcends all creation, her own origin, nature and goal:
O compassionate Papa! In the worlds you reside in entirety in all beings
even in the smallest particle. Likewise you dwell in me in all your
perfection. Now grant me power to describe your magnificent glory
manifest in me.7
Her Papa thus dwells within her, just as he also manifests himself outside
her in her parents, her children, in all that she sees and does. And she is at
the same time one with him which is her way of expressing the goal of God-
realization. Papa is for her the symbol of God or brahman. Yet Krishnabais
vision is one not merely of identity and unity with her Papa, but also of
wonderment and loving subservience; she is one who has gained her
realization of Oneness primarily, as she expresses it, through the grace of
her guru; one who, while sharing in his Being and Essence, can yet offer
praise and homage to his universal compassion and transcendence.

RAJNEESH
Turning now to the third of these mystics, Rajneesh is probably the most
enigmatic, and certainly the most controversial and self-contradictory, of
the three; yet he is also in many ways the most stimulating and the most
forceful one in terms of personality and persuasiveness.
Rajneesh Chandra Mohan was born at Kucchwada in Madhya Pradesh on
11 December 1931. His father, struggling to maintain a dwindling family
business, moved the family around various parts during the boys childhood;
Rajneesh attended school in Gardarwara from 1944 to 1951, then graduated
in Philosophy from Jabalpur University in 1955, and gained a Masters
degree from Sagar University in 1957. He reputedly became enlightened in
1953 at the age of twenty-one, and during the subsequent period, in addition
to his academic studies, he also took a job for one year as Assistant Editor of
the Navabhrat, a local newspaper, besides developing a reputation as a
voracious reader and a powerful debater. From 1957 to 1966 he taught
Philosophy at the Sanskrit College in Raipur, Madhya Pradesh, and still
found time to travel to various parts of India delivering lectures and gaining
followers for his views. His teachings became increasingly pragmatic and
experientially-based, and in 1966 he left the academic sphere to found an
Ashram and to devote himself to teaching and to devising a variety of
meditational practices which he propounded since 1974 till 1981 from his
Ashram in Poona.8
It is difficult either to categorize or give any brief outline of Rajneeshs
teachings. It is also somewhat unnecessary to do so, for he made it clear
that he was generally expounding what he saw as the single mystical truth
THREE CONTEMPORARY INDIAN MYSTICS 157

realized by his predecessorsbe they Lao Tzu, Confucius, the Buddha,


Jesus or . His uniqueness lies not so much in what he taught, but
rather in the way he expounded, and in the synthesis he attempted to bring
to diverse teachings. He did not concentrate, like nandamay, on teaching
a single path, but he claimed to be able to guide people on all paths to the
underlying unity towards which all paths lead. Thus each month he
discoursed on different paths, switching from the Sfs of Islm to Zen
Buddhism, from teachings of Pythagoras and Jesus to Hindu Tantra, each
time proclaiming the virtues of the path which he was just expounding. He
emphasized throughout the need to go beyond all teachings, including his
own words, in order to perceive and be aware of the true reality of oneself.
Such an awareness is by definition not something that can be taught, but
something which must arise from within oneself; and since the mental and
psychic pattern of each individual is different, so each must accordingly
follow a different path in order to achieve this self-awareness, this liberation
and awakening to the reality of life. The central feature of the Rajneesh
phenomenon was thus not so much the teachings as the man himself who
emphasized that what he was saying was not as important as the experience
behind the words which he was using:

I am not saying any new thing every day. The truth is very simple and it can
be said in a few lines. But if you dont hear it, I have to tell it again and
again. I go on talking to you so that one day I will be able to persuade you
to listen to the silence that has happened to me. And those who have started
understanding me, they are no more listening to my wordsthey are
listening to my presence.9

Rajneesh appeared to be unconcerned with organized or institutionalized


religion of any sort. His main concern was not to put forward a set of
teachings or to preach a particular path to be followed; it was rather to
destroy all dogmatic teachings and to induce others to realize themselves
through experience of the present moment of reality. For this reason, far
from being concerned about any seeming contradictions in the various
teachings which he put forward, he actively sought to retain such
contradictions:

I am not giving you dogmas. I give you only momentary flowers:


whatsoever I say at the moment belongs to the moment. If I was creating a
dogma here, then I would never contradict myself. You would be happy
with that, because you would have something to cling to. My effort is not to
impart knowledge to you: my effort is to awaken you. I cant allow you to
cling to any statementhence I contradict.10
158 MITCHINER

His point being that while many teachers have expressed the reality of their
experience in different ways, no experience can be realized or assessed
through relying on their words and expressions, but only by experiencing for
oneself.
Although Rajneesh did not teach any particular single path for his
followers to pursue, he did devise a number of meditational practices,
involving especially group-psychotherapy and free sexual self-expression
but not the use of drugs to which he is opposed,11 the underlying aim being
to break down the narrow barriers of selfhood and to make the individual
more aware and perceptive of both himself and others. There are numerous
dynamic meditations and Sf dances where the participants may sing,
dance, shake, scream, whirl, or do whatever comes naturally; the main aims
being to release pent-up tensions, to lose awareness of the self through
movement and thereby to penetrate to the stillness deep within oneself.
There are meditations involving humming, and concentrating the attention
on flashing psychedelic lights; there are more traditional meditations such
as vipassan; and a large number of therapy groups which range from
massage and hypnotherapy to encounterthe latter being a week-long
group activity designed to explore the personality, to release subconscious
fears and repressions which may be brought to light by other members of
the group, and thence to drop all masks and defences, leaving behind the
narrow consciousness of selfhood and growing into an awareness of the
shared life-force of the present moment. Much of the intention underlying
these meditations is to free oneself of the past and future: to concentrate on
the reality of the present instant of experience and thence, by coming fully
to terms with oneself, to go beyond ones self. The growth of love, and of
loving attitude towards others, is consequently of central importance to
many of these practices, and physical or sexual expression of this love is
not only encouraged but frequently insisted upon within the meditational
groups. In many respects, Rajneeshs overall emphasis is on a religion of
love and compassionlove in the sense of dying to the ego in order to
share the greater Reality beyond selfhood:
Love is a deep communion of two beings who are ready to be together this
moment, not tomorrow: who are ready to forget all past and future. Love is
a forgetfulness of the past and future and a remembrance of this moment, this
throbbing moment, this alive moment. Love is the truth of the moment.12
Yet Rajneesh also emphasizes that love itself is not the goal, but merely a
stage which must itself be ultimately superseded in order to reach the goal;
like all of his meditations, love is a game to be played but not taken too
seriously. He adopts a similar attitude towards life in general, and towards
money in particular, seeing these, as one might say, as a form of my
without any lasting value. Yet his attitude is one of acceptance, rather than
of rejection: all is a game, of little ultimate importance, so why not play the
THREE CONTEMPORARY INDIAN MYSTICS 159

gameif you have money, enjoy it; if you do not have money, laugh and
still enjoy it.
There are a number of prominent contradictions and inconsistencies about
Rajneesh which particularly strike the observer. He claimed on the one hand
to be no more than a guide, pointing the way to the goal and helping others
to select the path which is most appropriate for them to follow. Yet he also
adopted the traditional Hindu role of the guru as God, as the incarnation of
the goal, who is consequently himself worthy of worship. He proclaimed
that one must die to oneself, thereby growing into the divine; yet he also
encouraged his followers to lose themselves in him and to merge in loving
union with himan idea which bears close similarity to the Sf concept of
fan or self-obliteration in the teacher. He claimed that he possessed no
self or ego, that what was called Rajneesh was but a shell encasing an
embodiment of Reality or God. Yet surrounding him was a high-powered
personality cult wherein all his followers who had accepted or
renunciant initiation were obliged to carry a prominently displayed
photograph of himself. He claimed to be a master who was unaffected by
his physical surroundings. Yet in order to gain admission to his discourses,
let alone to a personal audience, it was necessary (in addition to paying a
handsome fee) to pass the test of the sniffers who turned away anyone
with the slightest scent or smell. He proclaimed that all religions were
ultimately the same and that one might as well follow one as another. Yet
he insisted that his followers should adopt a new (usually Sanskrit) name,
together with orange clothes and ml or beadsthe traditional garb of
Hindu ascetics. He emphasized the need to replace knowledge by personal
experience, yet he established his own University where it was possible to
take a PhD in such diverse subjects as meditation, acupuncture and
commune management. At times he treated all of these teachings and
practices as but another type of game, not to be taken to heart. Yet it does
make one question whether there was not still some very powerful element
of ego involved somewhere in the Rajneesh phenomenon.
What Rajneesh said over the years is voluminous and was sold in very
expensive bookswhich one may see as a further illustration of his point
about playing with money. His was basically a call for a revolution in oneself
and in ones way of life, a call to love and to find Reality or God not by
rejecting life but by penetrating to its depth:
I have given you to live in the world as totally as possible. Just by
living totally in the world you will transcend it. Suddenly you will come to
know that you are in the world but not of it. The old said: escape,
renounce. But I tell you that those who escape are not total, not wholeit is
not for you. You must live life in its totality, live it as wholly as possible.13
This was also a call to reject dogma, ritual and tradition. Rajneesh was, not
surprisingly, strongly opposed by traditionally-minded Hindus as well as by
the Indian political establishment in the form of State and Central
160 MITCHINER

Governments who resisted his applications to set up a further Ashram,


whereupon he started to make strong criticisms of Indian politicians in
general, and of Morarji Desai, the Prime Minister, in particular.14
Rajneesh often seemed to be casting himself in the role of a prophet
crying in the wilderness, proclaiming himself as another Christ or Buddha
and preaching the path of destruction of the ego and of mans realization
and enjoyment of his own divinity. If one searches through Rajneeshs
sayings trying to find a definition of mystical experience or of the nature of
ultimate reality, little is forthcoming, for he is somewhat Buddhistic on this
point. He usually showed concern to set people on the path, to take them to
the cliffs edge, but it was for each individual to take the plunge into the
unknown, to discover himself and his true identity and to express this
discovery in his own way. Rajneesh affirms in a general sense that Reality
is One, unitary, non-dual. Yet beyond such generalized affirmations he left
it for each individual to experience whatever he finds through self-
surrender and destruction of the ego, through falling into an abyss of
nothingness. Above all he emphasized that he did not seek to communicate
through words, but through a shared experience which allows the Divine to
take the place of the human:
What I am trying to say to you is a kind of music that I have heard. It has
not yet been heard verbally. It is in the sound of the running water. It is in
the wind passing through the pine trees. It is in the songs of the birds. It is
in the silence of darkness. It is in the dancing rays of the sun. It is all over
the place! But it is music. And unless you are capable of understanding this
music, you will not be able to understand meWhen words start
disappearing, something far deeper, more powerful, takes place
communion: the meeting of the master and the disciple, not as two minds
but as two presences, merging into each other, melting into each other,
being lost in each other.15Dont come here to be supported in your ego
and your expectations. Come here to die! If you love me, I am going to kill
you. And when you are killed, one day you will have the opportunity to kill
me. And that day is the greatest day: when the master and disciple are both
killed. Then only that which is, is left. God is in the master, God is in the
disciple. When the disciple and the master both have disappeared, only God
is left16

DISCUSSION
Having looked at certain aspects of the teachings and personalities of these
three mystics, I shall now seek to isolate and highlight those points on
which all three are agreed, and consider the question of where experience
ends and interpretation begins.
In the first place, I would select three basic statements about the nature of
mystical experience which are agreed upon by all three of them:
THREE CONTEMPORARY INDIAN MYSTICS 161

1. that the ultimate reality of existence is Onewhether it be called the


cosmic absolute, God, , brahman or whatever; and that all that
exists apart from this One is secondary to it;
2. that mans individualistic self, his ego, is of no real or lasting value and
must be destroyed and overcome in order for man to realize his true
reality and identity;
3. that mans true reality and identity is identical with the One ultimate
reality of existence which is in some sense already present within him
even before he realizes it.

Our three mystics clearly differ slightly on the question of the precise
nature of this identity and still more on the question of the way in
which mans ego is to be destroyed. How, then, should we satisfactorily
harmonize or account for these differencesand do they in any sense
influence the nature or validity of the experience itself?
In talking of the nature of mystical identity expressed by these mystics,
we are again considering essentially R.C.Zaehners supposed distinction
between monistic and theistic approaches17here typified respectively by,
on the one hand, nandamays and Rajneeshs total identity versus, on the
other hand, Krishnabais bhakti approach envisioning her Papa as the reality
within her which she can yet praise and wonder at. Are, then, these
approaches distinct and mutally opposed or is the latter approach, in
Ninian Smarts terminology,18 a high auto-interpretation read into, as it
were, the experience itself?
Smarts basic contention is that phenomenologically mysticism is
everywhere the same; different flavours, however, accrue to the experiences
of mystics because of their ways of life and modes of auto-interpretation.19
Reading between the lines, what Smart seems in effect to be saying is that
all mysticism is basically monistic, but is theistically interpreted by some
due to their background or dogmatic presuppositions. According to this line
of thought, therefore, we must say that the unitary monistic vision of
nandamay and Rajneesh is somehow closer to the truth than Krishnabais
bhakti approach, and closer also than all experiences expressed in theistic
terms. I am somewhat inclined to agree with Smart on this point for the
following reason: the bhakti approach necessitates an emotional response
and attitude, which is at root an individually motivated response to a given
situation that requires by definition the presence of some form of individual
identity or ego; yet this is precisely what must be eradicated by the mystic
in order to realize the fullness of his quest. We must, however, at the same
time ask whether this attitude of wonderment and praise is itself an integral
part of the experience, or a subsequent interpretation on the part of the
experiencer; and I am inclined to suspect that the latter is most probably the
case with Krishnabai who in places speaks of her experience in terms of
total identity with her Papajust as it is also the case with certain Christian
162 MITCHINER

and Sf mystics. With the latter we can, for example, point out many
instances wherein total unity and identity between man and God is spoken
of, while apologists such as Ruysbroeck and al-Ghazl argue hetero-
interpretativelyin line with their dogmatic presuppositionsthat such
experiences of seeming unity with God are to be interpreted along the lines
of only an apparent and non-absolute unity like that experienced between
lovers in a state of drunkenness.20 I would not go so far as Smart in drawing
a clear distinction between mysticism and bhakti religion but would tend to
suggest that the bhakti approach is in some measure an emotional,
and consequently an individual and non-absolute, response to
mystical experience. I would here agree more with Rajneesh, who while
laying very strong emphasis on the path of love as a means for the
dissolution of the ego, none the less also emphasizes that ultimately love
itself must be superseded by something higher. The path of love can bring
one close to the goal, but one must ultimately go beyond even that, and so
the bhakti approach can lead one to the heights, yet its inherent element of
emotionalism must be surpassed in order to attain the supreme identity.
I now turn to the question of the precise way in which mans ego is to be
destroyed in order to realize the mystical goal. As I have attempted to
indicate particularly in the case of nandamay, the path adopted and
taught by her is essentially that which she herself had earlier followed,
dependent largely on her own upbringing and psychology. And I would
suggest that much the same is also the case with both Krishnabai and
Rajneesh, namely that the particular paths and practices which they
advocate for their followers are based in large measure on those practices
followed by and suited to themselves. All three mystics affirm that the
paths do not lead automatically to the experience itself: and this in a sense
confirms Smarts contention that the mystics doctrine, as also his practices
and methods, are determined at least partly by factors other than the
mystical experience itself. Indeed, Rajneesh repeatedly proclaimed that he
taught no doctrines or dogmas and that his aim was to denounce and go
beyond all static doctrines to experiential knowledge. If we accept that, by
definition, Rajneesh, as one claiming to have experience of union or
identity with the One ultimate reality of existence, is a mystic, we may
accordingly accept Smarts point that doctrine is extrinsic and non-essential
to the mystical experience itself. The different individual practices and
beliefs of these three mystics need not, therefore, deter us from believing
that their experiences are not for that reason of the same order.
I would like to raise Agehananda Bharatis contention that mysticism has
no connection with morality and that mystical experience in no way alters
the personality or behaviour of the mystic.21 This contention is, to my
mind, untenable. It may well be the case with isolated mystical experiences
where the experiencer does not encourage or desire a repetition of the
experience or where he is content to treat the experience as an interesting
THREE CONTEMPORARY INDIAN MYSTICS 163

and enjoyable but not exceptionally significant part of his total human
experience. Yet by all accounts mystical experience involves a sense of the
loss of selfhood and of the merging of oneself with some greater reality.
Also, if any seriousness or value is attached to the experience, it follows that
the mystic will thereafter strive for a greater loss of his own sense of
selfhoodas is the central concern of these three Indian mystics, and
indeed of mystics in all major traditions.
The mystic will consequently strive to adopt an attitude throughout his
everyday life in which his sense of selfhood and his egotistic or self-seeking
tendencies are reduced to a minimum and ultimately destroyed. And this
attitude will inevitably be reflected in his behaviour and will indeed
influence the form of behaviour adopted. Clearly, if a mystic was already
striving to destroy his ego before his experience, his behaviour after that
experience will not show any marked change, merely an intensification of
the previous pattern, as would seem to be the case with nandamay in
particular. A blatant egotist, on the other hand, can only remain an egotist
after a mystical experience if he rejects the central import of his experience
and refuses to take it seriously. But if he seriously accepts its basic
implications, he will thereafter strive to curb his egotistic tendencies. It is
perhaps the twin factors of the unitive experience itself plus also the
attempt to mould oneself upon the basic dicta of that experience which
constitutes a mystic and it is questionable whether one who undergoes a
mystical experience, yet remains unconcerned to give serious consideration
to its basic unitive implication, should properly be called a mystic. This does
not, of course, deny that mystical or unitive experiences may be enjoyed by
a large number of people; but it does imply that the mystic is one who
seriously accepts the implications of that experience as influencing his
entire outlook and way of lifeas has certainly been the case with the three
mystics at present under discussion.
I would simply add by way of conclusion that the three contemporary
Indian mystics I have been considering in this paper, with their diverse
approaches and outlooks, are indicative of the fact that the serious pursuit
of mysticism in both traditional and novel forms remains a living and
potent factor in present-day India: one which ultimately derives its strength
not from any dogmatic or institutional basis, butas alwaysfrom
first-hand living experience.

NOTES

1 Yognanda, Autobiography of a Yogi, New York


1946, pp. 4578.
2 Words of r nandamay M, translated and compiled by
tmnanda, pp. 113.
164 MITCHINER

3 Agehanada Bharati, The Light at the Centre, Santa Barbara 1976


(repr. Delhi 1977), pp. 53ff, 87111.
4 Among recent works see, for example, Alexander Lipski, Life and
Teaching of r nandamay M, Delhi 1977, and the discussion in
Sobharani Basu, Modern Indian Mysticism, Vanarasi 1974, vol. 2,
pp. 562606.
5 Mother Krishnabai, Gurus Grace, transl. by Svami Rmds,
Anandashram 1964.
6 Gurus Grace, p. 14.
7 Ibid., p. 2.
8 This paper was written while Rajneesh was still in Poona. In June
1981 he suddenly left India and established his headquarters at
Rajneeshpuram, Oregon, U.S.A., and for three years undertook a
vow of silence. Following a split among his followers in mid-1985,
he announced that he had never wanted to found a religion and that
he now wanted his adherents to regard him as a friend rather than a
guru, to burn all copies of his speeches and to abandon their orange
robes and ml. Towards the end of 1985, amidst Federal fraud
investigation Rajneesh left the States with the intention of returning
to the foothills of the Himalayas.
[Editors note: An up-to-date account of practices, events and
problems within the movement prior to its disintegration can be
found in Bob Mullan (Dept. of Sociology, University of East Anglia),
Life as Laughter. Following Bhagwan Shree Rajneesh, London 1983.
For an insiders account of events leading to the disintegration of the
movement and the aftermath see H.Milne, Bhagwan. The God That
Failed, London 1986.]
9 Awareness, Rajneesh Foundation Newsletter, vol. 5, no. 6,
(16 March 1979).
10 Zorba the Buddha, Rajneesh Foundation Newsletter, vol. 4, no. 10
(16 August 1978).
11 His attitude to drugs is well illustated in LSD: A Shortcut to False
Samdhi, Bombay 1971.
12 Bhagwan Shree Rajneesh Diary 1977, Poona 1976, entry for 19
December.
13 Rajneesh Foundation, Poona 1976, p. 11. See also ;a
Dehypnosis, Rajneesh Foundation Newsletter, vol. 5, no. 3, 1
February 1979; and I am the Gate, Poona 1975, pp. 3762.
14 For example Dogs and Politicians not Allowed, Rajneesh
Foundation Newsletter, vol. 4, no. 19, 1 October 1978.
15 Zorba the Buddha, Rajneesh Foundation Newsletter, vol. 4, no. 16,
16 August 1978.
16 Trust in the Master, Rajneesh Foundation Newsletter, vol. 5, no. 2,
16, 16 January 1979.
THREE CONTEMPORARY INDIAN MYSTICS 165

17 For example in R.C.Zaehner, Mysticism Sacred and Profane, Oxford


1957, pp. 153207.
18 See especially his Interpretation and Mystical Experience, Religious
Studies, vol. 1, no. 1 (1965), pp. 7587.
19 Ibid., p. 87.
20 For example Jan van Ruiysbroek, The Spiritual Espousals, tr. Eric
College, London 1952, pp. 16673; al-Ghazl, Mishkat al-Anwr,
translit. text and trans. in Zaehner, op. cit., pp. 1578 & 2301.
21 The Light at the Centre, especially pp. 94111.
166
11
YOGA, MYSTICISM AND A MODEL
OF COMPARATIVE RELIGION
Andrew Rawlinson

Reading through the literature on Yoga and mysticism will quickly lead us
to the realization of the ambiguity of these two terms as used by many
authors. At times it seems that almost any account of human condition and
endeavour can be fitted into them. In the context of Yoga it is expressed by
the variety of Yogas: Hatha Yoga, Bhakti Yoga, Karma Yoga, Rja Yoga,
Jna Yoga etc.
In the context of mysticism the ambiguity is underlined by the need felt
by writers to characterize its facets as done in the introductory paper to this
collection: direct experience of divine or ultimate reality; a theological or
metaphysical doctrine; and a (mystical) path leading to a (mystical) goal.
All expressions used here have an intrinsic ambiguity. So do references to
the ultimate reality as being beyond the world of external objects. The
words world, external and objects are not self-explanatory and may
harbour different meanings. Even the expression beyond is not exempt
from this ambiguity.
One way of dealing with this problem is to define ones terms very
precisely and adhere strictly to their meanings thus defined. This is the
move that most systematic schools of Yoga and some mystical doctrinal
schools have adopted. Another method would be to accept the ambiguity of
language terms as unavoidable and try to show how they are related. Such a
method is, basically, comparative; it starts with a set of different positions
as found in different systems and does not try to establish a single, possibly
correct, position.
In this paper I will try to outline a model that is concerned with the
fundamental variables of comparative religion. It will be seen that it is
applicable also to Yoga and mysticism for the simple reason that they both
are, at bottom, identical with religion, unless one would wish to define them
in a particular way which would mean using the other method instead of the
comparative one I have chosen.
When trying to understand the great traditions and teachings of the world
one is struck, sooner or later, by the realization that opposites are true. Or,
to put it another way, opposite truths apply to the human condition. We
168 RAWLINSON

have therefore no option open to us other than to come to terms with this
ambivalence.
Assuming therefore that opposites have to be embraced I propose the
following model (see Fig. 1)which is essentially simple, but has extremely
rich ramifications. It starts with two pairs of polar concepts: Hot and
Cool; Structured and Unstructured.
Hot is that which is other than oneself; that which has its own life. It is
not something that one can have access to by right. It is powerful and
breath-taking and is associated with revelation and grace. It is very similar
to Ottos numinous.
Cool is the very essence of oneself; one need not go to another to find
it. Hence one does have access to it by right. It is quiet and still and is
associated with self-realization.
The meaning of Structured is that there is an inherent order in the
cosmos and therefore in the human condition. There is something to be
discovered and there is a way of discovering it. A map is required to find
the destination.
By contrast, Unstructured teachings say that there is no gap between the
starting point and the finishing point. Method and goal are identical. We are
not separate from what is, and so no map is required. Everything is
available now and always has been.
Although these four statements of the human condition are all related,
they also conflict with each other. But they are all true. Examples from the
great traditions will be given later, but first we need to see that the two pairs
can be combined (see Fig. 2).
These combinations can be shown more clearly by using four categories
that refer to those aspects of the human condition which all teachings must
deal with in some form or another. The four are: ONTOLOGY or that
which is; COSMOLOGY or the nature of the universe; ANTHROPOLOGY
or the nature of man; and SOTERIOLOGY or the nature of liberation
(see Fig. 3).
Naturally, the types can overlap and I shall give some examples later.
But now it is useful to summarize each of the four quarters of the model
with some examples (taken from Christianity, Hinduism and Buddhism,
respectively) and some essential characteristics and images (see Fig. 4).
A few explanations may be needed. First, it is no accident that the
characteristics on the structured side are more numerous than those on the
unstructured side. Naturally, the unstructured cannot have a wealth of
qualities since it obliterates the distinction between substance and
accidents. Secondly, the characteristics of the Hot Structured and the
Cool Structured exactly complement each other. Thus awareness is cool
and dispassionate, whereas initiatory knowledge is hot, something one is
granted. Similarly, the Hot Structured path is one requiring the exercise of
will which allows the practitioner to break through the barriers that are in
YOGA, MYSTICISM AND A MODEL 169

his way in an ever-increasing series of leaps. This method requires the use
of magic, which is simply the manipulation of the laws of the cosmos in the
service of self-transformation. By contrast, the Cool Structured path is
very restrained. There is a task to be accomplished (just as in the Hot
Structured paththey are both structured, after all), but the method is
ordered and gentle. The practitioner starts on page one of the manual, so to
speak, and works his way through. Everything happens as it should in the
fullness of time. At a certain point, magical powers appear, it is true, but
they are incidental to the aim, which is balance and timing.
An instructive comparison between Hot and Cool Structured
teachings can be found in Vedic and Confucian ritual. All ritual, by
definition, is structured. But Vedic ritual, which is concerned with
participation in the sacred world of the gods, is hot; while Confucian
ritual, which aims to establish a correct relationship with the cosmic
principle, is cool.
The four categories of Hot/Cool/Structured/Unstructured form
themselves naturally into four sets of pairs. The pairs above the horizontal
line are both hot (but are also opposite, because one is structured and the
other is unstructured). The inverse is true of the pairs below the line.
Analogously, on the left of the vertical line we have the structured pairs
(one hot, one cool); and inversely on the right. By contrast, the opposite
corners of the model have nothing in common. The magician (Hot
Structured) regards the hermit (Cool Structured) as a stick-in-the-mud; the
hermit sees the magician as a tearaway. Similarly, Leap! (Hot Structured)
is the exact opposite of Let go! (Cool Unstructured). The same is true of
the other two corners; Submit! and Work! Notice, however, that Leap!
and Work! have a (structured) element in common, just as Leap! and
Submit! have (though this time it is the hot element). Similarly for
Submit! and Let go!
Another interesting set of comparisons that this model reveals is that of
the idea of a teaching itself (see Fig. 5).
All these types have attractive and dispiriting aspects to them. The great
attraction of the Cool Structured teachings is that anyone can be a
beginnerit is easy to start. The drawback is that it may take a very long
time to get to the endand there is no one to help you. Everyone has to
work on himself.
The attraction of the Cool Unstructured teachings is that the truth is
simple; the drawback is that it is very elusive. Hence the practitioner (if that
is the right word, since there cannot really be practice on an unstructured
path) is constantly failing. But because truth is his by right, he can always
try again in the very next moment. Hot Unstructured teachings share this
characteristicone is always failing. But the solution to this failure is not,
as with the Cool Unstructured to be open; rather, it is simply to ask.
(Though, naturally, being open and asking are related, because both are
170 RAWLINSON

unstructured ideals.) The reason why asking is the solution is that the central
truth of Hot Unstructured teachings is that love is freely given to all who
request it.
Finally, the attraction of Hot Structured teachings is that there is plenty
of help. Most cosmologies of this kind have the idea that the entire universe
is designed to aid the practitioner on the wayfrom the colour of the rose
to the megacosmic designs of the archangels. The drawback is that the task
is correspondingly awesome. The journey is very long and the demands are
very great. This is not an adventure to be entered lightly.
It can be noticed that both the cool teachings (structured and
unstructured) are open whereas both the hot teachings are in some sense
withheld. This is because cool teachings are regarded as mans right
typical cool ideal. By contrast, hot teachings are a gift, not a right. We
can also see from the model that unstructured teachings are completely and
instantly available, while structured teachings have to be worked through
(often on a huge timescale).
As said earlier, the four quarters of the model can easily combine. In fact,
it is somewhat artificial to separate them. A few simple examples are shown
in Fig. 6.
The first diagram represents the teaching that God creates the universe
with all its dimensions, that he is responsible for it, and that its forms
express his divine nature. The second can be summarized as follows:
Everyone is Godnow. The third in effect is saying: Ones own self, which
is identical with truth, is surrounded by layers that must be penetrated. The
fourth represents a variant of esotericism: Liberation is a great journey
through the cosmos, which is contained within oneself (and one needs
initiation to complete it).
Of course, one could apply the categories of Ontology, Cosmology,
Anthropology and Soteriology to these overlaps and thereby be far more
detailed in characterizing them. But I shall leave the reader to do it for
himself.
The model can be used in a number of ways. For example Fig. 7 represents
the teachings of the Bhagavad Gt. The first one distributes the four Yogas
to the appropriate sections of the model. The second one unites the four, so
to speak. This explains why the Gt has been the most influential text in
Indian history: it contains all the essential aspects of a spiritual teaching. Or
to put it another way, it appeals to all levels of the human condition.
(I have to admit that I have oversimplified the matter somewhat. I have
not included the material that is found in the Gt and Rja Yoga
is, strictly speaking, not a Hot Structured teaching. The two diagrams
should thus be as in Fig. 8. However, if we include the revelation of
aivarya-rpa in ch. 11, which definitely is Hot Structured, the first pair
of diagrams can be justified as genuine representations of the elements in
the Gt.)
YOGA, MYSTICISM AND A MODEL 171

A good test of a model is the range of phenomena that it can explain.


This one is not limited to the great historical traditions but can be applied to
very recent religious movements. Fig. 9 is, I think, reasonably accurate. The
diagram shows, moreover, the similarities and differences between the four.
Thus there is obvious sympathy between Subud and Gurdjieff (both are
hot), though the former is primarily Hot Unstructured with a secondary
level of Hot Structured, and the latter is primarily Hot Structured along
with some Cool Structured elements. But there is no sympathy at all
between Subud and Transcendental Meditation. Similarly, Krishnamurti
and Gurdjieff have nothing in common (since they occupy opposite corners
of the model).
Two other areas offer excellent material for seeing how the model works.
The first concerns the and aiva Bhakti traditions which I have
summarized, using an earlier version of this model, in another paper. 1
There I used the terms Love and Meditation instead of Hot and Cool.
Fig. 10 is a concentrated form of the model that I used in that paper.
This can be further concentrated as shown in Fig. 11.
All great devotional teachings, whatever their provenance, have some
elements of these four types in them. This can give rise to subtle and
complex teachings. However, the model shows that certain general
principles always apply. Hot Bhakti insists that God is the doer, while for
cool Bhakti the focus is ones own nature (which is divine nature).
Unstructured Bhakti always claims that the method and the goal are one
(though for Hot Unstructured Bhakti it is love or submission, whereas for
Cool Unstructured Bhakti it is wisdom). Structured Bhakti, on the other
hand, accepts a natural distinction between them. One of the consequences
of this difference between unstructured and structured Bhakti is that the
latter tends to be eclectic (any method is acceptable as long as it leads to the
goal), while the former never is (there is only one method, because there
is only one goal). Hence only love (Hot Unstructured) or wisdom
(Cool Unstructured) will do.
The second example to which the model can be applied is Buddhism, and in
particular Buddhology, as given in Fig. 12.
I hope I have shown that this model is genuinely comparative and that it
can explain the relation between different truths at various levels. If I have
been clear, it should be obvious that the terms Yogi and mystic can be
put in any quarter of the model (see Fig. 13).
Different people may have their own preferences as to how to use these
terms. In this article I have used the term Yogi in an exclusively cool
structured sense and I have not used the word mystic at all. Yet I have

1 Love and Meditation in the Bhakti Tradition, The Sant Tradition of


India, ed. by K.Schomer & H.McLeod, Delhi 1986, pp. 538.
172 RAWLINSON

throughout been concerned with what might be called Yoga and mysticism.
If the model works, this should be obvious. And other people should be able
to apply the model in their own wayand thereby use both these terms in a
variety of senseswithout the rest of us getting lost. That is what a
comparative model is designed to do.
YOGA, MYSTICISM AND A MODEL 173

Fig. 1

Fig. 2
174 RAWLINSON

Fig. 3
YOGA, MYSTICISM AND A MODEL 175

Fig. 4
176 RAWLINSON

Fig. 5

Fig. 6
YOGA, MYSTICISM AND A MODEL 177

Fig. 7

Fig. 8
178 RAWLINSON

Fig. 9
YOGA, MYSTICISM AND A MODEL 179

Fig. 10
180 RAWLINSON

Fig. 11
YOGA, MYSTICISM AND A MODEL 181

Fig. 12
182 RAWLINSON

Fig. 13
GLOSSARY

Abhidharma (Pli: abhidhamma)the higher doctrine in Buddhism; the


third division of the Buddhist canonical scriptures containing
psychological and philosophical texts of predominantly analytical nature.
diprimeval, original.
advaitanon-dual.
akusalaunwholesome, non-meritorious, unskilful.
nandabliss.
araha(n)tthe worthy one; in early and Theravda Buddhism a term for
the accomplished follower of the Buddha who has reached the final
; in Mahyna the status of arahats is ambiguous, sometimes
recognized as the achievement of liberation, though inferior to the status
of a bodhisattva, sometimes seen as a temporary respite with further effort
needed if perfection is to be won.
ryannoble; also: holy or saintly as a designation for achievers of stages
of sanctity in early Buddhism; derived from rya, the name the Indo-
European tribes, who invaded India in the second millennium B.C. and
created the Vedic civilizion, used to refer to themselves and which was
probably once so used by all or most Indo-European nations (cf. Iran and
Eire).
yogaeightfold path of training in Patajalis Yoga Stra.
tman (Pli: atta)the self; the expression referring to the inmost
essence of man, sometimes inappropriately translated as soul.
avatradivine incarnation.
Bhagavatthe Lord.
bhaktadevotee pursuing the path of love for God.
bhaktilove, viz. of God for the devotee and of the devotee for God.
subconsciousness, a term mentioned in of the
Theravda Abhidhamma and explained in the commentary as a
basis of existence of subconscious life-stream.
bhmiplatform, level, stage; stages on the bodhisattva path to perfection,
ten in number.
bhtaa being; a ghost.
bjaseed; with seed(s).
bodhienlightenment.
bodhisattva (Pli: bodhisatta)an enlightenment-being; in the Pli Canon
the term designates a being preparing himself for the career of a Buddha
as the world teacher such as Siddhatha Gotama in his former lives and in
his last one up to his enlightenment, or the future Buddha Metteya who,
184 GLOSSARY

as a virtually accomplished bodhisatta, awaits the suitable time for his last
birth on earth in heaven; by implication there must be other
bodhisattas, not named in the Pli sources, preparing for the Buddha career
in future world periods; in Mahyna the term bodhisattva acquires new
meanings, one of them being based on the promise of the one who embarks
on the Bodhisattva path not to enter until he has assisted all other
beings, down to the last blade of grass, to reach liberation; one can thus
assume the existence of a category of permanent bodhisattvas.
Brahmathe god creator in Hinduism; in early Buddhism Brahmas are a
cateogry of divine beings above the deva world.
brahmacaryadivine faring; living in a discipline for the sake of the
realization of the ultimate goal; in some systems narrowed down to the
meaning of celibacy.
brahmanthe divine source of the universe in the ; the sole reality
in Advaita Vednta.
, brahminpriest, member of the highest caste in the Hindu social
system; are also priestly books, a category of Vedic
scriptures.
Buddhathe Enlightened One; the Awakened One.
buddhihigher mind; intelligence; the first cosmic evolute of in the
system.
cetamind; consciousness; will.
citta, cit (Ved. kit)mind, heart; sometimes to be understood as the character
or personality of a being.
devagod; devatdeity; devaputrason of god; sometimes these three
expressions are used interchangably, meaning divine being.
dharma (Pli: dhamma)reality, truth, law, duty; teaching of reality; in
Buddhism: the teaching of the Buddha; also, particularly when used in
plural: elements of reality, phenomena, mind-objects.
dharmakyathe body of truth or the absolute reality in itself in Mahyna
Buddhism.
dhyna (Pli: jhna)meditative absorption.
(Pli: dukkha)suffering, unsatisfactoriness.
epistemologyphilosophical discipline concerned with the theory of
knowledge.
gnosisknowledge; direct knowledge, often used in the sense of
suprasensory and suprarational perception and understanding.
gopmilkmaid, cowherdess; designation for the soul engrossed in the love
for God in mysticism.
attribute, quality, natural force; in philosophy there are three
or forces of : sattva (purity), rajas (drive, energy) and
tamas (inertia).
guruteacher, spiritual preceptor.
GLOSSARY 185

Hadesunderworld, the abode of the deceased ones in ancient Greek


religion and mythology.
Hnaynasmall vehicle; an expression coined by early Mahyna stras,
propagating the bodhisattva path, for the early Buddhist doctrine with its
individual goal of reaching by becoming an arahat.
janmabirth; birth suffering; the anguish experienced
when being born.
japarepetition; murmuring meditation; inward recitation of mantras.
jhnasee dhyna.
jvaindividual soul.
jnaknowledge.
kaivalyaaloneness; complete autonomy from empirical states of
existence as the realization of final freedom of the in the
system; also used in the context of classical Yoga.
kmadesire, love, lust.
a meditational object in Theravda practice.
karma (Pli: kamma)action, deed; the law of cause and effect in the sphere
of morality operating through successive lives.
a circular object for visual meditation in Theravda practice.
keinthe longhaired one; the accomplished sage outside the mainstream
of the Vedic tradition referred to in RV and AV.
khandhamass, heap, aggregate; one of the five sets of constituents forming
the personality according to early Buddhist doctrine.
krtan(a) singing the praises of God, usually in a devotional gathering.
kusalawholesome, meritorious, skilful.
llplay; divine play as motive for creation of the world.
a ivaistic sectarian movement in Southern India.
Mdhyamaka (Mdhyamika)a school of Mahyna philosophy derived
from the work of , its core being the teaching on emptiness and
therefore it is also called nyavda.
a sectarian Buddhist movement presumably originated from
a schism at the third Buddhist Congress over the definition of arahatship
and some other points of doctrine and discipline; it contributed
substantially to the appearance of Mahyna and anticipated some of the
Mahyna teachings.
Mahynathe great vehicle; the name for the second turning of the
wheel or the renewal of the Buddhist teaching on the basis of new
stras presumably uttered by the Buddha on higher planes; it replaced the
arahat ideal of the early Buddhism with the bodhisattva commitment to
work for the attainment of liberation of all sentient beings; in time it
developed hierarchies of cosmic Buddhas and Bodhisattvas, a doctrine of
three layers of reality (see trikya), several schools of philosophy and
elaborate systems of practice, both ritual and meditational.
186 GLOSSARY

mlgarland; a string of beads (rosary) used during recitation or inner


repetition of mantras to count them.
mantraa word or phrase used for chanting, inner repetition, in rituals and
as a vehicle for meditation.
Mradeath personified as the lord of death or the ruler of the realm of
death, i.e. , prominent particularly in Pli Buddhism.
myillusion; magic; an expression used in Vedntic philosophy and some
Hindu sectarian teachings for the manifested reality as a product of the
cosmic illusion brought about by the ignorance of beings; the creative or
magic power of God, usually represented by his female consort,
responsible for the manifestation of the universe.
metempsychosistransmigration; reincarnation.
liberation.
ngaa mythological category of beings related to serpents whose shape
they often take; they can also appear in human form and their abode is at
the bottom of lakes and rivers.
nmaname; mentality; nma-rpa designates the psycho-physical
compound forming the human personality.
nidnalink, cause, source; a link in the chain of dependent origination.
nimittasign; a mental image indicating an advanced state of concentration
or meditation.
nirbjaseedless.
(Pli: nibbna)going out, blowing out; extinction of passions
or cankers and attainment of liberation.
ontologydoctrine of reality; philosophical preoccupation with the
question of what is ultimately real.
pantheisma school of thought which subscribes to the view that God is in
everything.
parakypossessed by another.
the supreme swan, a symbol of an accomplished person,
sometimes used as an honorific term for gurus.
pram, pramitperfection.
praj (Pli: pa)wisdom.
nature; the primeval creative force responsible for the
manifestation of the populated universe through the interplay of its three
constituents or ; it is the second principle in the dualistic system of
philosophy.
prattyasamutpda (Pli: paticcasamuppda)dependent origination; a
chain of ten or twelve nidnas which explains, in Buddhist terms, the
process of existence.
premalove; ideal love.
preta (Pli: peta)a deceased one, a discarnate spirit; one of the six
categories of beings in the Buddhist scheme (partly
corresponding to the Christian idea of souls in purgatory).
GLOSSARY 187

person, spirit; the first principle in the dualistic system;


since there are innumerable , however, one can classify
as pluralistic dualism.
seer; Vedic designation of accomplished or inspired poets, authors of
the Vedic hymns; in the extended form (Maharishigreat seer)
in later and modern times used (and misused) as an honorific title for or
by gurus.
right, truth; cosmic law of balance incorporating both the natural and
ethical laws.
rpashape, form; bodily form.
sdhakaadept; accomplished person.
sdhanpersonal spiritual discipline; a way to fulfilment.
aivapertaining to god iva; ivaistic.
samdhia deep state of meditative absorption or concentration, sometimes
regarded also as a state of higher cognition.
samathapeace, quietude; in Theravda Buddhism used to denote a type of
meditation (samatha bhvan) leading to jhnas, but not necessarily to
wisdom and liberation.
global flow; an expression used mainly, though not
exclusively, in Buddhism to denote the whole of manifested reality and in
particular the fact of each beings beginningless and unceasing
transmigration from life to life.
(Pli: )lit. con-fection, it is usually translated as
mental formation and refers to unconscious dynamic tendencies and
volitions such as instincts, urges, desires, also decisions and aspirations,
all representing the fourth group of constituents of the human personality
as taught by early Buddhism.
embracing; embrace.
one of the six recognized Hindu systems of philosophy which
posits a multiplicity of , all originally pure and free, and the
creative force of responsible for producing the manifested world
and all things and beings with whom become involved and
falsely identified; when they realize their inner independence from the
evolutes of , they become free.
renunciation; a state of homelessness; a life style aiming at
spiritual fulfilment; a renunciate; mendicant; homeless
wanderer.
Sarvstivdaan early school of Hnayna Buddhism which subscribes to
the view that the elements or constituents which combine to produce things
and beings actually exist, while things and beings are impermanent.
Sautrntikaan early school of Buddhism which split off from the Indian
Sthaviravda (Pli: Theravda), because it rejected abhidharma
developments and regarded only the stras or discourses of the Buddha
as authentic Buddhadharma. On the doctrinal side they accepted the
188 GLOSSARY

continuity of a kind of subtle consciousness from life to life (somewhat


similar to the Theravda notion of ).
siddhi (Pli: iddhi)magic or supernatural power developed in the process
of training in Yoga or Buddhist meditation, sometimes regarded as an
undesirable and potentially dangerous by-product.
la (Pli; sla)morality; a set of ethical requirements in Buddhist training.
pupil.
(Pli: samana)wandering ascetic.
nyat (Pli: suat)emptiness; in Mahyna a crucial concept often
used in the sense of the ultimate reality.
svaky, sviyself-possessed, ones own.
Theravdathe oldest surviving school of Buddhism rooted in Pli Canon
and further developed in its commentarial literature; although often
referred to as Hnayna, it does not fit neatly under that heading; it
comprises in germ or by tacit implication some important features of
Mahyna doctrines.
trikyathree bodies or levels of reality or truth in Mahyna: dharmakya;
sambhogakya, the body of experience or the truth as accessible to the
enlightened mind; and , the symbolical body or the
incarnate truth as encountered in the person of a Buddha on earth.
turya (also called caturtha)the fourth state, a term used in some
and Vedntic works for the accomplished state of consciousness in which
final truth or conscious identity with the ultimate is realized; the other
three are: the waking state, the dream state and the deep sleep state,
unio mysticamystical union with God, the deity or the divine; this term
may but need not imply monistic interpretation.
upadnaclinging, grasping; a technical term, in Pli Buddhism, for the
personal force keeping together the five groups of the constituents of
personality: pac upadna khandha.
philosophical and mystical writings included in the Vedic
literature as its end or closing part (hence Vednta) and therefore
regarded as having scriptural authority in Hinduism; fourteen to eighteen
can be regarded as Vedic in this sense; later ones are specialized
writings and elaborations, some of them sectarian; Hindu orthodoxy
accepts usually 108 .
pertaining to god ; .
vsanindwelling impression, tendency; refers to traces of past actions
and ties in a persons character.
Vedalit. knowledge; sacred scriptures regarded as revelation in
Hinduism and composed of four Vedas or collections of hymns,
or priestly treatises and .
Vedntaend of the Veda, i.e. ; the term is sometimes used, not
quite correctly, for later-developed Vedntic philosophy derived from the
.
GLOSSARY 189

vijna (Pli: vina)consciousness, cognition, understanding; the


fifth khandha in the Buddhist concept of the human personality.
VijnavdaMahyna school of philosophy regarding vijna as the
substratum of reality in the absolute sense.
separation, absence, bereavement.
vimuttiliberation.
vipassaninsight; a faculty developed in the course of meditation and
leading to final knowledge and liberation; in Theravda Buddhism used
to denote the type of meditation, vipassan bhvan, leading to that
achievement.
virahaseparation, absence, want, abandonment; separation of lovers.
Vraaivapertaining to devotional worship of iva as hero; a sectarian
movement of South Indian ivaism, overlapping with .
Vrtyaone bound by a vow (vrata;) designation for early, nonVedic, Indo-
ryan fraternities in the East of Northern India with a religious and
spiritual tradition of their own, later brahmanized and codified in the AV.
Yogcraanother name for the Vijnavda school expressing its stress
on the development of consciousness through Yoga training.
190
CONTRIBUTORS

PRATIMA BOWES
Department of Philosophy, University of Sussex (retired).
LANCE S. COUSINS
Department of Comparative Religion, University of Manchester.
DEIRDRE GREEN
Department of Theology and Religious Studies, Saint Davids University
College, University of Wales.
MINORU HARA
Department of Sanskrit, University of Tokyo.
PETER HARVEY
Department of Languages and Cultures, Sunderland Polytechnic.
F.W.J.HUMPHRIES
Invited lay guest speaker.
JOHN E.MITCHINER
Foreign and Commonwealth Office, London.
ANDREW RAWLINSON
Department of Religious Studies, University of Lancaster.
KAREL WERNER
School of Oriental Studies, University of Durham.
192
NOTE ON THE PAPERS AND
ACKNOWLEDGEMENTS

Mysticism as Doctrine and Experience was presented at the Fifth


Symposium in Holly Royde College in Manchester on 20 April 1979 and
was published in Religious Traditions, A Journal in the Study of Religion,
vol. 4, no. 1 (1981), pp. 118. Its editor, Ian Kessarcodi-Watson of La
Trobe University, Australia (who died a few years later) was present at that
Symposium. The article has been revised for this collection.

Mysticism and Indian Spirituality was delivered at the Sixth


Symposium at the Cherwell Centre, Oxford, on 11 April 1980, published in
Studies in Indian Philosophy, a Memorial Volume in Honour of Pandit
S.Sanghvi, ed. D.Malvania & N.J.Shah, L.D. Institute of Indology,
Ahmedabad 1981, pp. 24156, and again in The Scottish Journal of
Religious Studies, vol. 3 (1982), pp. 1525; and revised for this collection.

The Longhaired Sage of RV 10, 136 published here is a substantially


revised version of the paper Yoga in the Veda read at the Second
Symposium in Passfield Hall on 19 September 1976 and published as
Yoga and the Veda. An Interpretation of the kein Hymn, RV 10,136
in Religious Studies, vol. 13, no. 3 (1977), pp. 289302.

Mysticism in the and in ankaras Vednta was read at the


Sixth Symposium on 11 April 1980 and is published here for the first time
with minor changes.
Birth of Extraordinary Persons was read at the Fifth Symposium on 22
April 1979 and published as A Note on the Buddhas Birth Story in
Indianisme et Bouddhisme. Mlanges offerts Mgr tienne Lamotte,
Louvain-la-Neuve 1980. Included here is an edited version of the paper.

Consciousness Mysticism in the Discourses of the Buddha was


delivered at the Fifth Symposium on 20 April 1979 under the title
Consciousness and Nibbna in Early Buddhism and published as
Consciousness and Nibbna in the Pli Suttas in Journal of Studies in
194 ACKNOWLEDGEMENTS

Mysticism, vol. 2, no. 2 (1979). The version published here has been
slightly revised and edited, with one substantial change to which attention is
drawn in note 17.
The Stages of Christian Mysticism and Buddhist Purification: Interior
Castle of St Teresa of Avila and the Path of Purification of Buddhaghosa
was read at the Fifth Symposium on 21 April 1979 and is published here for
the first time with minor editorial changes.

Living Between the Worlds: Bhakti Poetry and the Carmelite Mystics
was delivered at the Thirteenth Symposium on 3 April 1987 and is
published here for the first time.
Yoga Philosophy and Jung was presented at the Sixth Symposium on
12 April 1980 and is published without change for the first time in this
collection.

Three Contemporary Indian Mystics: nandamay, Krishnabai and


Rajneesh was read at the Fifth Symposium on 22 April 1979 and is here
published for the first time with the added note 8 supplemented by the
editors bibliographical note.

Yoga, Mysticism and a Model of Comparative Religion is a completely


new version, or a further elaboration, of an idea contained in the paper
Love and Meditation in the Indian Bhakti Tradition presented at the
Second Symposium on 20 September 1976.

The idea of commemorating the ten Symposia under the editors


convenership occurred also to the second convener who was quick enough
to put together a collection of papers, thematically unrelated, before the
intention of bringing out this volume with its theme became known. For
this reason two papers delivered at the Fifth Symposium on mysticism
found their way into the other collection: Mysticism in the Epics by John
L. Brockington (Department of Sanskrit, University of Edinburgh), and
Metaphysical Knowlege in the Yoga Stra by David Bastow (Department
of Philosophy, University of Dundee). Both were published in: Perspectives
on Indian Religion. Papers in Honour of Karel Werner, ed. Peter Connolly
(Bibliotheca Indo-Buddhica, no. 30), Delhi 1986, pp. 920 and 2134,
respectively.

You might also like